529267
338
Zoom out
Zoom in
Previous page
1/361
Next page
ASTRA
©Copyright by Vauxhall Motors Ltd., England.
Reproduction or translation, in whole or in parts, is not
permitted without prior written consent from Vauxhall Motors
Ltd.
All rights as understood under the copyright laws are explicitly
reserved by Vauxhall Motors Ltd.
All information, illustrations and specifications contained in this
manual are based on the latest production information
available at the time of publication.
The right is reserved to make changes at any time without
notice.
Edition: July 2006.
TS 1612-A-07
ASTRA
Operation, Safety and Maintenance
Owners Manual
VAUXHALL Astra
Operation, Safety, Maintenance
-2
Data specific to your vehicle
Please enter your vehicle’s data here to keep it easily accessible.
This information is available under the section "Technical data" as well as on the identification plate.
Fuel
Designation
Engine oil
Grade
Viscosity
Tyre inflation pressure
Tyre size with full load
Summer tyres Front Rear
Winter tyres Front Rear
Weights
Permissible gross vehicle weight
– EC kerb weight
=Loading
-1
Your Astra
Developed to the latest findings of
automobile research, it offers technical
sophistication and exceptional comfort.
Your vehicle represents an intelligent
synthesis of advanced technology,
outstanding safety, environmental
compatibility and economy.
It now lies with you to drive your vehicle
safely and to see it performs perfectly.
This Owner's Manual provides you with all
the necessary information to that end.
Make sure your passengers are aware of
the possible risk of accident and injury
which may result from improper use of the
vehicle.
You must always comply with the laws of
the country in which you are travelling.
These could differ from the information in
this Owner’s Manual.
The Owner's Manual should always be kept
in the vehicle: ready to hand in the glove
compartment.
Make use of the Owner's Manual:
z Its "In Brief" section will give you an initial
overview.
z The table of contents at the start of the
Owner’s Manual and in each individual
chapter will help you find your way.
z Its index will help you find what you
want.
z It will familiarise you with the
sophisticated technology.
z It will increase your pleasure in your
vehicle.
z It will help you to handle your vehicle
expertly.
The Owner’s Manual is designed to be
clearly laid-out and easily understood.
This symbol signifies:
6 Continue reading on next page.
3 The asterisk signifies equipment not
fitted to all vehicles (model variants,
engine options, models specific to one
country, optional equipment, Genuine
Vauxhall Parts and Accessories).
Yellow arrows in the illustrations serve as
points of reference or indicate some action
to be performed.
Black arrows in the illustrations indicate a
reaction or a second action to be
performed.
Thank you for choosing a Vauxhall. We
wish you many hours of pleasurable
driving.
Your Vauxhall Team
9 Warning
9 Warning is used to mark text
regarding possible risks of accident or
injury. Failure to follow the instructions
could lead to injury or loss of life.
Inform vehicle passengers accordingly.
0
Contents
Commitment to customer
satisfaction:
Our aim: to keep you happy with your
vehicle. All Vauxhall Authorised Repairers
offer first class service at competitive
prices. Experienced, factory-trained
technicians work according to factory
instructions.Your Authorised Repairer can
supply you with GENUINE VAUXHALL-
APPROVED PARTS, which have undergone
stringent quality and precision checks, and
of course useful and attractive
VAUXHALL-APPROVED ACCESSORIES.
Our name is your guarantee!
For details of the
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer Network
please ring this number; 01582 - 427200
In Brief ....................................................... 2
Instruments ............................................. 36
Keys, doors,
bonnet ................................................ 66
Seats, Interior .......................................... 87
Safety systems ..................................... 111
Lighting ................................................. 136
Windows, Sun Roof ............................. 143
TwinTop ................................................ 148
Climate control .................................... 157
Easytronic ............................................. 178
Automatic transmission ...................... 186
Automatic transmission
with ActiveSelect .............................. 192
Driving hints ......................................... 200
Saving fuel,
Protecting the environment ............ 202
Fuel consumption,
fuel, refuelling .................................. 204
Catalytic converter, exhaust gases .... 207
Drive Control Systems ......................... 212
Brakes .................................................... 226
Wheels, tyres ......................................... 230
Roof racks,
Caravan and trailer towing ............ 238
Self-help ................................................ 247
If you have a problem ......................... 294
Maintenance,
Inspection System ............................ 296
Vehicle care .......................................... 308
Technical Data .................................... 312
Index........................................................ 349
2In Brief
In Brief
Key numbers,
Code numbers
Remove key number from keys.
The key number is specified in the vehicle
documents and in the Car Pass 3.
Alloy wheels 3, towing equipment 3: make
a note of the key identifier codes.
Electronic immobiliser, infotainment
system 3: The code numbers are specified
in the Car Pass.
Do not keep the Car Pass in the vehicle.
For key with retractable key blade 3, press
button to extend.
6 Further information – pages 66, 67,
vehicle recommissioning – page 307.
To unlock and open the vehicle:
Press button q,
pull door handle
In vehicles with an Open&Start system 3,
the vehicle is unlocked automatically by
pulling a door handle or by pulling the
button beneath the rear door handle if the
electronic key is in the external reception
range of the vehicle.
6 Child safety locks – page 86,
electronic immobiliser – page 67,
keys – page 66,
Open&Start system 3 – page 70,
radio remote control – page 68,
central locking system – page 76,
anti-theft locking system 3 – page 77,
Vauxhall alarm system 3 – page 83,
TwinTop roof operation 3 – page 148.
3In Brief
To unlock and
open the luggage compartment:
Press button q on remote
control and
pull button beneath
handle
In vehicles with Open&Start system 3 the
tailgate is unlocked automatically by
pulling the button beneath the handle if
the electronic key is within the external
reception range of the vehicle. The doors
are also unlocked.
6 Open&Start-System 3 – Page 70,
Radio remote control – Page 68,
Central locking system – Page 76,
Vauxhall alarm system 3 – Page 83.
To adjust front seat:
Pull handle,
slide seat,
release handle
Never adjust the seat while driving. It could
move in an uncontrolled manner when the
handle is pulled.
6 Seat position – page 87.
Adjust front seat backrest:
Turn handwheel
Move backrest to suit seating position.
Do not lean on seat backrest whilst
adjusting it.
6 Seat position – page 87.
9 Warning
Do not sit nearer than 10 inches (25cm)
from the steering wheel, to permit safe
airbag deployment.
4In Brief
To adjust front seat lumbar
support 3:
Turn handwheel
Adjust lumbar support to suit personal
requirements.
Do not lean on seat backrest whilst
adjusting it.
6 Seat position – page 87.
To adjust front seat height 3:
Operate lever on outboard side of
seat
Lever pumping action
upward: seat higher
downward: seat lower
6 Seat position – page 87.
To adjust front seat inclination 3:
Pull inner lever on front of seat,
adjust inclination,
release lever,
engage seat in position
Adjust the inclination by distributing body
weight.
6 Seat position – page 87.
5In Brief
Tip the front seat backs
forward 3:
Lift release lever, tilt seat back
forward,
lower release lever, seat back is
engaged in tilted position, slide
seat forwards
To straighten the seat, slide back and it
engages in its original position. Raise
release lever, straighten seat back, lower
release lever, seat back engages.
For seats without memory function 3:
engage seat in desired position.
The seat back can only be tipped forwards
from an upright position.
Panoramic windscreen 3: before folding
the seat, push the head restraints down
and close the sun visors.
To adjust thigh support 3
of the front sport seat 3:
Press button in recessed handle
at the front of the adjustment
cushion and adjust the
thigh support
Adjust thigh support to suit personal
requirements.
To adjust head
restraint height of front
and rear outboard seats:
Press button to release,
adjust height,
engage in position
6 Head restraint position – Page 88,
Adjusting rear centre head restraint
– Page 89,
Removing the head restraint – Page 88.
6In Brief
Adjusting interior mirror:
Swivel mirror housing
Swivel lever on underside of mirror housing
to reduce dazzle at night.
6 Automatic anti-dazzle
interior mirror – page 134.
To adjust exterior mirrors:
From inside, swivel lever
in required direction
6 Further information, aspherical exterior
mirror 3 – page 134.
Electrical exterior mirrors 3,
adjust:
Four-way switch in driver’s door
Press mirror switch right or left: Four-way
switch adjusts corresponding mirror.
6 Further information, aspherical exterior
mirror – page 134,
heated exterior mirrors – page 18.
7In Brief
Swing in exterior mirror:
Manual: Mirrors can be folded in under
light pressure.
Electrically 3 : Press
n and both mirrors will
swing in.
Press button
n again - both exterior
mirrors swivel to the driving position.
If an electrical retracted mirror is extended
manually, pressing button
n will cause the
mirror to move all the way forward. The
other mirror
will be eclectically swiveled to
the driving position. If button
n is pressed
again, both mirrors will be electrically
retracted. Press again: both mirrors swivel
to the driving position.
Fitting seat belt:
Draw seat belt smoothly from
inertia
reel,
guide over shoulder
and engage in buckle
The seat belt must not be twisted at any
point. The lap belt must lie snugly against
the body. The front seat backrests must not
be tilted back too far (recommended tilting
angle approx. 25 °).
To release belt, press red button on belt
buckle.
6 Three-point seat belts – Page 112,
Vauxhall Full Size Airbag System
– Page 117,
Seat position – Page 87.
Steering wheel adjustment:
Move lever down,
adjust height and distance,
move lever up,
engage
Adjust steering wheel only when vehicle is
stationary and steering column lock is
released.
6 Vauxhall Full Size Airbag System
– Page 117.
8In Brief
9In Brief
Page
1 Side air vents ..................................159
2 Front passenger airbag ................ 117
3 Centre air vents ............................. 159
4 Central information display for
time, date, outside temperature,
infotainment system 3 ,
check control 3 ................................ 62
Trip computer 3 ........................52, 58
Climate control system 3 ............. 171
5 Heated seat (left) 3 ...................... 160
Deflation
detection system 3 ........................ 221
Tyre pressure
monitoring system 3 ...................... 222
Parking distance sensor 3 ............ 218
Hazard warning lights .....................16
Central locking system ....................76
SPORT mode 3 ...............................214
Heated seat (right) 3 ................... 160
Page
6 Turn signal lights, headlight flash
Dipped beam, main beam .............. 15
Door-to-door light function 3........ 140
Parking lights 3 ............................ 140
Cruise control 3 ...................... 13, 216
7 Remote control on
steering wheel 3 .............................. 64
8 Instruments ....................................... 36
9 Horn .................................................. 16
Driver’s Airbag .............................. 117
10 Windscreen wiper,
windscreen wash system,
headlight wash system 3 and
rear window wash system .........17, 18
11 Parking lights, dipped beam ........ 140
Instrument illumination ................. 140
Fog tail light ................................... 137
Fog lights 3 .................................... 137
Headlight range adjustment 3 .... 138
12 Bonnet release lever ........................ 86
Page
13 Starter switch
with immobiliser .............................. 14
and
sensor panel for emergency operation
Open&Start system 3 ..................... 73
14 Accelerator pedal.................. 200, 201
15 Brake pedal ................... 201, 226, 227
16 Clutch pedal 3............................... 201
17 Steering wheel adjustment ............... 7
18 Start/stop button 3 .................. 22, 70
19 Ashtray 3 ...................................... 108
Cigarette lighter 3 ........................ 107
20 Climate control ............................. 157
21 Infotainment system 3 ................... 65
22 Glove compartment ....... 72, 110, 159
10 In Brief
Control indicators
0 Open&Start system
see pages 36, 70.
I Engine oil pressure
see page 37.
R Brake system,
clutch system
see pages 38, 226, 302.
v Airbag systems,
belt tensioners,
deployable anti-roll bar 3
see pages 113, 123, 132.
v Electronic
Stability Programme
(ESP®
Plus
) 3
see page 212.
X Seat belt 3
see pages 38, 115.
Q Door open
see page 39.
p Alternator
see page 39.
W Coolant temperature
see pages 39, 300.
A Engine electronics,
Gear electronics 3,
Immobiliser
Diesel fuel filter 3,
fault
see pages 39, 67, 184, 190,
198, 210.
j Easytronic 3 ,
start engine 3
see pages 39, 179.
IDS+ Continuous
Damping Control 3,
SPORT mode 3
see pages 214, 215.
S Engine oil level 3
see pages 40, 298.
8 Exterior lights
see pages 40, 136.
r Parking distance sensor 3
see page 218.
O Turn signal lights
see pages 15, 40.
Y Fuel level
see pages 40, 43, 205.
> Fog lights 3
see pages 41, 137.
C Main beam
see pages 15, 41.
r Fog tail light
see pages 41, 137.
11In Brief
T Winter programme of
automatic transmission 3
or Easytronic 3
see pages 182, 189, 196.
1 SPORT mode of
automatic transmission 3
or Easytronic 3
see pages 181, 188, 195.
y Seat occupancy recognition 3
see page 124.
Z Exhaust emission 3
see pages 41, 209.
u Anti-lock brake system
see page 229.
! Preheating system 3,
Diesel particle filter 3
see page 42.
w Deflation
detection system 3,
Tyre pressure monitoring
system 3
see pages 42, 221, 224.
B Adaptive headlights 3,
Fault
see pages 139, 142.
m Cruise control 3
see pages 13, 216.
Lighting
Light switch,
stalk positions
see pages 14, 136,
7 Lights off,
8 Parking lights,
9 Dipped beam, main beam
> Fog lights 3
see page 137.
r Fog tail light
see page 137.
C Main beam
see page 15.
O Turn signal lights
see page 15.
k Instrument illumination
see page 140.
c Courtesy lights
see page 141.
a Reading lights 3
see page 141.
¨ Hazard warning lights
see page 16.
12 In Brief
Climate control
Air distribution
see pages 161, 175,
L to head area via adjustable
air vents and to foot well,
M to head area via
adjustable air vents,
l to windscreen,
J to windscreen and
to foot well,
K to foot well.
x Air flow
see pages 161, 175.
A Automatic control
of fan speed 3
see page 168.
Ü Heated rear window
see pages 18, 160.
n Air conditioning system 3
see pages 19, 164, 168.
4 Air recirculation system 3
see pages 164, 168, 176.
AUTO Automatic mode 3
see pages 19, 172.
V Demisting and defrosting 3
see pages 19, 163, 166, 174.
ß Heated seats 3
see page 160.
Astra TwinTop 3
> Open roof
see page 149.
< Close roof
see page 149.
" Central switch
window operation,
opening
see page 144.
" Central switch
window operation,
closing
see page 144.
Sun roof 3
ü Sun roof:
opening or tilting – see page 147.
d Sun roof:
closing – see page 147.
G Sunblind:
opening – see page 147.
H Sunblind:
closing – see page 147.
Windscreen wiper
Stalk positions–
see pages 17, 18
§ Off,
$ Timed interval wipe, or
automatic wipe
with rain sensor 3,
% Slow
& Fast
13In Brief
Cruise control 3
Buttons on turn signal stalk
see pages 16, 216.
m Activate, store,
accelerate,
g Resume
stored speed,
decelerate,
§ Deactivate.
Information display,
infotainment system
Information display
see page 46.
Ö On button for date
and time, see page 48,
; Date and time setting button,
See page 48.
Remote control on steering
wheel 3,
see pages 49, 64.
Miscellaneous
p Central locking system:
locking – see page 76.
q Central locking system:
unlocking – see page 76.
m Central locking button,
see page 78.
b Vauxhall alarm system 3
see page 83.
0 Emergency operation
Open&Start system
see page 73.
z Child safety system
for rear windows 3
see page 144.
E Deflation
detection system 3,
Tyre pressure monitoring
system 3
see pages 221, 222.
r Parking distance sensor 3
see page 218.
SPORT SPORT mode 3
see page 214.
T Winter programme,
Easytronic 3,
Automatic transmission 3
see pages 182, 189, 196.
j Horn
see page 16.
+ First-aid kit (cushion) 3
see page 252.
¨ Warning triangle 3
see page 252.
14 In Brief
Steering wheel lock and ignition:
Turn key to position 1.
Move steering wheel slightly
to release lock
Positions:
0 = Ignition off
1 = Steering released, ignition off
2 = Ignition on,
with diesel engine: preheating
3=Start
To lock the steering wheel, switch ignition
off, remove key and engage steering
wheel.
6 Starting – page 22,
electronic immobiliser – page 67,
parking the vehicle – page 24.
Steering wheel lock and ignition
on vehicles with Open&Start
system 3:
Make sure electronic key
is in the interior reception
range and press the Start/Stop
button.
Release steering column lock by
moving the steering wheel
slightly.
To start the vehicle, also operate brake or
clutch pedal.
To lock the steering wheel, switch ignition
off by pressing the Start/Stop button, open
driver’s door and engage steering wheel.
Do not allow vehicle to move whilst doing
this.
6 Starting – page 22,
electronic immobiliser – page 67,
parking the vehicle – page 24.
Light switch:
7 =Off
8 = Parking lights
9 = Dipped or
main beam
AUTO = Automatic dipped
beam activation 3
Press button:
> = Fog lights3
r
= Rear fog lights
6 Lighting - Page 136,
Headlight control indicator – Page 23.
15In Brief
Dipped and main beam switch:
Main beam = Push stalk
forward
Dipped beam = Push stalk
forward again
or pull toward
steering wheel
The blue control indicator C is illuminated
when main beam is on.
Headlight flash:
Pull stalk towards steering wheel
The main beam is switched on while
activated.
To operate turn signal lights:
Right = Move stalk up
Left = Move stalk down
After operation, the turn signal stalk
returns to its starting position.
If the stalk is moved past the resistance
point, the turn signal light remains on.
When the steering wheel moves back
toward the straight-ahead position, the
turn signal light is automatically
deactivated.
Tap signal: Move stalk to resistance point
and release to activate three flashes from
the turn signals when changing lanes or the
like.
Move the stalk to the resistance point and
hold for the turn signals to flash longer.
Switch the turn signal off manually by
moving the stalk slightly.
16 In Brief
Cruise control operation 3:
Press button on stalk
Switch on: briefly press button m.
Switch off: briefly press button §.
Resume at stored speed:
briefly press button
g.
6 Cruise control 3 – page 216.
Hazard warning lights:
On = Press ¨
Off = Press ¨ again
To aid location of the pushbutton, the red
surface is illuminated when the ignition
switched on. When the button is pressed,
its control indicator flashes in time with the
hazard warning lights.
Activate horn:
Press j in centre of steering
wheel
6 Vauxhall Full Size Airbag System
– Page117,
Remote control on steering wheel 3
– Page 64.
17In Brief
Windscreen wiper:
Move lever upward
§ = Off
$ = Timed interval wipe
% = Slow
& = Fast
Lever always moves back to starting
position. Shift to next higher or lower level:
move lever slightly.
Push lever past resistance point and hold:
the windscreen wiper stages are run
through; an acoustic signal sounds at
position §.
Press lever down from position §: Single
swipe.
6 Further information – pages 303, 310.
Windscreen wiper:
adjustable wiper interval 3
To set the wiper interval to a value between
2 and 15 seconds:
Switch on ignition.
Press lever down from position §.
Wait the desired interval.
Set the lever to timed interval wipe $.
The interval time selected remains stored
until it is next changed or the ignition is
turned off.
After turning on the ignition and setting the
lever to $ , the interval is set to 6 seconds.
Automatic wiping with
rain sensor 3:
Move stalk upward
$ = Automatic wiping
with rain sensor
Automatic wiping $ : The rain sensor
detects the amount of water on the
windscreen and automatically regulates
the windscreen wiper.
To switch off, move stalk downwards
6 Further information – pages 303, 310.
18 In Brief
Operating windscreen and
headlight wash systems 3:
Pull stalk towards steering wheel
The wiper swipes for a few strokes. At low
speeds, there is a single post-wash swipe.
The headlight wash system 3 can be
operated when the lights are on. Wash
fluid is sprayed on the headlights. The
headlight wash system cannot be
operated for 2 minutes thereafter.
On vehicles fitted with rain sensor 3, keep
the sensor area clean.
6 Further information – pages 303, 310.
Activate rear wiper 3 and
wash 3:
Wiper on = Stalk
forwards
Wiper off = Stalk forwards
again
Wash = Hold stalk
fully
forwards
The rear window wiper swipes in timed
interval mode.
The rear window wiper engages
automatically when the windscreen wiper
is switched on and reverse gear is
engaged.
6 Further information – pages 303, 310.
Heated rear window,
heated exterior mirrors:
On = Press Ü
Off = Press Ü again
Heating operational only with engine
running.
The rear window and exterior mirror
heating is switched off automatically after
approx. 15 minutes.
6 Air conditioning– Page157,
Heated rear window– Page160.
19In Brief
To demist or defrost
windows:
Set air distribution to l,
rotary switch for temperature
and air flow clockwise;
Air conditioning system 3:
also press button n;
Automatic air conditioning
system 3:
press button n and v,
turn rotary switch for
temperature
clockwise, air flow to A;
Climate control system 3:
press button V
Open air vents and direct the side air vents
toward the door windows.
6 Climate control system 3 – page157.
Set automatic mode on
climate control system 3:
Press AUTO,
preselect temperature
with rotary knob,
open air vents
6 Climate control system 3 – page 171.
Information display 3 :
provides information:
–Time,
outside temperature,
–radio3 and date,
navigation 3,
telephone 3 ,
check control 3,
–trip computer3 ,
climate control system 3.
6 Information Display 3 – page 46.
Range
257
miles
Inst. consumpt.
7.6
miles/gal
19,5° 23° 5 Eco x 19:36
20 In Brief
Manual transmission:
Reverse: with the vehicle stationary, wait 3
seconds after declutching and then pull up
the button on the selector lever and
engage the gear.
If the gear does not engage, set the lever in
neutral, release the clutch pedal and
depress again; then repeat gear selection.
Easytronic 3 :
N = Idle
o =Drive position
+ = higher gear
- =lower gear
A = Change between
Automatic and
Manual mode
R = Reverse
(with selector lever lock)
The selector lever must always be moved in
the appropriate direction as far as it will
go. Upon release, it automatically returns
to the centre position. Pay heed to the
gear/mode indicator in the transmission
display.
The foot brake must be depressed when
starting.
6 Easytronic 3 – Page 178.
Automatic transmission 3 :
P = Park
R = Reverse
N = Neutral (idle)
D = Automatic gear selection
3 = 1st to 3rd gear
2 = 1st and 2nd gear
1 = 1st gear
Starting only possible in P or N . To move
from P, switch on ignition, depress foot
brake and press button on selector lever.
Press button on selector lever to engage P
or R.
P: Only with vehicle stationary, first
apply hand brake
R: Only with vehicle stationary
6 Automatic transmission 3 – page 186.
21In Brief
Automatic transmission
with ActiveSelect3 :
P = Park
R = Reverse gear
N = Neutral (idle)
D = Automatic gear selection
Selector lever in D to left:
Manual mode
+ = Higher gear or stage
- = Lower gear
or stage
P or N must be engaged when starting.
To move from P or N, switch on ignition,
depress foot brake and press button on
selector lever.
To select P or R, press button on selector
lever.
P: Only with vehicle stationary, first
apply hand brake
R: Only with vehicle stationary
6 Automatic transmission with 3
– page 192.
Exhaust gases are poisonous
Exhaust gases contain carbon monoxide,
which is extremely poisonous but is
odourless and colourless.
Therefore never inhale exhaust gases, and
never run the engine in an enclosed space.
Avoid driving with an open luggage
compartment. Otherwise, exhaust gases
could penetrate the interior.
6 Catalytic converter, exhaust – Page 207
22 In Brief
Before starting off, check:
z Tyre pressure and tyre condition –
pages 232, 333.
z Engine oil level and fluid levels in engine
compartment – see pages 297 to 305.
z All windows, mirrors, exterior lighting
and number plates are free from dirt,
snow and ice and operational.
z Do not place any objects in front of the
rear window, on the instrument panel or
in the area in which the airbags inflate.
z Seats, seat belts and mirrors are
correctly adjusted.
z Check brakes.
To start engine:
Operate clutch and brake,
automatic transmission 3 in P or
N,
Easytronic 3 : Depress brake,
do not accelerate,
Petrol engine: Turn key to 3;
Diesel engine: Turn key to 2,
when control indicator ! goes
out
1)
turn key to 3;
release key
once engine is running
Before restarting or switching off the
engine, turn key back to 0.
To switch on the ignition, only turn key to 2.
6 Electronic immobiliser – Page 67,
Diesel fuel system – Page 247.
To start engine
with Open&Start system 3:
The electronic key must be
inside the car,
operate clutch or brake,
Automatic transmission 3 in P or
N,
Easytronic 3 : Depress brake,
do not accelerate,
Petrol engine: Press button;
Diesel engine: Briefly press
button; when control indicator !
goes out
1)
press button again for
1 second;
release button once engine is
running
Press button again to repeat the starting
procedure or switch off the engine.
1)
Preheating system switches on only if outside
temperature is low.
23In Brief
To turn on the ignition, do not press the
brake or clutch pedal; just press the button
briefly.
Do not start unless vehicle is stationary.
6 Open&Start-System 3 – Page 70,
Electronic immobilizer – Page 67,
Diesel fuel system – Page 247.
Releasing the hand brake:
Raise lever slightly,
Press lock button,
Lower lever fully
To reduce operating forces, depress foot
brake at the same time.
And now "Have a good journey!"
Drive carefully, economically and with the
environment in mind. While driving, do not
do anything that could distract you.
Warning buzzers
When starting the engine or whilst driving:
z if the electronic key of the Open&Start
system3 is not present or is not
recognised,
z if seat belt is not fastened 3,
z if a door or the tailgate is ajar,
z once you have reached a certain speed if
the hand brake is applied 3,
z if a specified maximum speed is
exceeded 3.
z for Easytronic 3 - if A, M or R is selected
while the engine is running and the
driver’s door is opened but the foot
brake is not depressed.
When the vehicle is parked and the driver’s
door is opened:
z when the key is in the starter switch 3,
z with parking lights or dipped beam on,
z with Open&Start system 3 and
automatic transmission if the selector
lever is not in P
z with Easytronic 3 – if the hand brake is
not applied and no gear is engaged
when the engine is off.
24 In Brief
Indicator and warning buzzers
for Astra TwinTop 3:
z Indicator buzzer upon completed
opening or closing of the convertible
hardtop.
z Indicator buzzer upon completed raising
or lowering of the electric luggage
compartment loading aid.
z Gong tone if the boot lid is not closed
during roof operation.
z Gong tone if the boot lid is not fully
opening during operation of the luggage
compartment loading aid.
z Gong tone during roof operation if
vehicle speed exceeds 20 mph
(30 km/h).
z Gong tone when vehicle speed exceeds
20 mph (30 km/h) if the roof is not fully
open or closed.
z Three gong tones during roof or loading
aid operation if the luggage
compartment blind is not attached.
z Three gong tones during roof operation
if outside temperature is below –20 °C,
vehicle battery voltage is too low or the
system is overloaded.
z Continuous warning buzzer during roof
operation if the anti-roll bars 3 have
been triggered.
z Continuous warning buzzer starting one
minute before the end of the 9-minute
standby time with the roof in an
intermediate position.
z Continuous warning buzzer starting one
minute before the end of the 9-minute
standby time with the loading aid in a
raised position.
z Persistent warning buzzer when closing
the luggage compartment lid, if the
lowering process of the electric load aid
is not complete or has been interrupted.
Parking the vehicle:
apply hand brake firmly,
engine off,
ignition off,
lock steering wheel,
lock vehicle
To lock, press p button or with
Open&Start system 3 touch sensor in one
of the front door handles.
With Open&Start system 3, the driver’s
door must be opened to lock the steering
wheel.
25In Brief
To activate the anti-theft locking system 3
and the Vauxhall alarm system 3 press
button p twice or with Open&Start system
3 touch sensor in one of the front door
handles twice.
6 Further information – pages 67, 200,
Open&Start system – page 70,
radio remote control – page 68,
central locking system – page 76,
Vauxhall alarm system 3 – page 83,
vehicle decommissioning – page 307,
TwinTop roof operation 3 – page 148.
Advice when parking:
z Do not park the vehicle on an easy
flammable surface. The high
temperature of the exhaust system could
ignite the surface.
z Always apply the hand brake firmly.
Apply the hand brake as firmly as
possible on uphill or downhill slopes. To
reduce operating forces, depress foot
brake at the same time.
z Close the windows and sun roof 3 or
TwinTop.
z For manual transmission, select first or
reverse; for automatic transmission 3
move selector lever to P , for
Easytronic 3 select first or reverse before
switching off the ignition (note gear
display, see pages 178, 186, 193).
z On vehicles with automatic
transmission 3 the key can only be
withdrawn when the selector lever is in
position P. On the Open&Start system 3,
"P" flashes in the gear display for a few
seconds if P is not engaged or the
handbrake is not applied.
z On vehicles with Easytronic 3 control
indicator R flashes for a few seconds
after the ignition is switched off if the
hand brake has not been applied
– page 184.
z With the Open&Start system 3 the
engine can only be switched off when the
car is stationary.
z Turn steering wheel until the steering
lock perceptibly engages (theft
protection) after first withdrawing the
ignition key; for Open&Start-System 3
switch off ignition and open driver’s
door.
z The engine cooling fans may run after
the engine has been switched off
see page 297.
6 Further information – pages 306, 307.
26 In Brief
Service work,
Maintenance
We recommend that you entrust all work to
your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who
can provide you with reliable service and
correctly perform all work according to
factory instructions.
6 Vauxhall Service – page 294,
service interval display – pages 44, 296.
Genuine Vauxhall Parts and
Accessories
We recommend that you use "Genuine
Vauxhall Parts and Accessories" and
conversion parts expressly approved for
your vehicle type. These parts have
undergone special tests to establish their
reliability, safety and specific suitability for
Vauxhall vehicles. Despite continuous
market monitoring, we cannot assess or
guarantee these attributes for other
products, even if they have been granted
approval by the relevant authorities or in
some other form.
"Genuine Vauxhall Parts and Accessories"
and conversion parts approved by
Vauxhall can be obtained from your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who can
provide comprehensive advice about
permissible technical changes and ensure
that the part is installed correctly.
9 Warning
Carry out regularly the checks
recommended in the individual sections
of this Owner’s Manual.
Ensure that your vehicle is serviced at the
service intervals specified in the Service
Booklet. We recommend that you entrust
this work to your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
Have faults remedied without delay!
Consult a workshop. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. If
necessary, interrupt your journey.
6 Maintenance – page 296.
27In Brief
That was the most important
information for your first drive in
your Astra in brief.
The other pages
of this chapter
contain a summary of the
interesting functions
in your vehicle.
The remaining chapters
of the Owner’s Manual
contain important information
on operation, safety
and maintenance
as well as a complete
index.
28 In Brief
Vauxhall Full Size airbag system
The Vauxhall Full Size airbag system
comprises several individual systems.
Front airbag system
The front airbag system will be triggered in
the event of a serious accident involving a
frontal impact and forms safety cushions
for the driver and front passenger. The
forward movement of the driver and front
passenger is checked and the risk of
injuries to the upper body and head
thereby substantially reduced.
Side airbag system 3
The side airbag is triggered in the event of
a side-on collision to form a safety cushion
for the driver or front passenger in the
respective door area. This substantially
reduces the risk of injury to the upper body
and pelvis.
Curtain airbag system 3
The curtain airbag system triggers in case
of a side-on collision and provides a safety
barrier in the head area on the respective
side of the vehicle. This reduces the risk of
injury to the head considerably in case of a
side-on collision.
6 Vauxhall Full Size Airbag System
– Page 117.
Active head restraints 3 on front
seats
In the event of a rear-end impact, the
active head restraints tilt forward a little.
The head is more effectively supported by
the head restraint and the danger of
injuries caused by hyperextension in the
area of the cervical vertebrae is reduced.
Active head restraints are identified by the
lettering ACTIVE on the head restraint
guide sleeves.
6 Headrests – page 88.
29In Brief
Operating menus in
the information display 3
Menu options are selected via menus using
the buttons/four-way button or the
multifunction button of the Infotainment
system 3 or the left adjustment
wheelbuttons 3 on the steering wheel. The
respective menu options are shown on the
display.
Selection using four-way button 3
press four-way button at top, bottom, left
or right.
Selection using multifunction button 3
rotate and press multifunction button.
To exit a menu, turn the multifunction
button left or right to Return or Mainand
select.
Selection with left adjuster wheel on
steering wheel 3 turn adjuster wheel and
press.
6 Information Display – page 46.
30 In Brief
Trip computer 3
The trip computers provide information on
driving data, which is continually recorded
and evaluated electronically.
Functions:
z Range
z Instantaneous consumption
z Distance travelled
z Average speed
z Effective consumption
z Average consumption
z Stop watch
z Tyre pressure 3
6 Trip computer 3 – Pages 52, 58.
Check control 3
The check control software monitors
z Fluid levels
z Tyre pressure 3
z Radio remote control battery
z Vauxhall alarm system 3
z Important exterior lighting lights,
including cables and fuses.
6 Check Control 3Page 62.
Remote control on steering
wheel 3
The functions of the infotainment system 3
and the information display can be
operated with the remote control on the
steering wheel.
Further information is available in the
infotainment system operating
instructions.
6 Remote control on steering wheel 3
Page 64, Infotainment System – Page 65.
Range
257
miles
Inst. consumpt.
7.6
miles/gal
19,5° 23° 5 Eco x 19:36
Coolant level
check
OK
31In Brief
Twin Audio 3
Twin Audio allows rear seat occupants the
choice between the audio source played on
the infotainment system or a separate
audio source.
Only an audio source that is not currently
active on the infotainment system can be
controlled using Twin Audio.
Two headphone connections are available,
with separate volume controls.
Further information is available in the
infotainment system operating
instructions.
6 Twin Audio 3 – Page 64.
Open&Start system
with electronic key
and radio remove control 3
The Open&Start system allows the vehicle
to be locked and unlocked, including anti-
theft locking system 3 and the Vauxhall
alarm system 3 without a mechanical key
and the engine to be started and stopped
using a start/stop button. All the driver has
to do is carry the electronic key around with
him.
6 Open&Start System 3 – Page 70.
Parking distance sensor 3
When reverse gear is selected, the parking
distance sensor switches itself on
automatically.
The parking distance sensor can also be
activated at speeds of less than 15 mph (25
km/h) by pressing the
r button on the
instrument panel.
If the vehicle approaches an obstacle when
reversing, a series of signals can be heard
in the vehicle interior. The interval between
the signals becomes shorter as the
distance is reduced. If the distance is less
than 30 cm, the signal will be continuous.
6 Parking distance sensor 3 – Page 218.
32 In Brief
Sport mode 3
To activate
Press button SPORT.
SPORT mode is used to change
damping 3,steering 3, throttle application
and the shift point for Easytronic 3 and
automatic transmission 3 while driving.
Damping and steering become more direct
and provide better contact with the road
surface. The engine reacts more quickly to
accelerator movements.
With Easytronic 3 and automatic
transmission 3, the shift times are
shortened and shifting takes place at
higher revs (not with cruise control
enabled 3).
6 Sport mode 3 – Page 214.
Tyre pressure loss
monitoring system
(DDS = Deflation Detection
System) 3
The deflation detection system
continuously monitors the speed of all
wheels while driving. If a tyre loses
pressure, it grows smaller and therefore
rotates more quickly than the other wheels.
If the system detects a difference in speed,
the control indicator
w illuminates in red.
After tyre pressure is corrected or a tyre or
wheel is changed, the system must be
initialised by pressing the DDS button.
6 Tyre deflation detection system 3
– Page 221.
33In Brief
Tyre pressure monitoring
system 3
The tyre pressure monitoring system
continually checks the pressure and speed
of all four wheels while driving.
A pressure sensor is installed in each wheel.
The inflation pressures of the individual
wheels are transmitted to a controller,
where they are compared.
The current tyre pressures can be
displayed on the graphical information
display or the colour information display 3.
Deviating tyre pressures are displayed in
the form of messages on the information
display whilst driving.
6 Tyre pressure monitoring system 3
– Page 221.
Ü Board Computer
BC 1
BC 2
Timer
Tyres
Adaptive Forward Lighting
(AFL) 3
improves lighting in curves (curve lighting)
on vehicles with Bi-Xenon headlight
system.
Curve lighting
The Xenon light beam pivots based on
steering wheel position and speed (from
approx. 6 mph /10 km/h).
Motorway lighting
At higher speeds and continuous straight
ahead travel, the dipped beam
automatically raises slightly, thereby
increasing headlight range.
6 Adaptive driving lights 3 – Page139.
34 In Brief
Panoramic windscreen 3
To open:
Turn the handle to the right and move the
roof lining rearward to a suitable position.
To close:
Move the roof lining forward to a suitable
position. When moved all the way forward,
the roof lining engages in position.
6 Panoramic roof 3 – Page 146.
Adjusting the rear row of seats 3
z Pull the handle below the seat
z Slide the seat bench to the desired
position
z Release the handle and engage the seat
bench
6 Adjusting the rear row of seats 3
–Page 90.
Cargo box 3
Collapsible box to divide the luggage
compartment.
The cargo box may only be loaded when
the backrests are engaged in an upright
position.
When removing, start with the right half.
6 Cargo Box 3 – Page 103.
35In Brief
FlexOrganizer 3
The side walls contain retaining strips,
where various components can be
attached to divide the luggage
compartment or fasten loads.
The system consists of
z adapters
z variable partition net
z mesh pockets for the side walls
z hooks in the luggage compartment
6 FlexOrganizer 3 – Page 102.
Luggage compartment cover,
Estate
To open:
Press handle on luggage compartment
cover down. The cover automatically
unrolls.
6 Luggage compartment cover 3
– Page 98.
Astra TwinTop
With TwinTop, a convertible hardtop, Astra
unites the benefits of a coupe with those of
a convertible.
To optimise safety, the Astra TwinTop is
equipped with a rollover protection system
with reinforced windscreen frame and the
choice of fixed or deployable anti-roll bars
in addition to the front and side airbag
systems.
The roof is operated with the buttons on
the roof console above the mirror or with
the remote control.
To improve luggage compartment
accessibility, the electric loading aid makes
it possible to raise the open roof when it is
stowed in the luggage compartment.
6 TwinTop – see page 148.
36 Instruments
Instruments
Control indicators ................................ 36
Instrument display............................... 43
Information display ............................. 46
Radio reception 3................................ 64
Remote control on steering wheel 3.. 64
Twin Audio 3 ....................................... 64
Mobile telephones and radio
equipment 3...................................... 65
Infotainment system 3........................ 65
Control indicators
The control indicators described here are
not present in all vehicles. The description
applies to all instrument versions.
The control indicator colours mean:
z Red Danger, important reminder,
z Yellow Warning, note, fault,
z Green Engagement confirmation,
z Blue Engagement confirmation.
0
Open&Start system 3
Control indicator lights or flashes yellow.
If it flashes
System has not detected electronic key in
vehicle interior. The reasons for this may
be:
If the battery in the electronic key needs
changing, InSP3 appears in the service
display or, in vehicles with check control 3,
by an appropriate message in the
information display – pages 44, 74.
The electronic key is in the wrong
location in the vehicle interior (do
not put key in luggage
compartment or in front of
information display), or the
electronic key is not in the vehicle
interior, or influence from an
external interference source (radio
masts, interfering transmitters in the
vicinity).
or –
Electronic key failure, for emergency
operation – page 73.
37Instruments
lights
Fault in Open&Start system.
Lock or unlock vehicle using remote control
or emergency key if necessary – page 80,
or attempt to use the spare key.
Emergency operation – page 81.
If
0 illuminates, this can also mean that
the steering wheel lock is still locked: move
steering wheel to and fro a little and press
Start/Stop button again.
If
0 illuminates whilst driving a system
error has occurred that may eventually
lead to a complete failure.
If
0 illuminates or flashes: The Start/Stop
button must be held depressed somewhat
longer to switch off the ignition. It is
possible that the vehicle will not start
during the next start attempt.
If
0 continues to flash or remains
illuminated, consult a workshop
immediately. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
I
Engine oil pressure
Control indicator lights red.
It illuminates when the ignition is switched
on and goes out shortly after the engine
starts.
Illuminates when the engine is running
Engine lubrication may be interrupted. This
may result in damage to the engine and/or
locking of the drive wheels:
1. Depress clutch.
2. Shift manual transmission or
Easytronic 3 into neutral; for automatic
transmission 3 , set selector lever to N.
3. Move out of the flow of traffic as quickly
as possible without impeding other
vehicles.
4. Switch off ignition.
Consult a workshop. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
9 Warning
When the engine is off, considerably
more force is needed to brake and steer.
Do not remove key until vehicle has come
to a standstill, otherwise the steering
column lock could engage unexpectedly.
38 Instruments
R
Brake system,
clutch system
Control indicator lights or flashes red.
It illuminates after the ignition is turned on,
when the hand brake is applied or if the
brake or clutch fluid level is too low. For
further information – pages 226, 302.
For vehicles with Easytronic 3, the control
indicator flashes for a few seconds when
the ignition is turned off if the hand brake
is not applied.
9 Warning
If it illuminates when the hand brake is
not applied: Stop the vehicle; interrupt
your journey immediately. Consult a
workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
v
Airbag systems 3,
belt tensioners 3
,
deployable anti-roll bars 3
Control indicator lights red.
Illuminates when the engine is running
Fault in airbag system, belt tensioners or
roll-over protection, – pages 113, 123, 132.
v
Electronic
Stability Programme (ESP ®
Plus
) 3
Control indicator flashes or lights yellow.
Flashing during driving
System actively engaged,
– page 212, 213.
Illuminates while driving
System switched off or fault in system for
Electronic Stability Program, – page 213.
X
Seat belt 3
Control indicator lights or flashes red.
It lights after the ignition is turned on until
the seat belt is fastened. When driving
begins, the control indicator flashes. Apply
seat belt – page 115.
39Instruments
Q
Door open
Control indicator lights red.
It is illuminated when a door or the luggage
compartment is open.
p
Alternator
Control indicator lights red.
It illuminates when the ignition is switched
on and goes out shortly after the engine
starts.
Illuminates when the engine is running
Stop, switch engine off. Battery is not
charged. Engine cooling may not be
operating. With a diesel engine the brake
servo unit may stop operating. Consult a
workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
W
Coolant temperature
Control indicator lights red.
Illuminates when the engine is running
Stop and switch off engine. Coolant
temperature too high: Danger of engine
damage. Check coolant level immediately
– page 300.
A
Engine electronics, transmission
electronics 3 ,
immobiliser, diesel fuel filter 3
Control indicator lights or flashes yellow.
It illuminates for a few seconds when the
ignition is switched on.
Illuminates when the engine is running
Fault in engine electronics or transmission
electronics. Electronics switch to
emergency running programme, fuel
consumption may increase and driveability
of the vehicle may be impaired – page 210.
Consult a workshop immediately. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
Illuminated
together with InSP4 in the
service display: Have the diesel fuel filter
drained of water – page 300.
Flashes when the ignition is on
Fault in the electronic immobiliser system;
the engine cannot be started – page 67.
j
Easytronic 3,
start engine
Control indicator lights yellow.
It illuminates if the foot brake is not
operated. The indicator goes off as soon as
the foot brake is operated. The engine can
only be started with the foot brake
operated, page 179.
IDS+
Interactive Driving System 3,
Continuous Damping Control (CDC) 3 ,
SPORT mode 3
Control indicator lights yellow.
It illuminates for a few seconds when the
ignition is switched on.
Illuminates while driving
System fault. Consult a workshop. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
IDS+ – page 212, CDC – page 214, SPORT
mode – page 214.
40 Instruments
S
Engine oil level 3
Control indicator lights yellow.
The engine oil level is checked
1)
automatically.
Illuminates when the engine is running
Engine oil level too low. Check engine oil
level and top up engine oil if necessary, –
page 298.
8
Exterior lights
Control indicator lights green.
It is illuminated when the exterior lights are
on – see page 136.
r
Parking distance sensor 3 
Control indicator lights yellow.
System fault. Consult a workshop. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
Parking distance sensor – page 218.
1)
Not on Z 14 XEP or Z 20 LEH engine. Sales
designation – see page 314.
O
Turn signal lights
Control indicator flashes green.
The corresponding control indicator
flashes on the side of the direction
indicators selected.
Both control indicators flash with the
hazard warning lights on.
Fast flashing: failure of a direction
indicator light or associated fuse, failure of
direction indicator light on trailer 3.
Change bulbs – page 274.
Fuses – page 266.
Y
Fuel level
Control indicator lights or flashes yellow.
lights
Low fuel level, fuel gauge in reserve area.
Flashing
Fuel supply exhausted, refuel immediately.
Never let the tank run dry!
Erratic fuel supply can cause catalytic
converter to overheat, – page 207.
Diesel engines: If the tank is run dry, bleed
the fuel system as described on page 247.
41Instruments
>
Fog lights 3
Control indicator lights green.
It is illuminated when the fog lights are on
– page 137.
C
Main beam
Control indicator lights blue.
It is illuminated when main beam is on and
during headlight flash – page 15.
r
Fog tail light
Control indicator lights yellow.
It is illuminated when the rear fog lights are
on – page 137.
T
Winter programme of
automatic transmission 3 or
Easytronic 3
Symbol lights in gear display with Winter
programme engaged.
Further information – pages 182, 189, 196.
1
SPORT mode of
automatic transmission 3
or Easytronic 3
Symbol lights in gear display with Sport
programme engaged.
Further information – pages 181, 188, 195.
y
Seat occupancy recognition 3
Symbol lights or flashes in kilometre
display.
lights
Seat occupancy recognition has detected
a child restraint system with transponders.
Airbag systems for the passenger are
deactivated – page 124.
Flashing
: Fault in system or child seat with
transponder not correctly fitted
– page 124.
Z
Exhaust emission 3
Control indicator lights or flashes yellow.
It illuminates when the ignition is switched
on and goes out shortly after the engine
starts.
Illuminates when the engine is running
Fault in emission control system. The
permitted emission limits may be
exceeded. Consult a workshop. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
If it flashes when the engine is running:
Fault that can lead to destruction of the
catalytic converter is indicated – page 209.
Consult a workshop immediately. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
u
Anti-lock brake system (ABS) 3
Control indicator lights red.
Illuminates while driving
Fault in antilock braking system
– page 228.
42 Instruments
!
Preheating system 3,
Diesel particle filter 3
Control indicator lights or flashes yellow.
lights
Preheating system active, switches on only
if outside temperature is low.
Flashing
(in vehicles with diesel particle
filter)
Diesel particle filters require cleaning. As
soon as the road and traffic situation
permits, briefly increase speed to greater
than 25 mph (40 km/h). The control
indicator goes off as soon as cleaning is
complete.
w
Deflation detection system 3, tyre
pressure monitoring system 3
Control indicator lights red
Tyre pressure loss – page 221.
Control indicator lights yellow
Fault in system – pages 221, 222. Consult a
workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
B
Adaptive Forward Lighting 3
(AFL)
Control indicator lights or flashes yellow.
lights
System fault. Consult a workshop. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
Flashing
System converted to symmetrical dipped
beam.
AFL – page 139.
m
Cruise control 3
Control indicator lights green.
It is illuminated when the system is on
– page 216.
43Instruments
Instrument display
On some versions, the pointer of the
tachometer, speedometer and fuel gauge
briefly moves to its end position when the
ignition is switched on.
Tachometer
Indicates engine speed.
Warning zone: Maximum permissible
engine speed exceeded; danger to engine.
Speedometer
Speed display.
Fuel gauge
Never run the tank dry!
Diesel engines: If the tank is run dry, bleed
the fuel system as described on page 247.
Because of the fuel remaining in the tank,
the amount of fuel required to fill the tank
may be less than the specified tank
capacity.
Pointer in left
zone or Y
illuminated
= Reserve area
Pointer in left
zone or Y
flashing
= Fill up – page 205
44 Instruments
Odometer display
Top line:
Trip odometer or clock display
3
To switch between the trip odometer and
the clock display 3, press reset knob
briefly, see previous page.
Trip odometer
Display of miles covered since reset.
To reset, hold reset button down for
around one second with the ignition turned
on, see previous page.
If the clock display is activated, first switch
to trip odometer.
Time display
3
To adjust the time, setting knob in
instrument:
Bottom line:
Odometer
Records the miles counted.
Service Display
InSP Service interval display.
Shows remaining distance
until next service.
Further information – page 296.
InSP2 Bulb failure 3 – page 274.
InSP3 Low battery voltage for remote
control
or electronic key
for Open&Start System
3, - pages 69, 74.
InSP4 Water in diesel fuel filter 3.
Contact your workshop.
We recommend your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
On vehicles with check control 3 , a
message is shown on the display instead of
InSP2 and InSP3.
Press for approx. 2 seconds:
Hours flash
Press briefly
Set hours
Press for approx. 2 seconds
Minutes flash
Press briefly
Set minutes
Press for approx. 2 seconds
Clock is started.
45Instruments
ESPoff Electronic Stability
Program 3
deactivated –
see page 212.
ESP on Electronic Stability
Program 3
activated –
see page 212.
Transmission display 3
Display of gear selected
on automatic transmissions 3
or current gear or mode for Easytronic 3:
P Park position of automatic
transmission.
R Reverse gear.
N Neutral or idling position.
A Automatic mode, Easytronic.
M Manual mode, Easytronic.
D Automatic mode,
automatic transmission.
1-4 Current gear, automatic
transmission.
1-5 or
1-6 3 current gear, Easytronic,
manual mode.
For Easytronic 3 , the display flashes for a
few seconds if A, M or R is selected when
the engine is running but the foot brake is
not depressed.
46 Instruments
Information display
Triple information display
Display of time, outside temperature and
date/infotainment system (when it is on).
When the ignition is off, the time, date and
outside temperature can be presented for
15 seconds by briefly pressing one of the
two buttons below the display.
An F in the display indicates a fault. Have
the cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
Board information display 3
Display of time, outside temperature and
date/infotainment system (when it is on).
An F in the display indicates a fault. Have
the cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
Graphical information display 3,
Colour information display 3
Display of time, outside temperature, date/
infotainment system (when it is on) and
climate control system 3.
The graphical information display presents
the information in monochrome. The colour
information display presents the
information in colour.
12:01 17,0°C
FM 3 90,6MHz
REG AS RDS TP
11:25} 21.5°C
Range
RDS [TP]
257km
Range
257
miles
Inst. consumpt.
7.6
miles/gal
19,5° 23° 5 Eco x 19:36
47Instruments
The type of information and how it is
displayed depends on the equipment of
the vehicle and the settings of the trip
computer 3, climate control system 3 and
infotainment system 3.
Some information appears in the display in
an abbreviated form.
Climate control system – page 171.
Infotainment system – see infotainment
system instructions.
An F in the display indicates a fault. Have
the cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
Outside temperature
A fall in temperature is indicated
immediately and a rise in temperature
after a time delay.
If outside temperature drops to 3 °C, the
symbol : illuminates in the triple
information display or the board
information display 3 as a warning for icy
road surfaces. : remains illuminated until
temperatures reach at least 5 °C.
In vehicles with graphical information
display 3 or colour information display 3,
a warning message appears the display as
a warning for icy road surfaces. There is no
message below -5 °C.
8:56 -5,5°C
07.04.2004
:
9 Warning
Caution: The road surface may already
be icy even though the display indicates
a few degrees above 0 °C.
Slippery road
-2,5°C
OK
48 Instruments
Triple information display
Set date and time
Infotainment system off: press Ö and ;
below the display as follows:
Correcting time
3
Some RDS transmitters do not send a
correct time signal. If the incorrect time is
continually displayed, switch off automatic
time synchronisation 3 and set the time
manually - see next column.
The automatic setting is indicated by } in
the display.
Deactivating/activating automatic time
synchronisation: infotainment system off,
press Ö and ; below the display:
Press Ö for approx. 2 seconds:
Day flashes
;:Set day
Ö:Month flashes
;:Set month
Ö:Year flashes
;:Set year
Ö:Hours flash
;: Set hours
Ö:Minutes flash
;:Set minutes
Ö:Clock is started.
8:56 5,5°C
07.04.2004
Hold down Ö for approx. 2 sec., clock
display is now in setting mode.
Press Ö twice (until year flashes).
Press Ö and hold down for approx.
3 seconds until } flashes in display 3
and "RDS TIME" appears (years flash
during this time).
Press ;, display indicates:
RDS TIME 0 = Off.
Press ;, display indicates:
RDS TIME 1 = On.
Press Ö three times.
49Instruments
Board information display 3,
Selecting functions
Functions and settings of some
equipment 3 can be accessed via the
board information display.
This is done via the menus and the buttons/
four-way button on the infotainment
system 3 or with the left adjuster wheel 3
on the steering wheel. The relevant menu
options are then shown in order on the
display.
Select options via the menus and with the
buttons/four-way button on the
infotainment system 3.
Depending on the equipment level of the
vehicle, menu options can be selected with
the left adjuster wheel 3 on the steering
wheel. The relevant menu options are then
shown in order on the display.
If check control 3 issues a warning
message, the display is blocked from other
functions. Acknowledge the message by
pressing the four-way button to the right or
left or by pressing the left adjuster wheel 3
on the steering wheel. If there are several
warning messages, acknowledge them one
at a time.
System settings – page 50.
Trip computer – page 52.
11:25} 21.5°C
Range
257miles
50 Instruments
Board information display 3,
System settings
Press the Settings button of the
infotainment system. Menu item Audio or
System will appear.
Press the lower button of the four-way
button to reach menu item System. After
pressing the right-hand part of the four-
way button, the first function of the System
menu is shown.
Some information appears in the display in
an abbreviated form.
The functions are displayed in the following
order:
z Time synchronisation
z Time, setting hours
z Time, setting minutes
z Date, setting day
z Date, setting month
z Date, setting year
z Ignition logic
z Language selection
z Setting units of measure
Correcting time 3
Some RDS transmitters do not send a
correct time signal. If the incorrect time is
continually displayed, deactivate
automatic time synchronisation 3 and set
the time manually - see next page.
11:25} 21.5°C
System
11:25} 21.5°C
Clock Sync.On
51Instruments
The automatic setting is indicated by } in
the display.
To correct time with the help of RDS, select
the menu item for time synchronisation
from the Settings menu.
Make the desired setting.
Setting date and time
Select the menu item for time and date
setting from the Settings menu.
Make the desired setting.
The setting is saved when the menu item is
exited.
Ignition logic 3
See infotainment system instructions.
Language selection
You can select the display language for
some functions.
Select the menu item for language from the
Settings menu and make the desired
setting.
Setting units of measure
You can select which units of measure are
to be used.
Select the menu item for units of measure
from the Settings menu and confirm the
desired setting.
11:25} 21.5°C
English
11:25} 21.5°C
Unit Europe-SI
52 Instruments
Board information display 3, trip
computer 3
The trip computer provides information on
driving data, which is continually recorded
and evaluated electronically.
Access trip computer vehicle data by
pressing the BC button on the infotainment
system or the left adjuster wheel 3 on the
steering wheel.
Some information appears in the display in
an abbreviated form.
Once an audio function has been selected,
the subsequent rows of the trip computer
function are displayed.
The functions are displayed in the following
order:
z Instantaneous consumption
z Average consumption
z Effective consumption
z Average speed
z Distance travelled
z Range
z Stop watch
Instantaneous consumption
Display changes depending on speed:
Display in gal/h below 8 mph (13 km/h).
Display in mpg above 8 mph (13 km/h).
Average consumption
Display of average consumption. The
measurement can be reset at any time and
restarted, see "Reset".
Effective consumption
Display of fuel used. The measurement can
be reset at any time and restarted, see
"Reset".
Average speed
Display of average speed. The
measurement can be reset at any time and
restarted, see "Reset".
Stoppages in the journey with the ignition
off are not included in the calculations.
Distance travelled
Display of miles travelled. The
measurement can be reset at any time and
restarted, see "Reset".
11:25} 21.5°C
Inst. Consumpt.
7.6l/100km
53Instruments
Range
Range is calculated from current fuel tank
content and instantaneous consumption.
The display shows average values.
After refuelling, the vehicle updates the
range automatically after a brief delay.
If less than 30 miles (50 km) can be driven
with the fuel remaining in the tank, the
warning " Range"appears on the display.
If less than 20 miles (30 km) can be driven
with the fuel remaining in the tank, the
warning " Refuel!" 3 appears on the
display.
Acknowledge the menu item as described
on page 54.
Reset:
Reset trip computer information
The following trip computer information
can be rest (reset and restart
measurements or calculations):
z Average consumption
z Effective consumption
z Average speed
z Distance travelled.
Select the desired trip computer
information.
Reset by pressing left adjuster wheel 3 on
steering wheel or by pressing the four-way
switch to the left or right:
Press for more than
2 seconds current value
Press for more than
4 seconds All values.
Stop watch
Select function, operate with four-way
switch:
Press right button
Start/Stop
Press left button
at least 2 seconds Reset
Operating using the left adjuster wheel 3
on the steering wheel:
Press
Start/Stop.
Interruption of power supply
If the power supply has been interrupted or
if the battery voltage has dropped too low,
the values stored in the trip computer will
be lost.
11:25} 21.5°C
Range
257km
11:25} 21.5°C
Stop Watch
01:22:32h
54 Instruments
Graphical information display 3
or
colour information display 3
Selecting functions
The functions and settings of some
equipment 3 can be accessed via the
graphical information display or the colour
information display.
These functions are marked or executed in
the menu display via the four-way switch,
the multifunction knob 3 on the
Infotainment System or the left adjuster
wheel 3 on the steering wheel.
To select with four-way button:
Select menu items via menus and with the
buttons/four-way button of the
infotainment system.
If check control 3 issues a warning
message, the display is blocked from other
functions. Acknowledge the message by
pressing the right or left portion of the four-
way button. If there are several warning
messages, acknowledge them one at a
time.
To select using the multifunction button:
Turn
Mark menu items
or commands, select
functions
Press
Select marked item,
confirm command.
To exit a menu, turn the multifunction
button left or right to Return or Mainand
select.
If check control 3 issues a warning
message, the display is blocked from other
functions. Acknowledge the message by
pressing the multifunction button. If there
are several warning messages,
acknowledge them one at a time.
Range
257
miles
Inst. consumpt.
7.6
miles/gal
19,5° 23° 5 Eco x 19:36
55Instruments
Select using the left adjuster wheel 3 on
the steering wheel:
Turn up
Previous
menu item
Turn down
Next
menu item
Press
Select marked item,
confirm command.
If check control 3 issues a warning
message, the display is blocked from other
functions. Acknowledge the message by
pressing the left adjuster wheel. If there are
several warning messages, acknowledge
them one at a time.
For each functional area there is a main
page (Main), which is selected at the top
edge of the display (not with the
Infotainment system CD 30 or the Mobile
Phone Portal):
z Audio
z Navigation 3,
z Telephone 3,
z Trip computer 3.
For Audio, Navigation 3 and Telephone 3
functions – see infotainment system
instructions.
System settings
The settings are accessed via the Settings
menu.
Press the Main button 3 (not found on all
infotainment systems) on the infotainment
system (call up main display).
Press the Settings button of the
infotainment system. On Infotainment
System CD 30, make sure no menu has
been selected.
The Settings menu is displayed.
FM AS [TP] REG CDin MP3
90.6
MHz
19,5° 19:36
7 Settings 19,5° 19:36
Time, Date 19:36
Language
Units 10 . 07 . 2004
Contrast
Day / Night
6 Ign. logic
56 Instruments
Setting the date and time 3
Select menu item Time, Date, from the
Settings menu.
The menu for Time, Date is displayed.
Select the menu items required:
Make the desired setting.
Correcting time
3
In systems with GPS receiver
1)
, date and
time are set automatically upon receipt of
a GPS satellite signal. If the displayed time
does not match local time, it can be
corrected manually or automatically by
receiving an RDS time signal
2)
3.
Some RDS transmitters do not send correct
time signals. If the incorrect time is
displayed often, deactivate automatic
time synchronisation 3 and set the time
manually.
To correct time with the help of RDS, select
menu item Synchron. clock automatical.
from the Time, Date menu.
The box in front of Synchron. clock
automatical. will be ticked;
see Fig. 17340 T.
Language selection
You can select the display language for
some functions.
Select menu item Languagefrom the
Settings menu.
The available languages are displayed.
7 Time, Date 19,5° 19:36
Time 19:36
Date 10 . 07 . 2004
6 Synchron. clock automatical.
1)
GPS = G lobal P ositioning S ystem,
Satellite system for world-wide positioning.
2)
RDS = R adio D ata S ystem.
7 Settings 19,5° 19:36
Time, Date
Language Deutsch
Units English
Contrast Español
Day / Night ...
6 Ign. logic
57Instruments
Select the desired language.
Selections are indicated by a 6 in front of
the menu item.
In systems with voice output 3, when the
language setting of the display is changed
the system will ask whether the
announcement language should also be
changed – see Infotainment system
instructions.
Setting units of measure
You can select which units of measure are
to be used.
Select menu item Units from the Settings
menu.
The available units are displayed.
Select the desired unit.
Selections are indicated by a o in front of
the menu item.
Adjusting contrast 3
(graphical information display)
Select menu item Contrastfrom the
Settings menu.
The menu for Contrast is displayed.
Confirm the required setting.
7 13 Languages 19,5° 19:36
X Deutsch
English
Español
Dutch
French
Italiano
7 Settings 19,5° 19:36
Time, Date
Language
~ Europe-SI
Units
| Japan
Contrast
| Great Britain
Day / Night
| USA
6 Ign. logic
7 Contrast 19,5° 19:36
12
58 Instruments
Setting display mode 3
The display can be adjusted to suit the light
conditions, black or coloured text on a light
background or white or coloured text on a
dark background.
Select menu item Day / Night from the
Settings menu.
The options are displayed.
Automatic: adapted based on vehicle
lighting.
Always day design: black or coloured text
on light background.
Always night design: white or coloured
text on dark background.
Selections are indicated by a o in front of
the menu item.
Ignition logic 3
See infotainment system instructions.
Graphical information display 3
or
Colour information display 3, Trip
computer 3
The trip computers provide information on
driving data, which is continually recorded
and evaluated electronically.
The trip computer main page provides
information on range and instantaneous
consumption.
To display other trip computer data, press
the BC button on the infotainment
system 3, select the trip computer menu
front the display or press the left adjuster
wheel 3 on the steering wheel.
Range
Range is calculated from current fuel tank
content and instantaneous consumption.
The display shows average values.
After refuelling, the vehicle updates the
range automatically after a brief delay.
Ü Board Computer 19,5° 19:36
BC 1 All values
BC 2
257.0 miles
Timer
Ø40mph
Tyres
31.0 gal
Ø 7.0 miles/gal
Range
257
miles
Inst. consumpt.
7.6
miles/gal
19,5° 23° 5 Eco x 19:36
59Instruments
If the fuel in the tank will allow less than
30 miles (50 km) of travel, the warning
"Range" appears on the display.
If less than 20 miles (30 km) can be driven
with the fuel remaining in the tank, the
warning " Please refuel!" 3 appears on the
display.
Acknowledge the menu item as described
on page 54.
Instantaneous consumption
Display changes depending on speed:
Display in gal/h below 8 mph (13 km/h).
Display in mpg above 8 mph (13 km/h).
Distance travelled
Display of miles travelled. The
measurement can be reset at any time and
restarted, see "Reset".
Average speed
Calculation of average speed. The
measurement can be reset at any time and
restarted, see "Reset".
Stoppages in the journey with the ignition
off are not included in the calculations.
Effective consumption
Display of fuel used. The measurement can
be reset at any time and restarted, see
"Reset".
Average consumption
Calculation of average consumption. The
measurement can be reset at any time and
restarted, see "Reset".
Reset:
Reset trip computer information
The following trip computer information
can be reset (restart measurements):
z Distance
z Average speed
z Effective consumption
z Average consumption.
Select BC 1 or BC 2 from the trip computer
menu.
Range
33miles
OK
Ü Board Computer 19,5° 19:36
BC 1 All values
BC 2
257.0 miles
Timer
Ø40mph
Tyres
31.0 gal
Ø 7.0 mpg
60 Instruments
The information of the two trip computers
can be reset separately, making it possible
to evaluate data from different time
periods.
Select the desired trip computer
information.
The value for the selected function will be
reset and recalculated.
To reset all information of a trip computer,
select menu item All values.
After resetting, "- - -" is displayed for the
trip computer information selected. The
recalculated values are displayed after a
brief delay.
Interruption of power supply
If the power supply has been interrupted or
if the battery voltage has dropped too low,
the values stored in the trip computer will
be lost.
Ü Reset BC 1 19,5° 19:36
All values
257.0 miles
Ø40mph
31.0 gal
Ø 7.0 miles/gal
Ü Reset BC 1 19,5° 19:36
All values
257.0 miles
Ø40mph
31.0 gal
Ø 7.0 miles/gal
61Instruments
Stop watch
Select menu item Timer from the Board
Computer menu.
The Timer menu is displayed.
To start, select menu item Start.
To reset, select menu item Reset.
The desired stop watch display can be
selected from the Options menu 3:
Driving Time excl. Stops
The time the vehicle is in motion is
recorded. Stationary time is not included.
Driving Time incl. Stops
The time the vehicle is in motion is
recorded. The time the vehicle is stationary
with the key in the starter switch is
included.
Travel Time
Measurement of the time from manual
activation via Start to manual deactivation
via Reset.
Display of current tyre pressure 3
Select menu item Tyres from the Board
Computer menu.
The current pressure of each tyre is
displayed.
Further information – page 222.
Ü Board Computer 19,5° 19:36
BC 1
BC 2
00:00:00
Timer
Tyres Start
Reset
Options
Ü Board Computer
BC 1
BC 2
Timer
Tyres
62 Instruments
Check control 3
Check control monitors some fluid levels,
the tyre pressure 3, battery of the remote
control, the antitheft warning system 3,
the brake light switch and important
exterior lights, including cable and fuses. In
trailer mode, the trailer lighting is
monitored.
Warning messages appear on the display.
If there are several warning messages, they
are displayed one after the other.
Some of the warning messages appear on
the display in an abbreviated form.
Examples of warning messages for the
graphical information display 3 and
colour information display 3 are depicted.
On the board information display,
messages appear in an abbreviated form.
Acknowledge warning messages as
described on pages 49, 54.
Unacknowledged warning messages can
be re-displayed later.
Warning messages:
Remote Control
Battery
check
Battery voltage of remote control or
electronic key of Open&Start system too
low – page 69.
Brakelight switch
check
Fault. Brake light does not come on when
brake applied. Have cause of fault
remedied immediately. We recommend
that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
Safeguard
check
Fault. System error in Vauxhall alarm
system. Have cause of fault remedied
immediately. We recommend that you
consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Coolant level
check
OK
63Instruments
If there is a fault in the vehicle lighting, the
respective fault source is displayed as text,
e.g.:
Brakelight
check right
In vehicles with tyre pressure monitoring
system 3, if tyre pressure is too low, the
display indicates which tyre to check, e.g.:
Tyre pressure
check rear
right tyre
(value in bar)
Check tyre pressure at next opportunity
using suitable gauge. Tyre pressure
monitoring system 3 – page 222. Checking
tyre pressure – page 333.
In vehicles with tyre pressure control
system 3, if there is major loss of pressure
in a tyre, the display indicates the tyre at
fault, e.g.:
Attention!
Rear left tyre
pressure loss
(value in bar)
Stop immediately and check tyre and tyre
pressure. Tyre pressure monitoring
system 3 – page 222.
Wash
Fluid Level
check
Fluid level in windscreen wash system too
low. Topping up wash fluid – page 305.
Rear window wash system and headlight
wash system 3 are deactivated if wash
fluid level is low.
Coolant level
check
Fluid level in engine cooling system is low.
Check coolant level immediately
– page 300.
Interruption of power supply
Stored warning messages appear on the
display one after the other.
64 Instruments
Radio reception 3
Car radio reception differs from domestic
radio reception:
As the vehicle antenna is relatively near the
ground, the broadcasting companies
cannot guarantee the same quality of
reception as obtained with a domestic
radio using an overhead antenna.
z Changes in distance from the
transmitter,
z multi-path reception due to reflection
and
z shadowing
may cause hissing, noise, distortion or loss
of reception altogether.
Remote control on steering
wheel 3
The functions of the infotainment system 3
and the information display can be
operated on the steering wheel.
Further information – page 49 and the
relevant operating instructions.
Twin Audio 3
Twin Audio allows rear seat occupants the
choice between the audio source played on
the infotainment system or a separate
audio source.
Only an audio source that is not currently
active on the infotainment system can be
controlled using Twin Audio.
Two headphone connections are available,
with separate volume controls.
Further information is available in the
infotainment system operating
instructions.
65Instruments
Mobile telephones and radio
equipment 3
The Vauxhall installation instructions and
the operating guidelines provided by the
telephone manufacturer must be observed
when fitting and operating a mobile
telephone. Failure to do so could invalidate
the vehicle’s operating permit
(EU Directive 95/54/EG).
Prerequisites for fault-free operation:
z Professionally installed exterior antenna
to obtain the maximum range possible
z Maximum transmission power 10 Watt,
z Installation of the telephone in a suitable
spot (see information on page 126).
Obtain advice on predetermined
installation locations for the external
antenna and equipment holder and ways
of using devices with transmission power of
more than 10 Watts. We recommend that
you consult your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer, who will have brackets and
various installation kits available as
accessories and will install them in
accordance with regulations.
For reasons of safety, we recommend that
you do not use the phone while driving.
Even use of a handsfree set can be a
distraction while driving. Be sure to observe
any country-specific regulations.
Infotainment system 3
The infotainment system is operated as
described in the operating instructions.
9 Warning
When used in the vehicle interior, mobile
telephones and radio equipment (CB)
with integrated antenna may cause
malfunctions in the vehicle electronics.
Mobile telephones and radio equipment
(CB) should only be used with an antenna
fitted on the vehicle exterior.
66 Keys, doors, bonnet
Keys, doors,
bonnet
Replacement keys
The key number is specified in the vehicle
documents and in the Car Pass 3.
The key is a constituent of the electronic
immobiliser. Ordering keys from a Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer guarantees problem-
free operation of the electronic
immobiliser.
When electronic keys of the Open&Start
system are being replaced, all keys must be
handed to the dealer for programming.
Keep the spare key in a safe spot.
Locks – page 311,
Open&Start system, electronic keys
– page 70.
Car Pass
The Car Pass contains all of the vehicle’s
data and should therefore not be kept in
the vehicle.
Have your Car Pass on hand when
consulting a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Key with foldaway
key section 3
Press button to extend. Press button to
retract; key section engages audibly.
Electronic immobiliser.......................... 67
Radio remote control 3 with
mechanical key ................................. 68
Open&Start system 3 .......................... 70
Central locking system ........................ 76
Fault when locking or unlocking......... 80
Luggage compartment....................... 81
Vauxhall alarm system 3.................... 83
Child safety locks 3 ............................. 86
Bonnet .................................................. 86
67Keys, doors, bonnet
Electronic immobiliser
The system checks whether the vehicle may
be started with the mechanical key or
electronic key of the Open&Start system 3
that is being used. If the key is recognised
as "authorised" the vehicle can be started.
The check takes place via a transponder in
the key.
The electronic immobiliser activates itself
automatically after the key has been
removed from the ignition or, with the
Open&Start system 3, when the engine is
switched off by pressing the Start/Stop
button.
The code number of the electronic
immobiliser is given in the Car Pass.
Control indicator for immobilizer A
Control indicator A illuminates briefly
when the ignition is switched on.
If the control indicator flashes when the
ignition is on, there is a fault in the system;
the engine cannot be started. Switch off
the ignition and then repeat the start
attempt.
If control indicator A continues to flash,
try to start the engine using the spare key
and consult a workshop. We recommend
your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
If control indicator A illuminates after the
engine is started, there is a fault in the
engine electronics or transmission
electronics 3 - pages 184, 190, 198, 210 or
there is water in the diesel fuel filter 3
- page 300.
Note
The immobiliser does not lock the doors.
Therefore, after leaving the vehicle always
lock it and switch on the Vauxhall alarm
system 3 – pages 76, 83.
68 Keys, doors, bonnet
Store personal
vehicle settings in
the vehicle key 3
The last settings selected
z for the climate control system 3
z information display 3
z Infotainment system 3
z instrument illumination
are stored automatically depending on the
vehicle key used.
Different settings stored for each vehicle
key are retrieved automatically on use the
vehicle key concerned.
Each time the vehicle is locked, the settings
are saved again.
Radio remote control 3 with
mechanical key
Radio remote control in version with
Open&Start system – page 70.
The radio remote control is integrated in
the key.
Used to operate:
z central locking system,
z mechanical anti-theft locking system 3,
z Vauxhall alarm system 3.
Depending on the equipment level of the
vehicle 3 , the windows of vehicles with
electric windows in all doors 3 can be
opened or closed from outside using the
radio remote control - page 79.
On the Astra TwinTop, the roof can also be
opened or closed with the remote
control 3.
The radio remote control has a range of
approx. 5 metres. This range can be
affected by outside influences. Aim the
remote control at the vehicle to operate.
Handle the radio remote control with care,
protect it from moisture and high
temperatures and avoid unnecessary
operation.
The hazard warning lights come on to
indicate that the remote control is
operational.
69Keys, doors, bonnet
Central locking system,
mechanical anti-theft locking system 3
– page 76.
Vauxhall alarm system 3
– page 83.
Electric windows 3
– page 143.
Astra TwinTop
– page 148.
Fault
If the central locking system cannot be
operated with the radio remote control, it
may be due to the following:
z The range of the radio remote control
has been exceeded.
z Radio remote control battery voltage is
too low. Battery replacement - see next
page.
z Frequent, repeated operation of the
radio remote control outside the
reception range of the vehicle (e.g. too
far from vehicle, remote control is then
no longer recognised). Remote control
synchronisation - see next page.
z If the central locking system is
overloaded as a result of repeated
operation at short intervals. The power
supply is cut off for a brief period.
z Interference from higher-power radio
waves from other sources.
To eliminate the cause of the fault, contact
your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Open driver’s door with key, – page 80.
Remote control battery replacement
Replace the battery as soon as the range
of the radio remote control begins to
shrink.
Key with foldaway key section
Extend key, – page 66. Open radio remote
control. Replace battery - battery type,
– page 342 - noting installation position.
Close radio remote control.
Make sure that you dispose of old batteries
in accordance with environmental
protection regulations.
Key with fixed key section
Entrust battery replacement to a
workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
Radio remote control synchronisation
After a battery change, unlock the door
with the key in the lock. Synchronise by
turning on the ignition.
70 Keys, doors, bonnet
Open&Start system 3
The Open&Start system allows the vehicle
to be locked and unlocked, including the
anti-theft locking system 3 and the
Vauxhall alarm system 3, and the engine
to be started and stopped without a
mechanical key. All the driver has to do is
keep the key on his person.
Depending on the equipment level of the
vehicle 3 , the windows of vehicles with
electric windows in all doors 3 can be
opened or closed from outside using the
remote control of the electronic key
- page 79.
On the Astra TwinTop, the roof can also be
opened or closed with the remote control 3
of the electronic key.
The electronic key must be within the
external reception range about 1 metre
from the vehicle in order to lock and unlock
the vehicle.
If the electronic key is recognized as
"authorised," the vehicle can be unlocked
by pulling a door handle or the knob
beneath the tailgate handle and the doors
and the tailgate can be opened.
When the Start/Stop button is pressed, the
system re-checks the authorisation. The
electronic key has to be recognised in the
interior in order to do this. After the key has
been authorised the ignition switches on.
At the same time, the electronic
immobiliser is switched off and the electro-
mechanical steering column lock is
deactivated. Pressing the Start/Stop button
again with the brake or clutch pedal
depressed or in P or N with automatic
transmission 3 starts the engine. Press the
button for at least one second with the
vehicle stationary or hold until the engine
starts.
71Keys, doors, bonnet
If the brake or clutch pedal is depressed,
the engine can be started right away with
a single press on the Start/Stop button.
Releasing the Start/Stop button interrupts
the starting procedure.
The engine and the ignition are switched
off by pressing the Start/Stop button again.
The vehicle must be stationary. The
immobiliser is activated at the same time.
If the ignition has been switched off and
the vehicle is stationary, the steering wheel
lock activates automatically when the
driver’s door is opened or closed.
The electronic key must be within the
interior reception in order to switch the
ignition on or off. We recommend that the
driver carries the electronic key on his or
her person. If the electronic key is not
recognised, try a different position for the
key.
Do not put the electronic key in the
luggage compartment or in front of the
information display.
The vehicle is locked from the outside with
the doors closed by touching the sensor
panel in the door handle of one of the front
doors. The electronic key must be within
the external reception range of
approximately one metre from the vehicle.
The Open&Start system 3 does not the lock
the vehicle automatically if the electronic
key is outside the external reception range
of approximately one metre from the
vehicle.
Radio remote control
The vehicle can be locked and unlocked by
conventional means using the radio
remote control with the buttons on the
electronic key.
In addition, the anti-theft locking system
and anti-theft alarm system can be armed
and disabled using the radio remote
control. Depending on the equipment level
of the vehicle 3, the windows of vehicles
with electric windows in all doors 3 can be
opened or closed from outside using the
radio remote control.
6
72 Keys, doors, bonnet
The radio remote control has a range of
approx. 5 metres. This range can be
affected by outside influences. Aim the
remote control at the vehicle to operate.
Handle the radio remote control with care,
protect it from moisture and high
temperatures and avoid unnecessary
operation.
The hazard warning lights come on to
indicate that the remote control is
operational.
Central locking system,
mechanical anti-theft locking system 3
– page 76.
Anti-theft alarm system 3
– page 83.
Electric windows 3
– page 143.
Astra TwinTop
– page 148.
Control indicator for Open&Start system
0
If the control indicator flashes
0 with the
ignition switched on or with the engine
running an operating error has occurred,
e.g. the electronic key is no longer within
the reception range of the vehicle interior.
During the next starting procedure the
engine may not be able to be started. Press
Start/Stop key somewhat longer to switch
the ignition off.
Flashing of the
0 can also be an indication
of complete failure of the electronic key. In
this case operation is only possible using
the emergency facility – page 73.
InSP3 in the service display or an
appropriate message in the information 3
display indicates that the battery of the
electronic key needs replacing – page 74.
If the control indicator
0 is permanently
on, an error has occurred in the system.
Lock or unlock vehicle using the radio
remote control or the emergency key if
necessary – page 80, or try using the spare
key.
If
0 illuminates, this can also mean that
the steering wheel lock is still locked: move
steering wheel to and fro a little and press
Start/Stop button again.
Illumination of
0 whilst driving indicates a
system fault. Consult a workshop
immediately. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Emergency operation – page 73.
Lockable glove compartment,
Astra TwinTop with Open&Start system 3
In addition to the electronic key of the
Open&Start system, there is a standard key
without remote control for the glove
compartment lock.
73Keys, doors, bonnet
Emergency operation
If the Open&Start system fails or the
electronic key (control indicator
0 flashes
or permanently on) the driver’s door can be
locked or unlocked with the emergency key
in the electronic key: press locking
mechanism on underside and remove cap
toward the front by applying gentle
pressure to the cap. Push emergency key
towards the outside over the detent and
remove.
Only the driver’s door can be locked and
unlocked using the emergency key. Unlock
the entire vehicle as described on page 80.
In the version with Vauxhall alarm
system 3 the alarm may be triggered
when the vehicle is unlocked. Switch
ignition on to deactivate alarm and release
the steering column lock: hold electronic
key at marked position on the steering
column panelling and press the Start/Stop
button. Repeat procedure if necessary.
To start the engine, hold the electronic key
at the marked position, depress brake
pedal or clutch pedal or in vehicles with
automatic transmission 3 depress brake
pedal and engage P or N, Then press the
Start/Stop button.
Press start/stop button for at least 1 second
to switch the engine off. Lock all doors
except driver’s door as described on
page 80. Unlock driver’s door with
emergency key.
This facility is only intended for
emergencies. Replace battery in electronic
key at the earliest opportunity or have the
system repaired. Consult a workshop. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
74 Keys, doors, bonnet
Replacing battery in electronic key
Replace the battery immediately if the
system is no longer working properly or the
range of the radio remote control is
reducing. The need for a battery change is
indicated via InSP3 in the service display or,
in vehicles with check control 3, by an
appropriate message in the display
– page 44.
To replace the battery, press the locking
mechanism on the underside of the
electronic key and remove the cover
towards the front by applying gentle
pressure – page 73, figure 17037 T. Push
off cover with emblem on the button side
towards the outside.
Replace battery, for battery type
– page 342, pay attention to installation
position. Engage caps.
Radio remote control synchronisation
The radio remote control synchronises itself
automatically during every starting
procedure.
75Keys, doors, bonnet
Fault in Open&Start system or radio
remote control.
If the central locking cannot be operated or
the engine cannot be started, the cause
may be one of the following:
z Electronic key out of reception range, or
out of range of radio remote control,
z Radio remote control battery voltage too
low – see previous page for instructions
on how to change battery,
z Frequent, repeated operation of the
radio remote control outside the
reception range (e.g. too far from
vehicle, remote control is then no longer
recognised).
z If the central locking system is
overloaded as a result of repeated
operation at short intervals. The power
supply is cut off for a brief period.
z Interference from higher-power radio
waves from other sources.
To remedy the cause of the problem, move
electronic key or radio remote control to
another location or change the remote
control battery. If the problem persists we
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
Emergency operation, – page 73.
76 Keys, doors, bonnet
Central locking system
For doors, boot lid/tailgate and tank flap.
To unlock
Remote control with
mechanical key
Press button q on radio remote control.
To open the door, pull the handle. Open
the luggage compartment by pulling the
knob under the tailgate handle.
Open&Start system with
electronic key 3
The electronic key must be in the outer
reception range of the vehicle. The vehicle
is unlocked by pulling a door handle or
operating the button beneath the tailgate
handle
– or –
by pressing button q of the electronic
key’s remote control.
To lock
Close doors, luggage compartment and
tank flap.
Radio remote control with
mechanical key
Press button p on radio remote control.
77Keys, doors, bonnet
Open&Start system with electronic key 3
The electronic key must be outside of the
vehicle. There must not be any electronic
key in the vehicle interior. All of the doors
and the luggage compartment are locked
by touching the sensor in the handle of the
driver’s or front passenger door
– or –
by pressing button p of the electronic
key’s remote control.
Mechanical anti-theft locking system 3,
Radio remote control with
mechanical key
All doors must be closed. At the latest 15
seconds after locking, press button p of
the radio remote control again.
Lock buttons on all doors are positioned
such that doors cannot be opened.
If the ignition was on, the driver’s door
must be opened and closed once so that
the vehicle can be secured.
9 Warning
Do not use the system if there are people
in the vehicle! The doors cannot be
unlocked from inside.
78 Keys, doors, bonnet
Open&Start system with
electronic key 3
All doors must be closed. The electronic key
must be outside of the vehicle. No more
than 15 seconds after locking, touch the
sensor in the handle of the driver’s or front
passenger door again
– or –
press button p of the electronic key’s
remote control again.
If the ignition was on, the driver’s door
must be opened and closed once so that
the vehicle can be secured.
All doors are secured against opening.
Central locking button for locking and
unlocking the doors from inside the
vehicle
Press button
m in the centre console: doors
are locked or unlocked.
The LED in the central locking button
m
illuminates for around 2 minutes after
locking with the remote control.
If the doors are locked from the inside
during driving using the central locking
button, the ELD
m lights permanently.
If the key is in the ignition, locking is only
possible if all doors are closed.
When the mechanical anti-theft locking
system 3 is active – see previous page –
the doors cannot be unlocked with this
button.
79Keys, doors, bonnet
Note
z If the driver’s door is not closed properly,
the central locking system will not lock.
z To lock the doors from within
(e.g. to prevent unwanted entry from
outside), press central locking switch
m
in the centre console.
z After unlocking with the key in the lock
and opening the driver’s door, the entire
vehicle is unlocked.
z If locked via the central locking system,
the doors can also be opened by pulling
the inside door handles. The central
locking system is also unlocked at this
time (not possible on Astra TwinTop
when the roof is open).
z Locked doors unlock automatically in
the event of an accident of a certain
severity (to allow external help to gain
access). The hazard warning lights and
courtesy light also come on. For this to
occur, the key must be in the starter
switch.
z With the Open&Start system 3 the
vehicle cannot be unlocked until 2
seconds after locking. Within this time, a
door handle can be pulled or the button
beneath the tailgate handle operated to
check whether the vehicle is locked.
z The Open&Start system 3 does not lock
the vehicle automatically if the electronic
key is outside the reception range of the
vehicle (more than 1 metre away from
the vehicle).
z When using the Open&Start system 3,
there must not be an electronic key
inside the vehicle when locking.
z The locking sensors in the door handles
must be kept clean to ensure
unrestricted functionality of the
Open&Start system 3.
Operating the windows 3 from the
outside
Depending on the equipment level of the
vehicle 3 , the windows of vehicles with
electric windows in all doors 3 can be
opened or closed from outside:
6
9 Warning
Take care when operating the electric
windows. Risk of injury, particularly to
children.
Vehicle passengers should be informed
accordingly.
Keep a close watch on the windows when
closing them. Ensure that nothing
becomes trapped in them as they move.
80 Keys, doors, bonnet
Radio remote control with
mechanical key
Hold button q or p on the radio remote
control depressed until all windows have
opened or completely closed.
Open&Start system with
electronic key 3
Hold down button q of radio remote
control to open. To close, hold down button
p or touch sensor in door handle for
longer. The electronic key must be
recognised within the external reception
range. It is advisable for the driver to keep
the electronic key on his person.
Further information on windows
– page 143.
Overload
The power supply is cut off for a brief
period if the central locking system is
repeatedly operated at short intervals.
The system is protected by a fuse in the
fuse box – page 266.
Further information on windows with
electric drive – page 145.
Fault when locking or
unlocking
Fault in radio remote control or
Open&Start system.
To unlock
Turn key or emergency key for Open&Start
system – page 73 anticlockwise in the
driver’s door lock as far as it will go. Return
key to a vertical position and remove. The
entire vehicle is unlocked when the driver’s
door is opened.
81Keys, doors, bonnet
For Astra TwinTop with open roof - after
opening the driver’s door, press the central
locking button
m in the centre console. The
vehicle will then be unlocked, provided the
anti-theft locking system 3 is not
engaged. Switch on the ignition to
deactivate the Vauxhall alarm system 3.
Emergency operation of the Open&Start
system – page 73.
To lock
Open passenger door, close driver’s door,
press central locking button
m in centre
console. Central locking system locks all
doors. Close passenger door.
Malfunction in central locking system
To unlock
Turn key or emergency key with
Open&Start system – page 73, forwards in
driver’s door lock as far as it will go. Turn
key back to a vertical position and remove.
The other doors can be opened by pulling
the handle on the inside of the doors (not
possible if anti-theft locking system 3
enabled beforehand). The luggage
compartment and the fuel filler cap remain
locked. To deactivate the anti-theft locking
system 3 switch ignition on
– page 14.
To lock
Insert the key or emergency key for
Open&Start system – page 73 into the
opening above the lock on the inside of the
door and press until the lock audibly
engages. Then close the door. The
procedure must be repeated for each door.
The driver’s door can also be locked from
outside using the lock. The unlocked fuel
filler flap and tailgate/boot lid cannot be
locked.
Emergency operation of
Open&Start system 3
– page 73.
Luggage compartment
To unlock
Radio remote control with
mechanical key
Press button q on the remote control. The
luggage compartment is unlocked
together with the doors.
Open&Start system with
electronic key 3
By pulling the knob under the tailgate
handle, the luggage compartment
together with the doors is unlocked and
opened if the electronic key is detected in
the outer reception range,
– or –
press button q on the radio remote control
of the electronic key and the luggage
compartment is unlocked together with the
doors.
82 Keys, doors, bonnet
To open:
The luggage compartment is opened by
operating the button beneath the handle.
Fitting of accessories on the tailgate will
increase its weight. If it becomes too heavy,
the tailgate will then not stay open.
To close:
Close luggage compartment using the
handle on the inside of the tailgate.
Do not operate the button beneath the
handle when closing. Otherwise the
luggage compartment will once again be
unlocked.
To lock
Close doors, luggage compartment and
tank flap.
Radio remote control with
mechanical key
Press button p on radio remote control.
Open&Start system with
electronic key 3
Press button p of the electronic key radio
remote control or touch sensor in handle of
one of the front doors. The electronic key
must be recognised in the external
reception area. It is advisable for the driver
to keep the electronic key on his person.
9 Warning
Do not drive with the tailgate open or
ajar, e.g. when transporting bulky
objects, since toxic exhaust gas could
penetrate the interior.
83Keys, doors, bonnet
Vauxhall alarm system 3
monitors
z the doors, luggage compartment,
bonnet
z the passenger compartment
z vehicle tilt, e.g. if it is raised,
z the ignition.
To activate
Radio remote control with
mechanical key
All doors, windows, the sun roof 3 and the
bonnet must be closed. Within 15 seconds
of locking, press button p on the radio
remote control again.
If the ignition was switched on, the driver’s
door must be opened and closed once so
that the Vauxhall alarm system can be
switched on.
Open&Start system with
electronic key 3
The doors, the windows and the bonnet
must be closed. The electronic key must be
in the outside reception range of the
vehicle. Touch the sensor in the door
handle of the driver’s or front passenger
door again no more than 15 seconds after
locking
– or –
press button p of the electronic key’s
remote control again.
If the ignition was switched on, the driver’s
door must be opened and closed once so
that the Vauxhall alarm system can be
switched on.
9 Warning
Do not use the system if there are people
in the vehicle! The doors cannot be
unlocked from the inside.
84 Keys, doors, bonnet
Activation without monitoring of
passenger compartment and vehicle tilt
e.g. if animals are to be left in the vehicle.
1. Close tailgate and bonnet.
2. Press button
b in the roof console. The
LED in button
m flashes (max. 10
seconds) – see next column
3. Close doors.
4. Switch on Vauxhall alarm system. LED
illuminates. After approx. 10 seconds the
system is activated, without monitoring
of the passenger compartment or vehicle
tilt. LED flashes until system is switched
off.
For Astra TwinTop, passenger
compartment monitoring is deactivated if
the roof is open to prevent false alarms.
Light emitting diode (LED)
During the first 10 seconds of anti-theft
alarm system activation:
z LED illuminated = Test, switch-on
delay
z LED flashes = Door, luggage
compartment,
rapidly bonnet open,
system fault.
After the first 10 seconds of anti-theft
alarm system activation:
z LED flashes = System
slow switched on,
z LED illuminates
for approx. 1 second =Switch-off
If a system fault occurs, consult a
workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
85Keys, doors, bonnet
To deactivate
Radio remote control with
mechanical key
Press button q of the radio remote control
–or–
turn on ignition.
Open&Start system with
electronic key 3
Pulling a handle or operating the button
beneath the tailgate handle unlocks the
vehicle and disarms the Vauxhall alarm
system if the electronic key has been
recognised in the outer reception range of
the vehicle
– or –
if button q on the electronic key’s remote
control has been pressed.
In the event of a fault in the radio remote
control or the Open&Start system, open the
vehicle as described on page 80.
If the alarm is triggered when the driver’s
door is opened, deactivate the Vauxhall
alarm system by switching on the ignition.
Note
Changes to the vehicle interior, such as the
use of seat covers, could impair the
function of passenger compartment
monitoring.
Alarm
While the Vauxhall alarm system is
switched on the alarm can be triggered:
z an acoustic signal (horn) and
z a visual signal (hazard warning lights).
The number and duration of the alarms are
legally established.
The alarm is silenced by pressing a button
of the radio remote control or by switching
on the ignition. The Vauxhall alarm system
is deactivated at the same time.
86 Keys, doors, bonnet
Child safety locks 3
Using key or screwdriver, turn knob on rear
door lock from the vertical position: door
cannot be opened from inside.
Bonnet
To open the bonnet, pull the release lever
located on the driver’s side below the
instrument panel. The bonnet will then be
unlocked and will partially open. Return
release lever to its original position.
There is a safety catch on the underside of
the bonnet: lift this upwards and open the
bonnet.
Dirt on snow on the bonnet can slide onto
the windscreen when opened and block the
air intake.
Air intake – page 177.
The bonnet is held open automatically 3.
In another design, to lock the bonnet in the
open position, insert the rod lying across
the radiator into the small slot on the
bonnet underside. Press rod firmly into its
holder before closing.
Lower the bonnet and allow it to drop into
its catch.
Check that the bonnet is locked in position
by pulling at its front edge. If it is not
engaged, repeat the procedure.
9 Warning
Use the child safety lock whenever
children are occupying the rear seats.
Disregard may lead to injuries or
endanger life. Vehicle passengers should
be informed accordingly.
87Seats, Interior
Seats, Interior
Front seat adjustment
see pages 3, 4.
Seat position
Adjust driver’s seat such that with the
driver sitting upright the steering wheel is
held in the area of its upper spokes with the
driver’s arms slightly bent.
Head restraints .................................... 88
Armrest 3 at driver’s seat................... 90
Adjusting the rear row of seats 3 ...... 90
Armrest 3 in the rear backrest........... 90
Luggage compartment enlargement,
Hatch ................................................. 91
Luggage compartment enlargement,
Estate without adjustable rear row
of seats .............................................. 92
Luggage compartment enlargement,
Estate with adjustable rear row of
seats................................................... 94
Extending the luggage compartment,
Astra TwinTop................................... 97
Folding down the front passenger
seat 3................................................. 97
Luggage compartment cover ............ 98
Safety net 3, Estate............................. 99
Luggage compartment grille 3, Van. 101
Rails and hooks in the luggage
compartment 3, Estate .................... 102
FlexOrganizer 3, Estate...................... 102
Lashing eyes 3 .................................... 103
Cargo box 3......................................... 103
Luggage compartment blind, Astra
TwinTop ............................................. 104
Easy Load............................................. 104
Notes on loading the vehicle.............. 106
Cigarette lighter 3............................... 107
Accessory socket 3.............................. 107
Ashtray 3 ............................................. 108
Foldaway tables 3 .............................. 109
Stowage compartments ..................... 110
Sun visors ............................................. 110
Head restraints.................................... 88
88 Seats, Interior
Push passenger seat as far back as
possible.
The seat backrests must not be tilted too
far back (recommended tilting angle
approx. 25 °).
Head restraints
The middle of the head restraint should be
at eye level. If this is not possible for
extremely tall persons, set to highest
position, and set to lowest position for
small persons.
Removal, see page 89.
To adjust
front head restraints (all variants)
and outboard rear head restraints
Hatch and Estate
To adjust, press button on side and adjust
height.
To fold down the backrests – page 91 or
improve visibility when the rear seats are
not occupied, remove the head restraints
or push them all the way down.
If the seats are occupied, set height
according to body size.
9 Warning
Failure to observe the descriptions could
lead to injuries which could be fatal.
Vehicle passengers should be informed
accordingly before starting off.
9 Warning
Failure to observe the descriptions can
lead to injuries which could be fatal.
Vehicle passengers should be informed
accordingly before moving away.
89Seats, Interior
To adjust the
centre rear head restraint 3,
Hatch and Estate
To adjust, pull the head restraint up or
press the catch to release. Then push the
head restraint down.
To fold down the backrest – page 91 or
improve visibility when the centre rear seat
is not occupied, remove the head restraint
or push it all the way down.
If the seat is occupied, set height according
to body size.
To adjust the
rear head restraints 3, Astra TwinTop
To adjust, pull the head restraint up or
press the two catches to release. Then push
the head restraint down.
To improve visibility when the rear seats
are not occupied, push the head restraints
all the way down.
If the seats are occupied, set height
according to body size.
Do not place any objects on the cover
behind the head restraints or between the
head restraints and the anti-roll bars 3.
Removing the head restraints
Press and release the two catches. Pull and
remove the head restraint.
To fold down the backrests 3 – page 91,
push the rear head restraints all the way
down or remove.
90 Seats, Interior
Armrest 3 at driver’s seat
Push raised armrest backward against
resistance and fold down.
The armrest can be moved to different
positions in stages by lifting it.
Stowage compartment in armrest,
– page 110.
Adjusting the rear row of seats 3
Pull the handle below the seat the slide the
seat bench to the desired position.
Release the handle and engage the seat
bench.
Armrest 3 in the rear backrest
Fold down the armrest, pulling the strap
obliquely down (45°).
When the centre rear seat is in use or the
rear backrests are folded, fold the armrest
up.
A flap located behind the armrest
facilitates transport of long, narrow objects
– see page 96.
91Seats, Interior
Astra TwinTop
Pull the armrest by the strap, pivot it down
and position on the sit with the flat side up.
The armrest is held in place on the backrest
with a retaining strap. To fully remove the
armrest, disengage the bracket at the
retaining strap.
A flap located behind the armrest
facilitates transport of long, narrow objects
– page 97.
Luggage compartment
enlargement,
Hatch
Folding the backrest
Pushing rear head restraints all the way
down or remove – page 88.
Slide front seat forward slightly.
Disengage the backrest (single or split 3)
using the pushbutton and fold it down onto
the seat cushion.
Return front seat to desired position.
Fold down centre backrest 3
Push head restraint all the way down
– page 89.
Disengage backrest using handle and fold
onto seat cushion.
Folding down the centre seat backrest
makes it possible to load longer objects.
The outer seats can still be used for
occupants.
9 Warning
The load must not obstruct the operation
of the pedals, the handbrake or the gears
or restrict the driver’s freedom of
movement. Do not place loose objects in
the interior.
92 Seats, Interior
Restoring backrest to an upright position
Guide the seat belt through the side
bracket to protect against damage.
Restore the backrest to an upright position
and audibly engage.
The three-point seat belt for the centre rear
seat can only be pulled from its inertia reel
if the backrest is properly engaged.
Notes on loading
– page 106.
Luggage compartment
enlargement,
Estate without adjustable
rear row of seats
Fold the backrest onto the seat cushion
Push the rear head restraints all the way
down or remove – page 88. Detach the
hooks of the luggage compartment cover
from the head restraints – page 99.
Slide front seat forward slightly.
Disengage the backrest (single or split)
using the pushbutton and fold it down onto
the seat cushion.
Return front seat to desired position.
Raise the seat cushion and fold the
backrest
Pull the strap on the seat cushion and lift
the backrest forwards (single or split).
Detach the hooks of the luggage
compartment cover from the head
restraints – page 99.
93Seats, Interior
Remove the outer rear head restraints.
Push the centre head restraint all the way
down – page 88.
Stow the removed head restraints in the
cavity below the raised seat cushions.
Disengage the backrest (single or split)
using the pushbutton, fold it forward and
engage.
Fold down centre backrest 3
Push head restraint all the way down
– page 89.
Disengage backrest using handle and fold
onto seat cushion. If the seat cushion is
raised, fold it forward until it engages.
Folding the centre seat backrest makes it
possible to load longer objects. The outer
seats can still be used for occupants.
9 Warning
The load must not obstruct the operation
of the pedals, the handbrake or the gears
or restrict the driver’s freedom of
movement. Do not place loose objects in
the interior.
94 Seats, Interior
Restoring the backrests or seat
cushions 3 to their original position
Guide the seat belt through the side
bracket to protect against damage.
To restore the backrest to an upright
position, fold up, pressing the button on
the backrest. Audibly engage the backrest
in an upright position.
Raised seat cushions : Insert and adjust
head restraints in backrests – pages 5, 88.
Fold back seat cushions, making sure the
belt buckles are properly positioned.
Attach the hooks of the luggage
compartment cover to the head restraints
– page 99.
The three-point seat belt for the centre rear
seat can only be pulled from its inertia reel
if the backrest is properly engaged.
Safety net 3
– page 99.
Notes on loading
– page 106.
Luggage compartment
enlargement,
Estate with adjustable rear row of
seats
Fold backrests onto seat cushions
Push the rear head restraints all the way
down or remove – page 88. Detach the
hooks of the luggage compartment cover
from the head restraints – page 99.
Slide front seat forward slightly.
Disengage the backrest (single or split)
using the sliders and fold it down onto the
seat cushion.
Return front seat to desired position.
95Seats, Interior
Raise the seat cushion and fold the
backrest
Lift rear seat cushions forward, single or
split.
Detach the hooks of the luggage
compartment cover from the head
restraints – page 99.
Remove the outer rear head restraints.
Push the centre head restraint all the way
down – page 88.
Stow the removed head restraints in the
cavity below the raised seat cushions.
Disengage the backrest (single or split)
using the sliders, fold it forward and
engage.
96 Seats, Interior
Loading option behind the armrest in the
rear seat backrest 3
Fold down the armrest, pulling the strap
obliquely down (45°).
Pull the handle and fold down the cover.
Folding down the cover makes it possible
to load long, narrow objects. The outer
seats can still be used for occupants.
To restore, fold the armrest back in
position.
Restoring the backrests or seat
cushions 3 to their original position
Guide the seat belts through the side
brackets to protect against damage.
To restore the backrest to an upright
position, fold up, disengaging the backrest
at the sliders. Audibly engage the backrest
in an upright position.
Raised seat cushions : Insert and adjust
head restraints in backrests – pages 5, 88.
Fold back seat cushions, making sure the
belt buckles are properly positioned.
Attach the hooks of the luggage
compartment cover to the head restraints
– page 99.
The three-point seat belt for the centre rear
seat can only be pulled from its inertia reel
if the backrest is properly engaged.
Safety net 3
– page 99.
Notes on loading
– page 106.
9 Warning
The load must not obstruct the operation
of the pedals, the handbrake or the gears
or restrict the driver’s freedom of
movement. Do not place loose objects in
the interior.
97Seats, Interior
Extending the luggage
compartment,
Astra TwinTop
Loading area between rear seats
Pull out the armrest by the strap.
The armrest is held in place on the backrest
with a retaining strap. To fully remove the
armrest, disengage the bracket at the
retaining strap.
Pull the handle and fold down the cover.
Cover behind armrest can be locked from
luggage compartment 3 : turn handle 90°:
Locked = Handle horizontal
Unlocked = Handle vertical
Notes on loading
– page 106.
Folding down the front passenger
seat 3
Push front passenger seat head restraint
all the way down or remove – pages 5, 88.
Push front passenger seat back.
Fold front passenger seat forward by
raising release lever.
Raise front passenger seat backrest
Raise release lever and engage passenger
seat back audibly.
9 Warning
The load must not obstruct the operation
of the pedals, the handbrake or the gears
or restrict the driver’s freedom of
movement. Do not place loose objects in
the interior.
98 Seats, Interior
Luggage compartment cover
Hatch
To remove, unhook the retaining straps
from the tailgate.
Pull cover from the side guides.
Fit in reverse order.
6
Estate
To open:
Press handle on luggage compartment
cover down. The cover automatically
unrolls.
To close:
Press handle on luggage compartment
cover rearwards; the cover automatically
engages in its end position.
Do not place any heavy or sharp-edged
objects on the cover.
To cover the gap between the luggage
compartment cover and the rear
backrests, there is a cover on the cartridge.
Attach the two hooks of the cover to the
head restraint guide rods. If the safety net
is mounted, run the hooks through the net
mesh.
99Seats, Interior
Removing
Open the luggage compartment cover and
detach the hooks from the head restraints.
Move release lever on right side of luggage
compartment cover upward. Lift right
cover and remove from brackets.
Fitting
Insert the luggage compartment cover in
the recess on the left, press the release
lever on the right side upward, insert the
cover in the recess on the right, engage
and press the lever down.
Attach the hooks on the head restraints
(see Fig. 17079 T).
Safety net 3,
Estate
The safety net can be mounted behind the
rear seats or, if the rear seat backrests are
folded and the seat cushions raised,
behind the front seats.
Passengers must not be carried behind the
safety net.
Fitting behind the rear seats
Remove the luggage compartment cover -
see left column.
Unroll the safety net.
There are two brackets in the roof frame.
Hook the net rods into the brackets on one
side and then the other. Slide forward to
engage.
Fixed rear row of seats:
Extend the safety
net straps by adjusting the strap at the
upper fastener in the loop of the strap (see
Fig. 17085 T). Attach the straps in the
eyelets in the floor on the right and left.
100 Seats, Interior
Adjustable rear row of seats 3 : Extend the
safety net straps by adjusting the strap at
the upper fastener in the loop of the strap
(see Fig. 17085 T). Attach the straps in the
eyelets on the back of the right and left
rear seat backrest.
Install the luggage compartment cover -
see left column.
Fitting behind front seats
Raise the rear seat cushions – pages 92
and 95.
Unroll the safety net.
There are two brackets in the roof frame
above the front seats. Hook the net rods
into the brackets on one side and then the
other. Slide forward to engage.
Fixed rear row of seats:
Extend the safety
net straps by adjusting the strap at the
upper fastener in the loop of the strap (see
Fig. 17085 T). Attach the straps in the
eyelets in the floor on the right and left.
Adjustable rear row of seats
3 : Extend the
safety net straps by adjusting the strap at
the upper fastener in the loop of the strap
(see Fig. 17085 T). Attach the straps in the
brackets on the right and left raised seat
cushions.
Remove the outer rear head restraints and
fold the backrests forward – pages 92
and 94.
101Seats, Interior
Removing
Detach the safety net belt straps by tipping
up the length adjuster.
Unhook the safety net rods from the
brackets in the roof frame. Roll up the net
and secure with a strap.
Luggage compartment grille 3,
Van
To transport long objects, part of the
luggage compartment grille behind the
passenger seat can be opened:
Release passenger seat back and fold
forward.
Press bracket down and fold grille
section up.
Lock grille in open position.
To close the grille section from the open
position, press bracket down, fold down
grille and lock.
Check that the closed grille is properly
locked.
102 Seats, Interior
Rails and hooks
in the luggage compartment 3,
Estate
The side walls of the luggage compartment
house two rails. Insert the hooks in the
desired position in the rails: insert the hook
in the upper groove on the rail and press in
the lower groove.
Pull off the hook to remove.
FlexOrganizer 3,
Estate
Flexible system for dividing the luggage
compartment or securing loads in an
Estate.
The system consists of
z Adapters
z variable partition net
z mesh pockets for the side walls
z Hooks in the luggage compartment
Components are mounted in the two guide
rails in the side walls of the luggage
compartment by means of adapters or
hooks.
Variable partition net
Insert an adapter in each rail: Fold up
handle plate, insert adapter in upper and
lower groove of rails, move to desired
position. To lock the adapter, swivel the
handle plate up. Compress the rods of the
partition net slightly and insert in
corresponding openings of the adapter.
The longer rod must be inserted in the
upper adapter.
103Seats, Interior
Hooks and mesh pocket
Insert the hooks in the desired position in
the rails: insert the hook in the upper
groove on the rail and press in the lower
groove. The mesh pocket can be hung from
the hooks.
Removing
Press the partition net rods together and
remove from the adapters.
Adapter: fold open the retainer, release the
adapter from the lower groove and remove
from the upper groove.
Release the hooks from the rails.
Lashing eyes 3
in the luggage compartment are intended
for fixing lashing straps 3 or a luggage
net 3 . They secure transport items from
slipping.
Cargo box 3
Foldable box under the floor cover used to
divide the luggage compartment.
The cargo box may only be loaded when
the backrests are engaged in an upright
position.
To remove the cargo box floor cover,
remove first the right half then the left half.
For models with towing equipment, first
release the coupling ball bar fixing strap
and thread this through the eye
– page 242. Installation in the reverse
order.
104 Seats, Interior
Luggage compartment blind,
Astra TwinTop
To open:
Disengage the luggage compartment
blind from the recess on the right and left.
Rolls up automatically.
To close:
Grasp the handle, pull the blind towards
the rear of the vehicle and engage in the
recess on the right and left.
Do not place any objects on the blind.
There must be no objects outside of or on
top of the luggage compartment blind
when the roof is open or in the process of
opening.
The roof can only be operated with the
luggage compartment blind engaged in
the recess.
Easy Load
(Electrically operated loading aid
for the luggage compartment
of the
Astra TwinTop)
The loading aid makes it possible to
comfortably load the luggage
compartment when the roof is open. The
press of a button will raise the roof folded
up in the luggage compartment 25 cm.
This enlarges the load opening of the
luggage compartment.
z Open the boot lid.
z Unhook the luggage compartment blind
and attach it to the rear window frame.
z Briefly press button
,: The folded roof is
raised. The roof remains in this end
position for approx. 9 minutes.
105Seats, Interior
z Load luggage compartment at most to
marked load height, otherwise the roof
and load could be damaged.
z Suspend the luggage compartment
blind from the rear window frame, and
engage in recesses on right and left. The
luggage compartment blind must be
flat; objects underneath it must not push
it upwards.
z Briefly press button
,: The folded roof is
lowered.
z Close the boot lid only after the
confirmation signal has sounded.
Otherwise the roof could be damaged.
Note
z Do not place objects on or near the
luggage compartment blind.
z The folded roof can only be lowered
when the blind is closed. Otherwise, a
warning buzzer will sound three times.
z Movement can only be stopped by
pressing button
,. Holding the button
depressed will change the direction of
movement.
z A confirmation signal sounds in the
upper and lower end positions.
z Only close the boot lid once the
confirmation signal has sounded to
indicate that the loading aid is in its
lower end position.
z If the loading aid is not in its lower end
position when the boot lid is closed, a
warning tone sounds or the boot lid is
blocked mechanically 3, – page 153.
z Do not touch moving parts.
z One minute before the end of the hold
time for the raised loading aid, a
warning buzzer will sound to remind you
to lower the roof.
z The loading aid is only operable when
the vehicle is unlocked.
9 Warning
Take care when operating the loading
aid. Risk of injury.
Make sure that nothing could be pinched.
Make sure no one is in the action zone
during operation. Risk of injury.
This is especially important for children.
Inform passengers accordingly.
106 Seats, Interior
Notes on loading the vehicle
z Heavy objects in the luggage
compartment should be placed against
the engaged rear seat backrests 3 or, if
the rear seat backrests are folded down,
against the front seat backrests. If
objects are to be stacked, the heavier
objects should be placed at the bottom.
Unsecured objects in the luggage
compartment would be thrown forward
with great force in the event of heavy
braking, for example.
z Secure objects with lashing straps 3
attached to lashing eyes – see page 103.
If heavy loads slip when the vehicle is
braked heavily or driven around a bend,
the handling of the vehicle may change.
z Estate: mount the safety net 3 when
transporting objects in the luggage
compartment – page 99.
z Estate: close the luggage compartment
cover so the rear window does not reflect
the objects.
z If the backrests are not folded down
when transporting objects in the
luggage compartment, they must be
engaged in their upright position 3
– pages 92, 94, 96.
z Do not allow the load to protrude above
the upper edge of the rear seat
backrests, or above the upper edge of
the front seat backrests if the rear seat
backrests 3 are folded down.
z Astra TwinTop: Note the maximum
loading height when the roof is open
(See page 104, Fig. 17973 T).
z The warning triangle 3 and first-aid kit
(cushion) 3 must always be freely
accessible.
z Do not place any objects in front of the
rear window or on the instrument panel.
They are reflected in the glass, obstruct
the driver’s view and will be thrown
through the vehicle, for instance in the
event of heavy braking.
z The load must not obstruct the operation
of the pedals, the handbrake or the
gears or restrict the driver’s freedom of
movement. Do not place loose objects in
the interior.
z Astra TwinTop: Do not place any objects
on the cover of the deployable anti-roll
bars 3, behind the rear head restraints
or in the luggage compartment outside
of, on or next to the luggage
compartment cover.
z Do not place any objects in the
deployment area of the airbags and
deployable anti-roll bars 3 as this poses
a risk of injury should the systems be
triggered.
z Do not drive with luggage compartment
open when transporting bulky objects,
for example, since toxic exhaust fumes
could penetrate the interior.
z Weights, payload and roof load
– page 324.
z Driving with a roof load
– pages 200, 203, 238, increases the
sensitivity of the vehicle to cross-winds
and has a detrimental effect on vehicle
handling owing to the vehicle’s higher
centre of gravity.
9 Warning
Failure to observe these descriptions can
lead to injuries which may be fatal.
Vehicle passengers should be informed
accordingly.
107Seats, Interior
Cigarette lighter 3
The cigarette lighter is located under the
ashtray cover.
The cover opens when pressed at the point
indicated.
Press in cigarette lighter. Switches off
automatically once the element is glowing.
Pull out lighter.
Accessory socket 3
Some vehicles have an accessory socket for
the connection of electrical accessories
instead of a cigarette lighter. Use of the
accessory socket while the engine is not
running will discharge the battery.
108 Seats, Interior
Estates have an additional accessory
socket 3 in the luggage compartment.
Do not damage the sockets by using
unsuitable plugs.
The maximum power consumption of
electrical accessories must not exceed 120
watts.
Do not connect any current-delivering
accessories, e.g. electrical charging
devices or batteries.
Electrical accessories connected to the
socket must comply with the
electromagnetic compatibility
requirements laid down in DIN VDE 40 839,
otherwise vehicle malfunctions may occur.
If the tyre repair kit 3 is in operation, no
consumers may be connected to the
auxiliary socket.
Ashtray 3
To be used only for ash and not for
combustible rubbish.
Ashtray, front
The cover opens when pressed at the point
indicated.
To empty, grip both sides of the ashtray
insert at the spots illustrated and pull
upwards.
9 Warning
Failure to observe these descriptions can
lead to injuries which may be fatal.
Vehicle passengers should be informed
accordingly.
109Seats, Interior
Rear ashtray 3
In the rear centre console.
Pull out the ashtray by pushing on one of
the sides.
To empty, open the ashtray, press the
spring (arrow) and pull the ashtray straight
out rearwards.
Foldaway tables 3
on the front seat backrests.
Open by pulling upward until it engages.
Fold away by pressing down past the
resistance point.
Do not place any heavy objects on the
table.
110 Seats, Interior
Stowage compartments
Glove compartment
To open, pull handle upwards.
The glove compartment shelf 3 can be
removed: Disengage the shelf by pulling on
the front edge.
Refit the shelf by sliding it into the side
guide strips and engage it in the rear panel
by pushing.
The front of the open cover houses a pen
holder and a coin compartment.
Cooled glove compartment 3 – page 159.
Stowage compartment in
front armrest 3
To open, press button and open upper part
of armrest.
Stowage compartment for glasses 3
On driver’s side: fold down to open.
Do not store heavy objects in the stowage
compartment.
Sun visors
Use the sun visor to protect from glare by
pulling it down and swivelling it to the
side 3.
On vehicles with panoramic windscreen 3,
close the sun visors before moving the roof
lining.
111Safety systems
Safety systems
Three-stage safety system
Comprising:
z three-point seat belts
z belt tensioners at the front seats
z airbag systems for the driver,
front passenger and outboard rear
seats 3; for TwinTop 3, anti-roll bars
behind the backrests.
The three stages are activated in sequence
depending on the severity of the accident:
z The automatic seat belt locking devices
prevent the belt strap from being pulled
out and thus ensure that the vehicle
occupants are retained in their seats.
z The front seat belts are pulled down at
the belt buckles. This means the belts fit
snugly, the occupants are decelerated
early with the vehicle and the body
loading is reduced.
z In the event of a severe accident, the
airbag systems and deployable anti-roll
bars 3 also deploy, forming safety
cushions for the occupants. The front
airbags are inflated in two stages based
on the severity of the collision.
Read the instructions supplied with the
child restraint system!
Three-point seat belts ......................... 112
Testing the belts .................................. 112
Belt tensioners...................................... 113
Using the belts..................................... 115
Vauxhall Full Size airbag system ....... 117
Mounting brackets 3 for ISOFIX child
restraint systems ............................... 129
Child restraint system 3 ...................... 130
Rollover protection system 3.............. 132
Exterior mirrors..................................... 134
Aspherical exterior mirror 3 ............... 134
Automatic anti-dazzle interior
mirror 3.............................................. 134
Sun visors, glove compartment .......... 134
Hazard warning flashers .................... 134
Head restraints .................................... 135
Safety accessories 3 ........................... 135
9 Warning
The airbag systems and anti-roll bars 3
serve to supplement the three-point seat
belts and belt tensioners. The seat belts
must therefore always be worn.
Disregard of these instructions could lead
to injuries or endanger life. Vehicle
passengers should be informed
accordingly.
112 Safety systems
Three-point seat belts
The vehicle is equipped with three-point
seat belts with automatic retractors and
locking devices, allowing freedom of body
movement although the spring tensioned
belts always ensure a snug fit.
For information on correct seating position
– pages 87, 115, 119.
The belts are locked during heavy
acceleration or deceleration of the vehicle.
In the event of an accident, persons not
wearing seat belts endanger their fellow
occupants and themselves.
Control indicator X 3 for the seat belt
– page 38.
Seat belts are only intended for one person.
They are not suitable for anyone under 12
years of age or under 150 cm tall.
For children up to 12 years of age, we
recommend the Vauxhall child restraint
system – page 130.
Belt force limiters
on the front seats reduce the body load
due to damped release of the belt on a
collision. This means that the occupants
move forward under control.
Testing the belts
Please check all parts of the belt system
occasionally for damage and correct
operation. Have damaged parts replaced.
In case of an accident, please replace
overstretched belts and triggered belt
tensioners. We recommend that you
consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Do not perform any alterations on the
belts, their anchorages, the automatic
retractors or the belt buckles.
Make sure that belts are not damaged or
trapped by sharp-edged objects.
9 Warning
Always wear your seat belt, and that
means also in urban traffic and when you
are a rear seat passenger. It can save
your life!
Pregnant women must always wear a
seat belt – page 115.
113Safety systems
Belt tensioners
The front seat belts are fitted with belt
tensioners. The seat belts are pulled down
at the buckles on a front or rear impact
above a certain severity. This tightens the
belts.
Actuation of belt tensioners
is indicated by illumination of control
indicator v, see next column.
The belt tensioners must be replaced after
activation. We recommend that you
consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Important information – page 114.
Control indicator v for belt tensioners
The function of the belt tensioners is
monitored electronically together with the
airbag systems and the deployable anti-
roll bars 3. Their operational readiness is
indicated by control indicator v in the
instrument panel. When the ignition is
switched on, the control indicator
illuminates for approx. 4 seconds. If it does
not illuminate, does not go out after 4
seconds or illuminates whilst driving, there
is a fault in the belt tensioner or and airbag
systems or in the deployable anti-roll
bars 3, – page 123. The systems may fail
to trigger in the event of an accident.
Deployment of the belt tensioners is
indicated by continuous illumination of v.
The system’s integrated self-diagnostics
allows faults to be quickly remedied. Have
your Car Pass on hand when consulting a
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
9 Warning
Have the cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
114 Safety systems
Note
z Accessories and other objects not
specifically approved for your vehicle
type must not be affixed or placed within
the action zone of the belt tensioners
(near the belt buckles) as this could
result in injury if the belt tensioners are
triggered.
z Do not make any modifications to the
components of the belt tensioners, as
this will render the vehicle unroadworthy.
z The belt tensioner and airbag system
control electronics can be found in the
centre console area. In order to avoid
malfunctions, do not store magnetic
objects in this area.
z When using the rear seats, ensure that
the front belt components are not
damaged by shoes or other objects.
Avoid dirt getting into the belt winders.
z We recommend that you have the front
seats removed by a Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
z The belt tensioners are for single use
only, indicated by the lighting of the
control indicators v. Replace triggered
belt tensioners. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
z Applicable safety directives must always
be observed when disposing of the
vehicle. For this reason, disposal should
be performed by an authorised recycling
company. We recommend that you
consult your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
9 Warning
Incorrect handling (e.g. removal or fitting
of belts or belt buckles) can trigger the
belt tensioners with risk of injury.
115Safety systems
Using the belts
Fitting seat belts
Pull the belt out of the retractor and guide
it across the body, making certain that it is
not twisted.
Insert the latch plate into the buckle. The
front seat backrest must not be tilted back
too far or the seat belt will not operate
properly. The recommended angle of
inclination is 25 °. Make sure that the lap
belt is not twisted and that it fits snugly
across the body. Tension the belt
frequently while driving by tugging the
diagonal part of the belt.
Bulky clothing prevents the belt from fitting
properly. The belt must not rest against
hard or fragile objects in the pockets of
your clothing (e.g. ballpoint pens, keys,
spectacles) because these could cause
injury. Do not place any objects (e.g.
handbags, mobile phones) between the
belt and your body.
Height adjustment 3
of front seat belt upper anchorage point:
1. Pull belt out slightly.
2. Press down button on adjuster slide.
3. Move adjuster slide up or down.
4. Allow sliding adjuster to audibly latch.
Do not adjust height while driving.
6
9 Warning
On pregnant women in particular, the lap
belt must be positioned as low as
possible across the pelvis so as not to put
too much pressure on the abdomen.
116 Safety systems
Adjust height such that the belt passes
over the wearer’s shoulder and rests
against the shoulder. It must not pass over
the neck or upper arm.
Removing the belt
To remove the belt, depress the red
pushbutton on the buckle; the belt will
retract automatically.
Three-point seat belts on rear outer seats
When not in use, pass seat belts through
side holders 3 as shown in Fig. 17063 T on
page 92.
Three-point seat belt of centre rear seat 3
The belt can only be pulled from the inertia
reel when the backrests are upright and
properly engaged – page 91.
Three-point seat belts of rear seats in
Astra TwinTop
In order to prevent the flutter noise caused
by the belts when the roof and windows are
open, the seat belts can be secured behind
the armrest when the rear seats are not
occupied.
117Safety systems
Vauxhall Full Size airbag system
The Vauxhall Full Size airbag system
comprises several individual systems.
Front airbag system
The front airbag system will be triggered in
the event of a serious accident involving a
frontal impact and forms safety cushions
for the driver and front passenger. The
forward movement of the driver and front
passenger is checked and the risk of
injuries to the upper body and head
thereby substantially reduced.
Side airbag system 3
The side airbag is triggered in the event of
a side-on collision to form a safety cushion
for the driver or front passenger in the
respective door area. This substantially
reduces the risk of injury to the upper body
and pelvis.
Curtain airbag system 3
The curtain airbag system triggers in case
of a side-on collision and provides a safety
barrier in the head area on the respective
side of the vehicle. This reduces the risk of
injury to the head considerably in case of a
side-on collision.
118 Safety systems
Vauxhall Full Size airbag system
Front airbag
The front airbag system is identified by the
word AIRBAG on the steering wheel and
above the glove compartment.
The front airbag system comprises:
z an airbag with inflator in the steering
wheel and a second one in the
instrument panel
z control electronics with impact sensors
z control light for airbag
systems v in instrument panel,
z seat occupancy recognition 3,
z the control indicator for Vauxhall child
restraint systems
y with
transponders 3 in the instrument panel.
The front airbag system will be triggered:
z depending on the severity of the
accident
z depending on the type of impact
z within the range shown in the illustration
z independent of side airbag 3 and
curtain airbag system 3.
Exception:
Passenger seat with seat occupancy
recognition system 3 . The seat occupancy
recognition system deactivates the front
and side airbags on the passenger side 3 if
the front passenger seat is unoccupied or a
Vauxhall child restraint system with
transponders 3 has been fitted to the front
passenger seat. Seat occupancy
recognition, see page 124. Vauxhall child
restraint system with transponders 3
– page 130.
Examples of events triggering the front
airbag system:
z Impact against a non-yielding obstacle:
the front airbags are triggered at low
vehicle speed.
z Impact against a yielding obstacle (such
as another vehicle): the front airbags are
only triggered at a higher vehicle speed.
119Safety systems
When triggered, the front airbags inflate in
milliseconds to form a safety cushion for
the driver and front passenger. The
forward movement of the front seat
occupants is checked, thereby
substantially reducing the risk of injury to
the upper body and head.
No impairment of view will occur, because
the airbags inflate and deflate so quickly
that it is often not even noticed in an
accident.
The front airbag system will not be
triggered in the event of
z the ignition is switched off
z minor frontal collisions
z accidents in which the vehicle overturns
z collisions involving a side or rear impact
that is to say, if it would not be of benefit to
the occupants.
9 Warning
The front airbag system provides
optimum protection when the seat,
backrest and head restraint are correctly
adjusted: Adjust the driver’s seat
according to the occupant’s height such
that with the driver sitting upright the
steering wheel is held in the area of its
upper spokes with the driver’s arms
slightly bent. The passenger seat should
be as far back as possible, with the
backrest upright – pages 3, 87. Do not
place the head, body, hands or feet on
the covers of the airbag systems.
Do not place any objects in the area in
which the airbags inflate. Important
information – page 126.
9 Warning
The three-point seat belt must be
correctly fitted – page 115.
120 Safety systems
In addition, the front airbag system will not
be triggered for the front passenger in
versions with seat occupancy recognition 3
if
z the front passenger seat is unoccupied
z there is a properly fitted Vauxhall child
restraint system with transponders 3.
Seat occupancy recognition – page 124.
Vauxhall child restraint system with
transponders 3 – page 130.
Side airbag 3
The side airbag system is identified by the
word AIRBAG on the outboard sides of the
front seat backrests.
The side airbag system comprises:
z an airbag with inflator in the back of the
driver’s and front passenger seat
respectively
z the control electronics
z the side impact sensors
z control light for airbag
systems v in instrument panel,
z seat occupancy recognition 3,
z the control indicator for Vauxhall child
restraint systems
y with
transponders 3 in the instrument panel.
The side airbag system will be triggered:
z depending on the severity of the
accident
z depending on the type of impact
z within the range shown in the illustration
on the centre door pillar of the driver’s or
front passenger side,
z independently of the front airbag
system.
Exception: Passenger seat with seat
occupancy recognition system 3 . The seat
occupancy recognition system deactivates
the front and side airbags on the
passenger side 3 if the front passenger
seat is unoccupied or a Vauxhall child
restraint system with transponders 3 has
been fitted to the front passenger seat.
Seat occupancy recognition, – page 124.
Vauxhall child restraint system with
transponders 3 – page 130.
9 Warning
Seat belts must therefore always be worn.
The front airbag system serves to
supplement the three-point seat belts. If
you do not wear your seat belt you risk
being seriously injured, or even thrown
from the vehicle, in the event of an
accident.
In the event of an accident the belt helps
to keep you in the correct seating
position, so that the front airbag system
can provide you with effective protection.
121Safety systems
When triggered, the side airbag inflates
within milliseconds to form a safety cushion
for the driver or front passenger in the
respective door area. This substantially
reduces the risk of injury to the upper body
and pelvis in the event of a side-on
collision.
The side airbags will not be triggered in the
event of
z the ignition is switched off
z frontal collisions
z accidents in which the vehicle overturns
z collisions involving a rear impact
z Side-on collisions outside the passenger
cell.
In addition, the side airbag system 3 will
not be triggered for the front passenger in
versions with seat occupancy recognition 3
if
z the front passenger seat is unoccupied
z there is a properly fitted Vauxhall child
restraint system with transponders 3 .
Seat occupancy recognition – page 124.
Vauxhall child restraint system with
transponders 3 – page 130.
9 Warning
There must be no objects in the area in
which the airbag inflates or in the area
between the seat backs and the vehicle
body. Do not place the hands or arms on
the covers of the airbag systems.
Important information – page 126.
The three-point seat belt must always be
correctly fitted – page 115.
122 Safety systems
Curtain airbag 3
The curtain airbag system is identified by
the word AIRBAG on the roof pillar trim.
The curtain airbag system comprises:
z an airbag with inflator in the roof frame
on the driver’s and front passenger side
respectively
z the control electronics
z the side impact sensors
z control light for airbag
systems v in instrument panel.
The curtain airbag system will be triggered:
z depending on the severity of the
accident
z depending on the type of impact
z within the range shown in the illustration
on the centre door pillar of the driver’s or
front passenger side,
z together with the side airbag system 3,
z irrespective of seat occupancy
recognition 3,
z independently of the front airbag
system.
When the curtain airbag is triggered it
inflates within milliseconds and provides a
safety barrier in the head area on the
respective side of the vehicle. This reduces
the risk of injury to the head considerably in
case of a side impact.
123Safety systems
The curtain airbags will not be triggered in
the event of
z the ignition is switched off
z frontal collisions
z accidents in which the vehicle overturns
z collisions involving a rear impact
z Side-on collisions outside the passenger
cell.
Control indicator v for airbag systems
The function of the airbag systems is
monitored electronically together with the
seat occupancy recognition 3 and belt
tensioner systems 3 and the deployable
anti-roll bars. Their operational readiness is
indicated by control indicator v. When the
ignition is switched on, the control indicator
illuminates for approx. 4 seconds. If it does
not illuminate, does not go out after 4
seconds or illuminates whilst driving, there
is a fault in the airbag systems, seat
occupancy recognition 3 or belt tensioner
systems, or in the deployable anti-roll
bars 3, – page 113. The systems may fail
to trigger in the event of an accident.
Deployment of the airbags is indicated by
continuous illumination of v.
The system’s integrated self-diagnostics
allows faults to be quickly remedied. Have
your Car Pass on hand when consulting a
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
9 Warning
There must be no objects in the area in
which the airbag inflates. Do not place
the hands or arms on the covers of the
airbag systems. Important information
– page 126.
The three-point seat belt must always be
correctly fitted – page 115.
9 Warning
Have the cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
124 Safety systems
Seat occupancy recognition 3
The seat occupancy recognition system
deactivates the front and side airbags 3
for the front passenger if the front
passenger seat is not occupied or a
Vauxhall child restraint system with
transponders 3 is fitted on the front
passenger seat. The curtain airbag
system 3 remains activated.
The control indicator
y for seat
occupancy recognition is located in the
instrument panel. If the control indicator
y
illuminates for approx. 4 seconds when the
ignition is switched on, the vehicle is
equipped with seat occupancy recognition,
see next page, Fig. 17117 T.
If a Vauxhall child restraint system with
transponders
3 is fitted, the control indicator
y lights
permanently after the ignition is switched
on as soon as the system has detected the
child restraint system. Only then may the
child restraint system with transponders 3
be used on the passenger seat.
Vehicles with seat occupancy recognition
are also identified by a sticker on the lower
panel of the front passenger seats – see
figure above.
Vauxhall child restraint systems with
transponders 3 are automatically
detected if correctly fitted to the front
passenger seat. When this type of child
restraint system is in use on the front
passenger seat, the front and side airbag
systems for the front passenger seat are
deactivated. The curtain airbag system
remains activated. Pay attention to control
indicator
y for seat occupancy
recognition 3 see Fig. 17117 T.
Vauxhall child restraint systems with
transponders 3 can be identified by a
sticker.
Note
On the Astra TwinTop, there may be
interference in radio reception of certain
frequencies in the medium waveband
when the roof is open and the front
passenger seat is unoccupied.
9 Warning
Only Vauxhall child restraint systems with
transponders 3 can be fitted on the front
passenger seats. Use of systems without
transponders poses a risk of fatal injury.
125Safety systems
Control indicator y for Vauxhall
child restraint systems
with transponders 3
The presence of a Vauxhall child restraint
system with transponders 3 is indicated
after the ignition has been switched on by
permanent illumination of the control
indicator
y in the instrument panel, as
soon as the seat occupancy recognition
system has detected the child restraint
system.
If the control indicator does not illuminate
whilst driving, the front and side airbag 3
have not been deactivated on the
passenger side. Risk of fatal injury to the
child - fit child restraint system to rear seat.
Have cause of fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
If the child restraint system is not correctly
installed or the transponder is faulty, the
control indicator flashes. Check for correct
installation of child restraint system. To
install the child restraint system with
transponders 3, see the instructions
enclosed with the system.
If the control indicator flashes even though
there is correctly installed child restraint
system with transponders 3, there is a fault
- risk of fatal injury to the child. Fit child
restraint system to rear seat. Have the
cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
If no Vauxhall child restraint system with
transponders 3 is installed, the control
indicator must neither illuminate nor flash,
since this indicates that the front
passenger airbag systems would not be
triggered. Have the cause of fault
remedied. We recommend that you consult
your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
9 Warning
If the Vauxhall child restraint system with
transponders 3 has been fitted
according to the instructions, the control
indicator for Vauxhall restraint systems
with transponders must illuminate in the
instrument panel when the ignition is
switched on.
If the control indicator does not illuminate
whilst driving, the airbag systems have
not been deactivated on the passenger
side. Risk of fatal injury. In this case, fit
child restraint system to rear seat. Have
cause of fault remedied. We recommend
that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
126 Safety systems
Important
z Do not affix or place accessories or other
objects in the deployment area or the
airbag systems or deployable anti-roll
bars 3 as this could result in injuries if the
components are triggered.
z Do not place any objects between the
airbag systems/anti-roll bar covers 3
and the occupants. Risk of injury.
z Use the hooks in the roof frame only to
hang up light articles of clothing or coat
hangers. Do not place any objects in the
pockets of the hanging items – risk of
injury.
z The control electronics of the airbag
systems, belt tensioners and deployable
anti-roll bars 3 are located in the centre
console area. Do not store any magnetic
objects in the area as they could cause
malfunction.
z Do not bond or use other material to
cover the steering wheel, dashboard,
front seat backrests and roof frame in
the area of the airbags and the seat
cushion of the passenger seat or the
covers of the deployable anti-roll bars 3.
z Use only a dry cloth or interior cleaner to
clean the steering wheel, instrument
panel, front seat backrests, roof frame
and seat cushion of the front passenger
seat. Do not use any aggressive cleaning
agents.
z Only protective covers which are
approved for your vehicle with side
airbag 3 may be fitted on the front
seats. When fitting the protective covers,
make sure that the airbag units on the
outboard sides of the front seat
backrests are not covered.
z The airbag systems are triggered
independently of each other based on
the severity of the accident and the type
of impact. The side airbag system 3 and
the curtain airbag system 3 are
triggered together.
z Astra TwinTop: The deployable anti-roll
bars 3 are deployed together with the
front and side airbag systems 3
depending on the severity of the impact.
z Each airbag or deployable anti-roll
bar 3 can only be deployed once. Have
deployed components replaced
immediately. We recommend that you
consult your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
z The speeds, directions of movement and
deformation properties of the vehicles,
and the properties of the obstacle
concerned, determine the severity of the
accident and triggering of the airbags.
The degree of damage to your vehicle
and the resulting repair costs alone are
not indicative that the criteria for
triggering of the airbags were met.
z Do not make any modifications to
components of the airbag systems or the
anti-roll bars 3 as this would render the
vehicle unroadworthy.
z We recommend having the steering
wheel, the instrument panel, all panelling
parts, the door seals, the handles and
the seats removed by your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
9 Warning
Never carry child restraint systems or
other objects on your lap - risk of fatal
injury.
9 Warning
The systems can be triggered abruptly
and cause injury if they are handled
improperly.
127Safety systems
z Applicable safety directives must always
be observed when disposing of the
vehicle. For this reason, disposal should
be performed by an authorised recycling
company. We recommend that you
consult your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
z Persons weighing less than 35 kg should
only travel on the rear seats. This does
not apply to children who are travelling
in child restraint systems with
transponders 3.
z In vehicles with seat occupancy
recognition 3, do not place any heavy
objects on the front passenger seat
otherwise the airbag systems for the
front passenger seat may be triggered in
the event of an accident.
z In vehicles with seat occupancy
recognition 3, to prevent malfunctions
do not use protective covers or seat
cushions on the front passenger seat.
z In order to prevent malfunctions when
using a Vauxhall child restraint system
with transponders 3 on the front
passenger seat, no objects (e.g. plastic
sheet, stickers or heated mats) may be
placed under the child restraint system.
Use of child restraint systems 3 on the
front passenger seat in vehicles
with airbag systems, but
without seat occupancy recognition 3
Versions with front passenger airbag can
be identified by the word AIRBAG over the
glove compartment and the warning
sticker on the side of the instrument panel,
visible when the passenger door is open -
see Fig. 17118 A.
6
9 Warning
Child restraint systems as well as other
objects must never be carried on the lap
of passengers; risk of fatal injury. If
carried in this way, child restraint systems
with transponders 3 in vehicles with seat
occupancy recognition 3 could lead to
front passenger airbag systems not
being triggered in the event of an
accident.
9 Warning
No child restraint system 3 may be
installed on front passenger seat. Danger
to life.
128 Safety systems
The side airbag system3 is identified by
the word AIRBAG on the outboard sides of
the front seat backrests.
Seat occupancy recognition 3page 124.
Use of child restraint systems 3 on front
passenger seat in vehicles
with airbag systems and
seat occupancy recognition 3
Vehicles with seat occupancy recognition
are identified by a sticker on the lower
panel of the front passenger seat – see Fig.
17116 T.
9 Warning
Only Vauxhall child restraint systems with
transponders 3 can be fitted on the front
passenger seats. Use of systems without
transponders poses a risk of fatal injury.
129Safety systems
Vehicles with seat occupancy recognition
can also be identified by control indicator
y in the instrument panel. If control
indicator
y illuminates for approx. 4
seconds when the ignition is switched on,
the vehicle is equipped with seat
occupancy recognition – page 124.
The seat occupancy recognition system
detects Vauxhall child restraint systems
with transponders 3 and deactivates the
front and side airbag systems 3 for the
front passenger seat. The curtain airbag
system 3 remains activated. For seat
occupancy recognition see page 124.
Vauxhall child restraint systems with
transponders 3 can be identified by a
sticker on the child restraint system – see
figure.
Mounting brackets 3 for ISOFIX
child restraint systems
The brackets located between the backrest
and seat cushion are used for mounting
ISOFIX child restraint systems.
Please follow the instructions
accompanying the ISOFIX child restraint
system.
Only ISOFIX child restraint systems
approved for the vehicle may be used. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
130 Safety systems
Child restraint system 3
The Vauxhall child restraint system is
designed specifically for your Vauxhall and
thus provides optimum safety for your child
in the event of impact. If a different child
safety seat is used, follow the
manufacturers’ instructions for fitting and
use.
The country in which you are travelling
may not permit the use of child restraint
systems on certain seats. Always comply
with the local or national regulations.
Selecting the right system
Your child should travel facing backwards
in the car for as long as possible. A child
has a very weak cervical spinal column and
in the event of an accident is less likely to
suffer injury in a rearward-facing, semi-
lying position than if seated upright.
9 Warning
Never carry child restraint systems on
your lap, risk of fatal injury.
Permissible options for fitting a child safety seat
1)
1)
For reasons of safety, we recommend that the child safety seat be installed on
one of the outer rear seats.
Weight and
age class
2)
2)
We recommend the use of each system until the child reaches the upper weight limit.
On
front
passenger seat
On
outer rear seats
On
centre rear seat
3)
3)
Not on Astra TwinTop.
Group 0:
up to 10 kg
or approx.
10 months
Group 0+:
up to 13 kg
or approx.
2 years
B
1
, + U, + U
Group I:
9 to18 kg
or approx.
8 months to 4
years
B
2
, + U, + U
Group II:
15 to 25 kg
or approx.
3 to 7 years
Group III:
22 to 36 kg
or approx.
6 to 12 years
X U U
131Safety systems
Note
z Children under 12 years or under 150 cm
tall should only travel in an appropriate
child safety seat.
z When transporting children, use the child
restraint systems suitable for the child’s
weight.
z Ensure correct installation of child
restraint system, see the instructions
enclosed with the system.
z The covers of the Vauxhall child restraint
system can be wiped clean.
z Do not stick anything on the child
restraint systems and do not cover them
with any other materials.
z Only allow the child to enter and exit on
the side of the vehicle facing away from
the road.
z A child restraint system which has been
subjected to stress in an accident must
be replaced.
z Secure or remove child restraint systems
carried in the vehicle when not in use.
B
1
= Limited, only with seat occupancy
recognition and Vauxhall child
restraint system with transponders.
If the child restraint system is being
secured using a three-point seat
belt, move seat height adjustment 3
to uppermost position. Move front
passenger seat as far back as
possible and move front passenger
seat belt anchorage point to lowest
position.
B
2
= Limited, only with seat occupancy
recognition and Vauxhall child
restraint system with transponders.
If the child restraint system is being
secured using a three-point seat
belt, move seat height adjustment 3
to uppermost position. Move front
passenger seat as far back as
possible so that vehicle safety belt
runs from anchorage point towards
the front.
U = Universal suitability in conjunction
with three-point seat belt.
+ = Vehicle seat with ISOFIX mounting
available. When mounting with
ISOFIX, only ISOFIX child restraint
systems that have been approved
for the vehicle may be used. We
recommend your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
X = No child restraint system permitted
in this weight class.
132 Safety systems
Rollover protection system 3
The Astra TwinTop is equipped with
rollover protection with reinforced
windscreen frame and anti-roll bars behind
the rear seat head restraints. Depending
on the variant, the anti-roll bars are either
fixed or deploy automatically in the event
of an impact of a certain severity. The
subsequent description only regards the
variant with automatically deployed anti-
roll bars 3.
In the event of a rollover, the anti-roll bars
deploy upwards in a matter of
milliseconds. They also deploy together
with the front and side airbag systems 3,
helping to optimise occupant protection.
The system deploys whether the roof is
open or closed. Roof operation is not
possible if the anti-roll bars are extended.
Control indicator v for anti-roll bars
The deployable anti-roll bars are
monitored electronically together with the
belt tensioners and the airbag systems.
Their operational readiness is indicated by
control indicator v in the instrument panel.
When the ignition is switched on, the
control indicator illuminates for approx. 4
seconds. If it does not illuminate, does not
go out after 4 seconds or illuminates whilst
driving, there is a fault in or deployment of
the anti-roll bars, belt tensioners and
airbag systems – page 113. The systems
may fail to trigger in the event of an
accident.
Deployment of the anti-roll bars is
indicated by continuous illumination of v.
133Safety systems
Extended anti-roll bars
can be retracted (e.g. in order to close the
roof after a collision).
Press the lever between the rods of an anti-
roll bar to unlock the system. Push the anti-
roll bar all the way down until it engaged.
Fit the cover.
Repeat the procedure on the other anti-roll
bar.
Control indicator v , however, will remain
illuminated and the anti-roll bars will not
deploy in the event of another collision.
Have the cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
Note
z Do not place any objects on the covers of
the anti-roll bars behind the head
restraints. They would be propelled
through the vehicle in an uncontrolled
fashion should the anti-roll bars deploy.
Such objects could also prevent the anti-
roll bars from extending.
z Do not operate the roof while the anti-
roll bars are extended. Parts of the roof
could be damaged during such
operation.
z Deployment of the anti-roll bars is
indicated by illumination of control
indicator v.
z Manually retracted anti-roll bars will not
deploy in the event of a collision.
z After deployment, the anti-roll bar
system must be serviced immediately.
We recommend that you consult your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
9 Warning
The roof cannot be closed or opened if
the anti-roll bars are extended. The anti-
roll bars must first be retracted.
If an attempt is made to operate the roof
while the anti-roll bars are extended, a
continuous signal will sound as a
warning.
134 Safety systems
Exterior mirrors
For the safety of pedestrians, the exterior
mirrors will swing out of their normal
mounting position if they are bumped with
sufficient force. Reposition the mirror by
applying slight pressure to the mirror
housing.
Aspherical exterior mirror 3
increases the field of view. Estimating the
distance away of vehicles following you is
only possible to a limited extent because of
slight distortion.
Automatic anti-dazzle
interior mirror 3
Dazzle at night is automatically reduced.
With the ignition off, the mirror does not
dim.
Setting – page 6.
Sun visors, glove compartment
The mirror covers in the sun visors and the
glove compartment should be closed whilst
driving.
Hazard warning flashers
The hazard warning lights switch on
automatically when the airbags are
triggered, and the central locking unlocks
all doors. Switch off hazard warning lights
with button ¨.
135Safety systems
Head restraints
Do not attach objects or components that
are not approved for your vehicle to the
head restraints, since they can reduce the
protection provided by the head restraints
and could be catapulted uncontrollably
through the vehicle in the event of hard
braking or an accident.
Active head restraints 3
In the event of a rear-end impact, the
active head restraints tilt forwards slightly.
The head is more effectively supported by
the head restraint and the danger of
hyperextension in the area of the cervical
vertebra is reduced.
Active head restraints are identified by the
lettering ACTIVE on the head restraint
guide sleeves.
Safety accessories 3
The wide range of Vauxhall accessories
allows you to equip your vehicle as you
desire. In addition to safety accessories,
items for improving comfort and a
complete range of vehicle care products,
there are many articles which will be of
great value to you when needed.
"Genuine Vauxhall Parts and Accessories"
guarantee high quality and accurate fit.
Your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer will be
happy to advise you, for example with
regard to:
z Vauxhall child restraint systems,
z Tow ropes,
z Tow rods,
z Jump leads,
z Spare bulb kit,
z Spare fuse kit
z Halogen fog lights
z Mud flaps
z Warning triangle
z First-aid kit (cushion)
136 Lighting
Lighting
Exterior lights
Turn light switch:
7 = Off
8 = Parking lights
9 = Dipped beam, main beam
Dipped beam, main beam and headlight
flash – see page 15.
In positions 8 and 9, the tail lights and
number plate lights are also on.
Control indicator 8 – page 40.
If the ignition is switched off with the
dipped beam or main beam on, the
parking lights illuminate.
Versions with daytime running lights 3 :
Parking lights are on when the ignition is
switched on and the light switch is set to 7
or AUTO. Dipped beam is on when the
engine is running.
The daytime running lights switch off when
the ignition is switched off.
Follow the regulations of the country in
which you are driving when using daytime
running lights and fog lights 3.
Driving abroad – page 142.
Automatic dipped beam activation 3 137
Fog lights > 3..................................... 137
Fog tail light r .................................... 137
Turn signals, hazard warning flashers 137
Reversing lights.................................... 137
Headlight range adjustment ?.......... 138
Adaptive Forward Lighting 3 (AFL) .. 139
Door-to-door light function ................ 140
Parking lights 3 ................................... 140
Instrument illumination , Information
display illumination........................... 140
Courtesy light....................................... 141
Puddle light 3 ...................................... 142
Battery discharge protection.............. 142
Light covers.......................................... 142
Headlights when driving abroad ....... 142
137Lighting
Automatic dipped beam
activation 3
Light switch to AUTO : Dipped beam
comes on automatically when the engine is
running if outside light conditions warrant
such.
The exterior lights switch off when the
ignition is switched off.
For reasons of safety, the light switch
should always remain in the AUTO
position.
Fog lights > 3
On = Press >> illuminates
in instrument panel
Off = Press > again or
switch ignition or light off
The fog lights can only be switched on
when both the ignition and lights are on.
Fog tail light r
On = Press r r illuminates
in instrument panel
Off = Press r again or
switch ignition or light off
The fog tail light can only be switched on
both the ignition and dipped beam/
parking lights are on.
The vehicle fog tail light are deactivated
when towing.
Turn signals, hazard warning
flashers
– page 15.
Reversing lights
Come on when reverse gear is engaged
and ignition is switched on.
138 Lighting
Headlight range adjustment ?
Manual headlight range adjustment 3
With dipped beam switched on, adjust
headlight range in four steps to suit vehicle
load. Turn wheel against resistance and
click it to the required position.
Correct adjustment of the headlight range
reduces dazzle for other road users.
Automatic level control system 3,
– page 220.
Vehicles without level control system
z Front seats occupied = 0
z All seats occupied = 1
z All seats occupied and
luggage compartment load =2
z Driver’s seat occupied and
luggage compartment load =3
Vehicles with level control system
z Front seats occupied = 0
z All seats occupied = 1
z All seats occupied and
luggage compartment load =1
z Driver’s seat occupied and
luggage compartment load =2
Automatic headlight range adjustment 3
On vehicles with Xenon headlights, the
range of the headlights is adjusted
automatically based on vehicle load.
139Lighting
Adaptive Forward Lighting 3
(AFL)
improves lighting in curves (curve lighting)
on vehicles with Bi-Xenon headlight
system.
Curve lighting
The Xenon light beam pivots based on
steering wheel position and speed (from
approx. 6 mph /10 km/h).
The headlights shine at an angle of up to
15 ° to the right or left of the direction of
travel.
Motorway lighting
At higher speeds and continuous straight
ahead travel, the dipped beam
automatically raises slightly, thereby
increasing headlight range.
Control indicator B for adaptive driving
lights
Illuminated: Fault in system. The system is
not ready for operation.
If the cornering light swivelling device fails,
the relevant dipped beam is switched off.
The corresponding fog light is
automatically switched on for reasons of
safety.
Consult a workshop. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
If control indicator
B flashes for approx. 4
seconds after the ignition is switched on,
the headlights have been set to
symmetrical dipped beam; see "Headlights
when driving abroad" on page 142.
140 Lighting
Door-to-door light function
Dipped beam and reversing lights 3 light
for around 30 seconds after the driver exits
the vehicle and closes his door.
To activate
1. Switch off ignition.
2. Remove ignition key. 3.
3. Open driver’s door.
4. Pull turn signal stalk toward steering
wheel.
5. Close driver’s door.
If the driver’s door is left open, the lights will
go out after two minutes.
Door-to-door lighting can be deactivated
by inserting the key in the starter switch or
by pulling the turn signal stalk toward the
steering wheel again while the driver’s door
is open.
Parking lights 3
The front parking light and tail light of one
side of the vehicle can be activated when
parking:
1. Set light switch to 7 or AUTO 3,
2. Ignition off
3. Move turn signal stalk all the way up
(right parking light) or down (left parking
light).
An acoustic signal sounds and control
indicator O illuminates briefly in the
instrument panel to indicate activation.
To switch it off, switch on the ignition or
move the turn signal stalk in the opposite
direction.
Instrument illumination ,
Information display illumination
Comes on when ignition is switched on.
Brightness can be adjusted when the
exterior lights are on: Push to release knob
k and then turn it clockwise or
anticlockwise and hold until the desired
brightness is obtained.
Display mode 3 – page 58.
141Lighting
Courtesy light
Automatic interior light
Comes on automatically when the vehicle is
unlocked with the radio remote control,
when a door is opened or when the key is
removed from the starter switch after the
ignition is switched off.
Goes off automatically after a delay when
the doors are closed or immediately when
the ignition is switched on or the doors are
locked.
Front courtesy light
To operate manually from inside when the
doors are closed:
On = Press button
c
Off = Press button c again
Front reading lights 3
Left and right reading lights are
individually operable. With ignition on:
on: press = button
a
off: press=button a again
Courtesy lights and
rear reading lights 3
Centre switch position: The rear courtesy
light comes on together with the front one
when a door is open.
The rear reading lights on the left and right
can be switched on separately. With
ignition on:
On = Switch position I
Off = Switch position 0
142 Lighting
Entry lighting 3
After unlocking the vehicle, the instrument
and switch lighting come on for a few
seconds.
Door handle lighting 3
When the exterior lights are on, the interior
front door handles are illuminated.
Illuminated mirror in the
sun visors 3
The lighting switches on when the cover is
opened.
Glove compartment lighting
on when lid is open.
Cigarette lighter
and ashtray illumination 3
Comes on when ignition is switched on.
Luggage compartment lighting
Comes on when the boot lid/tailgate is
opened.
Automatically regulated centre console
lighting 3
Spotlight in housing of interior mirror.
Daylight-dependent, automatically
regulated centre console lighting with
ignition switched on.
Puddle light 3
After unlocking the vehicle, the number
plate lights come on for a few seconds.
Battery discharge protection
To prevent the battery from becoming
discharged, the courtesy light, reading
lights, luggage compartment lighting and
glove compartment lighting switch off
automatically 10 minutes after the ignition
is switched off.
Light covers
The inside of the light covers may mist up
briefly in poor, wet and cold weather
conditions, in heavy rain or after washing.
The mist disappears quickly by itself; to
help, switch on the lights.
Headlights when driving abroad
The asymmetrical dipped beam increases
the field of vision on the passenger side of
the lane.
This causes glare for oncoming traffic if the
vehicle is driven in countries where traffic
drives on the opposite side of the road.
Do as follows to prevent glare:
Vehicles with
halogen headlight system or
Xenon headlight system 3
Have the headlights adjusted by a
workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
Vehicles with adaptive forward lighting 3
(AFL)
1. Pull and hold stalk for main beam on
steering wheel (headlight flash)
2. Switch on ignition.
3. After approx. 3 seconds, an acoustic
signal sounds and then AFL control
indicator
B flashes approx. 4 seconds.
After the switch, AFL control indicator
B
flashes for 4 seconds each time the ignition
is switched on.
To return to asymmetrical dipped beam,
pull and hold the main beam stalk again,
switch on the ignition and wait for the
acoustic signal. AFL control indicator
B
will then discontinue flashing.
Control indicator
B – page 42.
143Windows, Sun Roof
Windows, Sun Roof
Electric windows 3
The electric windows can be used
z with ignition on,
z within 5 minutes of switching ignition
off 3,
z within 5 minutes of switching ignition key
to position 1.
Stand-by after switching on the ignition
ends when the driver’s door is opened.
Operated via two or four 3 switches in the
driver’s door handle. The front switches are
for the driver and front passenger doors.
The rear switches 3 are for the rear doors.
Additional switches are located in the front
passenger door and rear doors 3.
For incremental operation, briefly pull or
press the switch. For automatic opening or
closing, pull or press the switch longer. Pull
or press the switch again to stop the
movement.
Electric windows 3............................... 143
Panoramic windscreen 3 .................... 146
Sun roof 3 ............................................ 146
9 Warning
Take care when operating the electric
windows 3 and the sun roof 3. Risk of
injury, particularly to children. Vehicle
passengers should be informed
accordingly.
If there are children on the rear seat,
switch on the child safety system 3 for
the electric windows.
Keep a close watch on the windows and
sun roof when closing them. Ensure that
nothing becomes trapped in them as
they move.
144 Windows, Sun Roof
Safety function
If the window glass encounters resistance
above the middle of the window during
automatic closing, it is immediately
stopped and the window opened again.
In the event of difficulty due to frost or the
like, press the relevant window switch
several times until the window is closed.
Child safety system for rear windows 3
Switch
z between the rear switches in the
driver’s door handle
z Forward (red field visible): Rear door
switches non-operational
z Rearward (green field visible): Rear door
switches operational
Central switch for electric
windows, Astra TwinTop
Button
$ or " in the roof console
Press button
$ : all windows are closed
Press button
$ : all windows are opened
145Windows, Sun Roof
Operating windows from outside 3
Depending on the equipment level of the
vehicle 3 , the windows of vehicles with
electric windows in all doors 3 can be
opened or closed from outside using the
radio remote control.
Radio remote control with
mechanical key
Hold button q or p on the radio remote
control depressed until all windows have
opened or completely closed.
Open&Start system with
electronic key 3
Hold down button q of radio remote
control to open. To close, hold down button
p or touch sensor in door handle for
longer. The electronic key must be
recognised within the external reception
range. It is advisable for the driver to keep
the electronic key on his person.
Stand-by after switching on the ignition
ends when the driver’s door is opened.
Overload
If the windows are repeatedly operated at
short intervals, the power supply is briefly
cut off.
The system is protected by fuses in the fuse
box – page 266.
Fault
The windows cannot be automatically
opened or closed.
Activate electronic windows as follows:
1. Close doors.
2. Switch on ignition.
3. Window completely open.
4. Close the window and hold the button
depressed at least 5 seconds.
5. Repeat for each window.
146 Windows, Sun Roof
Panoramic windscreen 3
Open the roof lining
Turn the handle to the right and move the
roof lining rearward to a suitable position.
Close the roof lining
Move the roof lining forward to a suitable
position. When moved all the way forward,
the roof lining engages in position.
Note
Close the sun visors before sliding the roof
lining.
Sun roof 3
Operated via rocker switches in the roof
console when the ignition is switched on.
For incremental operation, briefly press the
button. For automatic opening or closing,
press the button longer.
147Windows, Sun Roof
To raise:
When the roof is closed, press button ü.
The roof is tilted in the rear.
To open:
Press button ü again from the tilted
position. The roof opens to its stop.
To close:
Press button
d .
For reasons of safety, the roof closes from
its open position to approx. 20 cm. Hold
button
d depressed to close the roof
completely.
Sunblind
Used to reduce sun penetration into the
interior when the sun roof is closed.
The sunblind opens when the sun roof
opens.
To open:
Press button
G. The sunblind opens to its
stop.
To close:
Press button
H
For reasons of safety, the blind closes from
its open position to approx. 20 cm. Hold
button
d depressed to close completely.
Note
z If the top of the roof is wet, raise roof,
allow water to run off and then open
roof.
z When using a roof rack, check the
clearance of the sun roof to avoid
damage.
Overload
If the system is overloaded, the power
supply is automatically cut off for a short
time.
The system is protected by fuses in the fuse
box – page 266.
Fault
If the sun roof and sunblind do not operate
properly, activate electronics as follows:
1. Switch on ignition.
2. Close the sun roof and hold button
d
depressed at least 10 seconds.
3. Close sunblind and hold button
H
depressed at least 10 seconds.
148 TwinTop
TwinTop
With TwinTop, a convertible hardtop, Astra
unites the benefits of a coupe with those of
a convertible.
TwinTop
Operating the convertible hardtop
Stand-by with ignition key in lock from
position 1, or for Open&Start-System 3
switch on ignition.
Requirements:
z Vehicle is stationary or driving no more
than 20 mph (30 km/h).
z Luggage compartment blind is closed
and engaged - see above and page 104.
z Boot lid is closed.
If any of the requirements are not fulfilled,
a warning buzzer sounds when the switch is
actuated and the roof does not open or
close.
TwinTop................................................ 148
Rollover protection system ................. 152
Luggage compartment....................... 153
Wind deflector 3.................................. 154
9 Warning
Take care when operating the
convertible hardtop. Risk of injury.
Monitor the action zone above, to the
side and to the rear of the vehicle during
roof operation. Make sure that nothing
could become pinched.
Make sure no one is in the action zone of
the roof or boot lid during roof operation.
Risk of injury.
Check the amount height, length and
width of available space before
operating the roof, e. g. in a garage,
parking garage or when a bicycle rack is
fitted.
Vehicle passengers should be informed
accordingly.
Before leaving the vehicle, remove the
ignition key in order to prevent
unauthorised operation of the windows
and sun roof.
149TwinTop
To open the roof
There must be no objects in front of the
rear window or in the pivot area of the roof
and boot lid.
Hold button
> in the roof console
depressed until the roof is completely open
and the boot lid is closed.
An acoustic signal sounds at the end of the
opening procedure.
Open the door windows slightly before
opening the roof. If button
> is pressed
again after the acoustic signal sounds, the
door windows will close.
With the vehicle stopped, the roof can be
opened using the radio remote control 3 .
Unlock the vehicle. Press button q again
and keep pressed until the roof has opened
fully and the boot lid has closed.
During operation with the remote control,
the door windows are opened completely.
To close the roof
There must be no objects in the pivot area
of the roof and boot lid.
Hold button
< in the roof console
depressed until the roof and boot lid are
completely closed.
An acoustic signal sounds at the end of the
closing procedure.
Open the door windows slightly before
closing the roof. If button
< is pressed
again after the acoustic signal sounds, the
door windows will close.
6
150 TwinTop
With the vehicle stopped, the roof can be
closed using the radio remote control 3 .
Lock the vehicle. Press button p again and
keep pressed until the roof and boot lid
have closed completely.
Indicator and warning buzzers
z Indicator buzzer upon completed
opening or closing of the convertible
hardtop.
z Indicator buzzer upon completed raising
or lowering of the electric luggage
compartment loading aid.
z Gong tone if the boot lid is not closed
during roof operation.
z Gong tone if the boot lid is not fully
opening during operation of the luggage
compartment loading aid.
z Gong tone during roof operation if
vehicle speed exceeds 20 mph (30 km/h).
z Gong tone when vehicle speed exceeds
20 mph (30 km/h) if the roof is not fully
open or closed.
z Three gong tones during roof or loading
aid operation if the luggage
compartment blind is not attached.
z Three gong tones during roof operation
if outside temperature is below –20 °C,
vehicle battery voltage is too low or the
system is overloaded.
z Continuous warning buzzer during roof
operation if the anti-roll bars 3 have
been triggered.
z Continuous warning buzzer starting one
minute before the end of the 9-minute
standby time with the roof in an
intermediate position.
z Continuous warning buzzer starting one
minute before the end of the 9-minute
standby time with the loading aid in a
raised position.
z Continuous warning buzzer when closing
the boot lid if the lowering process of the
electric load aid is not complete or was
interrupted.
151TwinTop
Note
z Do not open the luggage compartment
until the acoustic signal indicating the
end of the roof opening or closing
procedure has sounded.
z The luggage compartment blind must
always be closed during roof operation.
z There must be no one at the covers
behind the rear head restraints.
z There must be no objects in the pivot
area or the roof or on the covers behind
the rear head restraints.
z The roof can only be operated at
temperatures above –20 °C. If the
temperature is below this limit, a gong
will sound three times when roof
operation is requested.
z The roof can be held in an intermediate
position for 9 minutes to facilitate
cleaning of roof spaces. This is done by
disengaging the actuation switch. One
minute before the end of this period, a
continuous buzzer sounds as a warning
that the hold period is almost over and
the roof could start to move.
z Activating the roof on uneven ground
can lead to malfunctions and damage.
Fault
The automatic drive of the roof is only
operational if the roof is in the proper open
or closed position.
Check if:
z The luggage compartment blind is
engaged in the closed position
z The boot lid is completely closed
z Outside temperature is above –20 °C
z There is sufficient battery voltage
z There is a system overload
If the automatic drive is not operational,
two persons are required to manually close
the roof. See the accompanying
instructions for Astra TwinTop. We
recommend that you seek professional
assistance.
152 TwinTop
Rollover protection system
To optimise safety in the event of a
rollover, the Astra TwinTop is equipped
with reinforced windscreen frame and anti-
roll bars behind the rear sat head
restraints. The anti-roll bars are fixed or
deployable depending on vehicle variant.
Fixed anti-roll bars
are secured to the vehicle bodywork.
Deployable anti-roll bars 3
are located between the rear head
restraints and the boot lid in such a way
that they are out of sight. In the event of a
rollover, head-on collision or side impact,
the anti-roll bars deploy upwards within
milliseconds. The convertible roof must not
be operated if the anti-roll bars have been
deployed. A continuous warning will sound
if the switch is actuated. The airbag control
indicator v illuminates if the anti-roll bars
have been deployed.
Manual retraction of the anti-roll bars
– page 132.
Further information, – page 133.
153TwinTop
Luggage compartment
The roof can only be opened if the load in
the luggage compartment does not
exceed the height of the luggage
compartment blind or protrude sideways.
The load height marked in the figure must
not be exceeded. The luggage
compartment blind must be flat; objects
below it must not press it upwards.
Otherwise the roof and load may be
damaged.
Electrically operated loading aid for the
luggage compartment – page 104.
Luggage compartment blind – page 104.
Blockage of boot lid on closure 3
To avoid damage to the open roof, boot lid
or load, the boot lid can only be closed if
the electric load aid is in the lower end
position – page 104.
Unblocking on failure of electric drive
Push locking lever forward as shown in the
figure.
154 TwinTop
Wind deflector 3
With the wind deflector installed
turbulence, draughts and noise in the
passenger compartment are reduced when
the roof is open.
The rear seats cannot be occupied when
the wind deflector is in place.
Do not place any objects on the wind
deflector.
With tyre repair set 3 , the wind deflector is
folded down into a storage
compartment 3 in the luggage
compartment below the loading floor
cover.
For the version with spare wheel 3, the
wind deflector is folded away in the
luggage compartment.
Fitting
Take the wind deflector from the luggage
compartment.
Expand the collapsed wind deflector as
illustrated.
155TwinTop
Join together the unfolded ends of the wind
deflector: press in the pin at the slider,
guide the hinge over the pin and release
the slider so that the pin engages in the
hinge.
Insert the guide clips of the wind deflector
in the seat belt recesses between the rear
head restraints.
Pull the toggle of the right and left locking
pin and turn to lock. Straighten out the
wind deflector, turn the toggle back and
engage the locking pin in the recess in the
side trim.
156 TwinTop
The wind deflector can be folded back
when not in use.
If the wind deflector is folded and the rear
seats are unoccupied, the wind deflector
can remain mounted in the vehicle when
the roof is closed.
Removing
Removal in reverse order, store wind
deflector fully folded in the luggage
compartment:
for tyre repair set 3, in the compartment
below the loading floor cover.
- for version with spare wheel 3, place in
the luggage compartment.
The wind deflector may never protrude
upwards or sideways from the luggage
compartment, see marked loading height,
see page 153, Figure 17973 T.
157Climate control
Climate control
Heating and ventilation system,
air conditioning system 3
Ventilation, heating and cooling 3 are
combined into one unit that is designed to
provide comfort regardless of the season,
weather or outside temperature.
When cooling 3 is activated, the air is
cooled and dried.
The heating unit heats the air as required in
all operating modes depending on the
position of the temperature switch. The air
supply can be adjusted to suit
requirements by means of the fan.
The buttons for cooling n and air
recirculation 4 are only found on
versions with optional air conditioning
system 3.
Air conditioning system 3
– pages 164, 166.
Air vents ............................................... 159
Cooled glove compartment 3 ............ 159
Heated rear window, heated exterior
mirrors 3 ............................................ 160
Heated seats 3.................................... 160
Heating and ventilation system ......... 161
Air conditioning system 3................... 164
Automatic air conditioning system 3 166
Electronic climate control system 3 ... 171
Air intake.............................................. 177
Pollen filter ........................................... 177
Note...................................................... 177
Maintenance ........................................ 177
158 Climate control
Automatic air conditioning
system 3
Provides a comfortable interior regardless
of the weather, outside temperature or
season.
When an interior temperature is set with
the temperature control, the temperature
and amount of inflowing air are
automatically regulated. A uniform,
comfortable climate in the vehicle is
thereby automatically obtained based on
outside climate conditions.
Automatic air conditioning system
– page 166.
Electronic
climate control system 3
Offers the greatest comfort in the vehicle
interior regardless of the conditions
outside.
To ensure a uniform and comfortable
climate in the vehicle, the temperature of
inflowing air, air-flow rate and air
distribution are automatically adapted
based on the climate conditions outside
the vehicle and the current temperature of
the vehicle interior.
The set values appear on the information
display.
Electronic climate control system
– page 171.
159Climate control
Air vents
Pleasant ventilation to the interior
controlled by the position of the
temperature switch.
To increase the air supply, turn the fan all
the way up and set the air distribution
switch to M or L.
Centre and side air vents (1)
Vents open: Vertical knurled wheel down.
Adjust the flow of air by turning the
horizontal knurled wheel.
To close the vent, turn the vertical adjuster
wheel fully up. The symbol 0 appears. The
slats of the vent remain open although the
air supply is closed.
Windscreen defroster nozzles (2)
Air distribution switch to
I or J :
Air flows onto windscreen and side
windows.
Additional vents
below the windscreen and door windows
and in the front footwell.
Cooled glove compartment 3
Cooled air is fed into the glove
compartment through a nozzle.
If glove compartment cooling is not
required, slide the slider forward.
160 Climate control
Heated rear window,
heated exterior mirrors 3
With the ignition on, the rear screen and
exterior mirror heating is switched on by
pressing button Ü:
LED Ü lights: rear screen and exterior
mirror heating.
LED Ü does not light: rear screen and
exterior mirror heating is switched off.
Heating works with the engine running and
is switched off automatically after around
15 minutes.
Astra TwinTop: The headed rear window
and heated exterior mirrors 3 are
deactivated when the roof is open.
Vehicles with diesel particle filter 3 : the
heated rear window is automatically
switched on during particle filter cleaning.
Heated seats 3
Operation with ignition switched on:
Press button ß one or more times to set the
desired heat output. The control indicator
in the button indicates which of the three
heating levels is active.
We do not recommend prolonged use of
the highest level for people with sensitive
skin.
Deactivation: Press button ß repeatedly
until the control indicator goes out.
Seat heating is operational when the
engine is running.
General information,
as well as information on air
intake, air outlet, pollen filter and
maintenance,
– page 177.
161Climate control
Heating and ventilation system
Left-hand rotary switch: Air distribution
L to head area via adjustable
air vents and to foot well
M to headroom via adjustable
air vents
l To the windscreen and
front door windows
J to the windscreen,
front door windows,
to foot well
K to foot well
Intermediate settings are possible.
Open the air vents when the switch is
set to L or M.
Centre rotary switch: Temperature
Turn right = warm
Turn left = cold
Right-hand rotary switch: air flow
Four fan speeds:
x = Off
4 = Maximum air flow
The rate of air flow is determined by the
fan. The fan should therefore also be
switched on during a journey.
162 Climate control
Ventilation
z For maximum ventilation in head area:
set air distribution switch to M and open
all vents
z Set the temperature to the desired
setting.
z Set the fan to the desired setting.
z For ventilation to foot well: Set air
distribution switch to K,
z For simultaneous ventilation to the head
area and the foot well: Set air
distribution switch to L.
Heating
The amount of heat is dependent on the
coolant temperature and is thus not fully
attained until the engine is warm.
For rapid warming of the passenger
compartment:
z Set air distribution switch to desired
position, preferably position J
– page 161.
z Turn the temperature switch clockwise as
far as it will go.
z Set the fan to speed 3.
z Open air vents
Vehicles with Quickheat
3 : depending on
the outside temperature and the engine
temperature the passenger compartment
is heated up more quickly using an
auxiliary electric heater.
The auxiliary electric heater switches itself
on automatically.
The comfort and general well-being of the
vehicle occupants are to a large extent
dependent on a suitable ventilation and
heating setting.
To achieve a stratification of temperature
with the pleasant effect of "cool head and
warm feet", turn the rotary switch for air
distribution to K or J, set temperature
rotary switch to any position (in the mid-
range with stratification of temperature).
163Climate control
Heating the foot well
z Set air distribution switch to K,
z Set the temperature switch in the right-
hand zone.
z Switch on fan.
Demisting and defrosting windows
Misted or icy windows, e. g. due to damp
weather, damp clothing or low outside
temperatures:
z Move air distribution switch to
I.
z Turn the temperature switch clockwise as
far as it will go (warm).
z Set fan to 3 or 4,
z Activate heated rear window Ü,
z Open side air vents as required and
direct them towards door windows.
z For simultaneous footwell heating, set
air distribution switch to J.
9 Warning
Failure to follow the instructions could
lead to misted or icy windows and
accidents stemming from impaired
visibility.
164 Climate control
Air conditioning system 3
As a supplement to the heating and
ventilation system, the air conditioning
system cools and dehumidifies (dries)
inflowing air.
If cooling or dehumidification is not
desired, switch off cooling in order to save
fuel.
Cooling switches off automatically at low
outside temperatures.
Cooling n
Operate only with the engine on and the
fan running:
Press On= n
Press off= n again
Control indicator in button.
Air recirculation system 4
The recirculation switch 4 is used to set
the ventilation system to recirculation
mode (control indicator in switch).
If fumes or unpleasant odours penetrate
from outside: temporarily switch on air
recirculation system 4.
To increase the cooling power at high
outside temperatures, temporarily switch
on the air recirculation system.
165Climate control
The air recirculation system minimises the
entry of outside air. The humidity
increases, and the windows can mist up.
The quality of the passenger compartment
air deteriorates which may cause the
vehicle occupants to feel drowsy.
Air distribution to
l : the air recirculation
system is automatically switched off to
speed up window demisting and prevent
fogging.
Comfort setting
z Set cooling n as desired.
z Air recirculation system 4 off.
z Set air distribution switch to M or L.
z Set temperature switch as desired.
z Switch on fan at desired speed
z Open or adjust vents as required.
Temperature switch in centre of
adjustment range: warmer air will flow into
the foot well and cooler air into the upper
zone, with warmer air coming from the side
air vents and cooler air from the centre
vents.
Maximum cooling
Open windows and sun roof 3 briefly so
that warm air can escape rapidly.
z Cooling n on.
z Activate recirculation system 4
z Set air distribution switch to M.
z Turn the temperature switch
anticlockwise as far as it will go (cold)
z Set fan to 4,
z Open all vents.
166 Climate control
Window demisting and de-icing
Misted or icy windows, e. g. due to damp
weather, damp clothing or low outside
temperatures:
z Cooling n on.
z Move air distribution switch to
I.
z Turn the temperature switch clockwise.
z Set fan to 4,
z Open side air vents as required and
direct them towards door windows.
z Activate heated rear window Ü,
z Open side air vents as required and
direct them towards the side windows.
Automatic air conditioning
system 3
Provides a uniformly comfortable interior
regardless of the weather, outside
temperature or season.
To ensure a constant and comfortable
climate in the vehicle, the temperature of
the inflowing air and the air-flow rate are
changed automatically based on climate
conditions outside the vehicle.
Temperature changes due to external
influences, such as direct sunlight, are
automatically compensated.
9 Warning
Failure to follow the instructions could
lead to misted or icy windows and
accidents stemming from impaired
visibility.
167Climate control
Automatic mode
Basic setting for maximum comfort:
z Set fan switch to A
z Set air distribution switch to desired
position - see next column
z Use rotary switch to set temperature
to 22 °C (a higher or lower temperature
can be set as desired)
z Air conditioning compressor activation
– page 168,
z All front air vents open. If desired, the
rear vents also 3.
Deactivation of the air conditioning
compressor can reduce the level of comfort
and safety – page 168.
Air distribution setting
L to head area via adjustable
air vents and to foot well
M to headroom via adjustable
air vents
l To the windscreen and
front door windows
J to the windscreen,
front door windows,
to foot well
K to foot well
Intermediate settings are possible.
Open the air vents when the switch is
set to L or M.
Temperature preset
Set the rotary switch to a value between
17 °C and 27 °C. Intermediate settings are
possible.
The selected temperature is maintained.
For reasons of comfort, temperature can
only be changed in small increments.
There is no temperature control for settings
below 17 °C (all the way left) or
above 27 °C (all the way right). The air
conditioning system works at maximum
cooling or heating.
168 Climate control
Air flow setting
1 - 4 Manual fan
speed setting.
Intermediate settings are possible.
A Automatic control
of fan speed
x Fan off
Fan speed is regulated to provide the rate
of air flow necessary to maintain the pre-
selected temperature.
Select automatic mode for the highest level
of comfort.
When the fan is off, the air conditioning
compressor is also off.
To activate/deactivate
air conditioning compressor (cooling) n
Operate only with the engine on and the
fan running:
Press On= n
Press off= n again
Control indicator in the button.
When cooling (AC compressor) is active, air
is cooled and dehumidified. If cooling or
dehumidification is not desired, switch off
cooling in order to save fuel.
Cooling switches off automatically at low
outside temperatures.
Manual air recirculation mode
The air recirculation system prevents the
entry of outside air and the air in the
passenger compartment is circulated.
Press button 4, control indicator in
button.
The exchange of fresh air is reduced in air
recirculation mode. The quality of the
passenger compartment air deteriorates
which may cause the vehicle occupants to
feel drowsy. In operation without cooling
the air humidity increases, so the windows
may mist up. Consequently, manual air
recirculation should only be run for short
periods of time.
To deactivate manual air recirculation:
Press button 4 again. The control
indicator in the button will go out.
169Climate control
Ventilation
z For maximum ventilation in head area:
set air distribution switch to M and open
all vents.
z For ventilation to foot well: Set air
distribution switch to K,
z For simultaneous ventilation to the head
area and the foot well: set air distribution
switch to L.
z Set desired temperature
z Set fan switch to A. The fan can also be
manually set: Set the rotary switch to
position
1 - 4. Intermediate settings are also
possible.
Heating
The amount of heat is dependent on the
coolant temperature and is thus not fully
attained until the engine is warm.
For rapid warming of the passenger
compartment:
z Set the air distribution switch to the
desired position – page 161.
z Set the centre rotary switch to the
desired temperature. We recommend a
value of about 22 °C.
z Set fan switch to A. The fan can also be
manually set: Set the rotary switch to
position 1 - 4. Intermediate settings are
also possible.
Vehicles with Quickheat
3 : depending on
the outside temperature and the engine
temperature the passenger compartment
is heated up more quickly using an
auxiliary electric heater.
The auxiliary electric heater switches itself
on automatically.
The comfort and general well-being of the
vehicle occupants are to a large extent
dependent on a suitable ventilation and
heating setting.
To obtain a stratification of temperature in
the vehicle with the pleasant effect "cool
head and warm feet", set the air
distribution switch to K or J, set the
temperature switch to about 22 °C and
open the centre air vents.
170 Climate control
Maximum cooling
for very hot interior
Open windows and sun roof 3 briefly so
that warm air can escape rapidly.
z Cooling n on.
z Set air distribution switch to M.
z Set the temperature switch to the desired
temperature.
z Set fan switch to A.
z Open all vents.
The automatic climate control system
provides maximum cooling down to the set
value.
At settings below 17 °C (rotary switch all
the way to the left), the system continually
runs with maximum cooling. When the air
conditioning compressor is running, air
recirculation is switched on automatically.
Window demisting and de-icing
Misted or icy windows, e. g. due to damp
weather, damp clothing or low outside
temperatures:
z Cooling n on.
z Press button V : In switch position A ,
the fan automatically switches to the
highest speed and air is directed to the
windscreen.
z Set temperature to maximum heating,
i.e. turn the centre rotary switch all the
way to the right (28 °C).
z Switch on heated rear window U.
Operation with cooling (air conditioning
compressor) is not possible when outside
temperatures are low.
To switch off, press button V again; the
automatic air conditioning system will
operate at the settings selected previously.
9 Warning
Failure to follow the instructions could
lead to misted or icy windows and
accidents stemming from impaired
visibility.
171Climate control
Electronic
climate control system 3
Provides a the greatest amount of comfort
in the interior regardless of the weather,
outside temperature or season.
To ensure a constant and comfortable
climate in the vehicle, the temperature of
the inflowing air, the air-flow rate and the
air distribution are changed automatically
according to climatic conditions outside
the vehicle.
Temperature changes due to external
influences, such as direct sunlight, are
automatically compensated.
Data is shown on the information display.
Setting modifications are briefly shown in
the information display, superimposing
over the currently displayed menu.
The display can vary according to the type
of presentation – page 46.
The settings in the climate control system
are stored in the vehicle key when the
vehicle is locked, see " Store personal
settings in vehicle key " – page 68.
Different settings are stored for each
remote control. Use of a remote control will
activate the settings associated with it.
Manual settings e.g. operating without
cooling and air distribution can be selected
using the menu – page 173.
When cooling (air conditioning
compressor) is active, air is cooled and
dehumidified.
The pollen filter removes dust, soot, pollen
and spores from the inflowing outside air.
The automatic air recirculation system 3
has an air quality sensor to detect harmful
ambient gases, in which case it will switch
automatically to recirculation.
When set to automatic mode, the climate
control system provides the optimal
settings for almost all conditions. If
necessary, climate control system settings
can be modified manually.
The climate control system is only
operational when the engine is running.
Cooling (air conditioning compressor)
switches off automatically at low outside
temperatures.
172 Climate control
Automatic mode
Basic setting for maximum comfort:
z Press AUTO button.
z Open all air vents.
z Air conditioning compressor activation
– page 174,
z Set pre-selected temperature to 22 °C
using left rotary knob.
The temperature can be set higher or lower
as desired.
Switching off the AC compressor (Eco
appears in display) can reduce comfort
and affect safety – page 174.
All air vents are actuated automatically in
automatic mode. The air vents should
therefore always be open – page 159.
Automatic air recirculation mode 3
The ventilation system is set to recirculation
mode and interior air is recirculated.
The automatic air recirculation system has
an air quality sensor to detect harmful
gases in the outside air, in which case it will
switch automatically to recirculation.
If outside temperatures are low and
cooling (air conditioning compressor) is
switched off, automatic air recirculation is
only available in a limited capacity so as to
prevent the windows from misting. Activate
recirculation manually if so desired.
Switching automatic recirculation on or off
– page 176.
Manual recirculation mode – page 176.
173Climate control
Temperature preset
The left rotary knob can be used to set
temperatures between 16 °C and 28 °C.
For reasons of comfort, temperature can
only be changed in small increments.
Vehicles with Quickheat
3 : depending on
the outside temperature and the engine
temperature the passenger compartment
is heated up more quickly using an
auxiliary electric heater.
The auxiliary electric heater switches itself
on automatically.
If a temperature below 16 °C is set, Lo
appears in the display: the climate control
system runs constantly at maximum
cooling power. The temperature is not
regulated.
If a temperature above 28 °C is set, Hi
appears in the display: the climate control
system runs constantly at maximum
heating power. The temperature is not
regulated.
Manual settings
Under certain circumstances (e.g. iced or
misted windows), the functions of the
climate control system can be modified
manually.
Climate control system settings can be
changed via the centre knob, the buttons
and the menus depicted on the display.
Press the centre knob to call up the menu.
The menu for manual climate control
system settings appears in the display.
Individual menu items are marked by
turning the centre knob and selected by
pressing it. Selecting certain menus by
pressing the knob will open a submenu 3.
To exit a menu, turn the centre knob left or
right to Return or Main and select.
Climate
Air distribut.
AC
Autom. blower
Auto. recirc
Air distribut.
174 Climate control
Window demisting and de-icing
Misted or icy windows, e. g. due to damp
weather, damp clothing or low outside
temperatures:
Press V button. V appears in display:
control indicator in button illuminates.
The temperature and the air distribution
are adjusted automatically, the fan runs at
a faster speed and the windows are rapidly
cleared of ice and moisture.
The air flow can be increased or decreased
by turning the right knob.
To return to automatic mode: press
button V or AUTO.
Heated rear window – page 160.
Activating and deactivating air
conditioning compressor
If no cooling or dehumidification is
required, switch the air conditioning
compressor off (maximum energy savings):
Mark menu item AC from the manual
settings menu and select by pressing. Eco
appears on the display.
Inflowing air is neither cooled nor
dehumidified. This restricts the level of
comfort provided by the electronic climate
control system. This may cause the
windows to mist up, for example.
To activate cooling: Select menu item AC
from the manual settings menu and press
to activate cooling.
9 Warning
Failure to follow the instructions could
lead to misted or icy windows and
accidents stemming from impaired
visibility.
Climate
Air distribut.
AC Air conditioning
Autom. blower on / off
Auto. recirc
175Climate control
Air distribution
Press the centre knob. The possible air
distribution settings appear one after
another in the display.
Air distribution can also be set in the Air
distribut. menu:
Up Air distribution to windscreen
and front door windows
Centre Air to vehicle occupants
via front adjustable air vents
Down Air distribution to foot well
Return to automatic air distribution:
Deactivate corresponding setting or press
button AUTO.
Air flow
Turn right knob right or left. The selected
fan speed in indicated with x and the
number in the display.
At speed 0 both the fan and cooling (air
conditioning compressor) are switched off.
To return to automatic mode: Press AUTO
button.
Fan control in automatic mode 3
Fan regulation in automatic mode can be
modified.
Select menu item Automatic blower from
the manual settings menu and select the
desired fan control.
Depending on the setting, the maximum
air flow, and thereby the noise level, will
increase.
Air distribut.
Automatic blower
Strong
Normal
Weak
176 Climate control
Switching automatic recirculation 3 on
or off
The automatic air recirculation system has
an air quality sensor to detect harmful
gases in the outside air, in which case it will
switch automatically to recirculation.
Select menu item Auto. recirc from the
manual settings menu and switch it on or
off by pressing.
Switch to manual air recirculation as
necessary.
Manual air recirculation mode
The air recirculation system prevents the
entry of outside air and the air in the
passenger compartment is circulated.
Press button 4, the control indicator in
the button will illuminate.
The exchange of fresh air is reduced in air
recirculation mode. The quality of the
passenger compartment air deteriorates
which may cause the vehicle occupants to
feel drowsy. In operation without cooling
the air humidity increases, so the windows
may mist up. Consequently, manual air
recirculation should only be run for short
periods of time.
To deactivate manual air recirculation:
Press button 4 again. The control
indicator in the button will go out.
Air conditioning with the engine not
running
When the vehicle is stopped and the
ignition off, the heat or cooling power still
in the system can be used to condition the
passenger compartment, for example
when stopped at a level crossing.
Press button AUTO with the ignition off.
Residual air conditioning on will appear
briefly in the display.
The air conditioning will operate for a
limited period of time.
To cancel air conditioning, press the AUTO
button.
Climate
Air distribut.
AC
Autom. blower
Auto. recirc
Automatic
recirculation
air control at
bad outside air
Residual air conditioning on
177Climate control
Air intake
The air intakes in front of the windscreen in
the engine compartment must be kept
clear to allow air intake. Remove any
leaves, dirt or snow.
Pollen filter
The pollen filter cleans dust, soot, pollen
and spores from the air entering from
outside. The active carbon layer 3
eliminates most odours and harmful
ambient gases from the air.
Replace the pollen filter at the intervals
given in the Service Booklet.
Note
If the windscreen mists up during damp
weather, temporarily set the system as
described under "Demisting and defrosting
the windows" – pages 163, 166 or 174.
Cooling 3 is most efficient when the
windows are closed. If the interior is
extremely hot due to a long period in
strong sunlight, briefly open the windows
and sun roof 3 to allow the hot air to
escape quickly.
When cooling 3 (air conditioning
compressor) is switched on condensation
forms, which is expelled from the underside
of the vehicle.
At least one air vent must be open while
cooling 3 (air conditioning compressor) is
on in order to prevent the evaporator from
icing up due to lack of air movement.
Cooling switches off automatically at low
outside temperatures.
Do not cover the sensor on the instrument
panel as this could cause the climate
control 3 system to malfunction.
Maintenance
In order to ensure continuously efficient
performance, the air conditioning
compressor 3 must be operated for a few
minutes once a month, irrespective of the
weather and time of year. The climate
control system, if present, handles this
automatically while driving. Air
conditioning compressor operation is not
possible when outside temperatures are
low.
If a fault occurs, consult a workshop. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
178 Easytronic
Easytronic
Easytronic 3
The semi-automatic Easytronic
transmission permits manual (manual
mode) or automatic gear shifting
(automatic mode), both with automatic
clutch control.
Transmission display
Shows the mode and current gear.
The display flashes for a few seconds when
A, M or R is selected with the engine
running and the foot brake not activated.
Transmission display ........................... 178
Starting the engine.............................. 179
Easytronic operation via the selector
lever.................................................... 179
Move selector lever toward N............. 179
Starting off........................................... 180
Electronically controlled driving
programmes ...................................... 181
Winter programme T ......................... 182
Kickdown.............................................. 182
Braking assistance from engine......... 183
"Rocking the car" ................................. 183
Manoeuvring the vehicle..................... 183
Stopping the vehicle............................ 184
Vehicle storage .................................... 184
Fault...................................................... 184
Interruption of power supply .............. 185
9 Warning
Disregard of these instructions may lead
to injuries or endanger life.
179Easytronic
Starting the engine
When starting the engine, press the foot
brake at the same time. The engine can
only be started with the foot brake pressed.
The gear display shows "N". If the foot
brake is not operated, the control indicator
j lights and "N" flashes in the gear
display, and the engine cannot be started.
Also the vehicle cannot be started if all
brake lights have failed.
There is no need to select neutral before
starting the engine. If a gear is engaged,
the transmission automatically switches to
neutral (N) before the engine starts when
the foot brake is operated. This can lead to
a slight delay in the starting process.
Easytronic operation via the
selector lever
Always move the selector lever in the
appropriate direction as far as it will go.
Upon release, it automatically returns to
the centre position. Pay heed to the gear/
mode indicator in the transmission display.
Move selector lever toward N
Neutral.
180 Easytronic
Starting off
Depress the foot brake, release the hand
brake and move the selector lever to A ,
+ or -. Easytronic is in automatic mode and
first gear is engaged (second gear if the
Winter programme is active). "A1" appears
in the transmission display ("A2" if the
Winter programme is active).
The vehicle begins to "creep" when the foot
brake is released.
It is also possible to start off without
depressing the foot brake if the accelerator
pedal is operated directly after movement
of the selector lever. If there is no
immediate acceleration or the foot brake is
not depressed, no gear is engaged and "A"
flashes. After a few seconds, the display
resumes showing "N". Start off by
repeating the previously described
procedure.
In Automatic mode, selection of other
gears is automatic irrespective of driving
conditions.
Move selector lever toward A
Switch between Automatic and Manual
mode.
Manual gear shifting is possible in manual
mode. "M" and the currently engaged gear
appear in the transmission display.
If the engine speed is too low the Easytronic
will automatically shift to a lower gear even
in Manual mode. This prevents the engine
from stalling.
Move selector lever toward + or -
+ Shift to a higher gear.
- Shift to a lower gear.
If a higher gear is selected when the
running speed is too low, or a lower gear
when the speed is too high, no shift is
effected. This prevents the engine from
running at too low or too high revs.
Gears can be skipped by moving the
selector lever repeatedly at short intervals.
181Easytronic
If the vehicle is in automatic mode, on
movement of the selector lever to
+ or -
Easytronic shifts to manual mode and
changes up or down. "M" and the currently
engaged gear appear in the transmission
display.
Move selector lever toward R
Reverse gear. Engage only when vehicle is
stationary.
Depress the foot brake, release the hand
brake and move the selector lever to R.
Reverse gear is engaged. "R" appears in
the transmission display.
The vehicle begins to "creep" when the foot
brake is released.
It is also possible to start off in reverse
without depressing the foot brake if the
accelerator pedal is operated directly after
movement of the selector lever. If there is
no immediate acceleration or the foot
brake is not depressed, no gear is engaged
and "R" flashes. After a few seconds, the
display resumes showing "N". Start off by
repeating the previously described
procedure.
Electronically controlled driving
programmes
z By means of delayed gear changing
(higher engine speeds) following a cold
start, the operating temperature
programme in automatic mode quickly
and automatically brings the catalytic
converter to the temperature required
for optimum pollutant reduction.
z Adaptive programmes automatically
adapt gear shifting in automatic mode
to suit the driving conditions, such as if
the vehicle is towing a caravan/trailer,
has a high payload, or is being driven on
inclines.
z When SPORT mode is engaged, shift
times are reduced and the transmission
shifts at higher engine speeds (unless
cruise control is on). SPORT mode
– page 214.
z Winter programme: Press button T
– see next page.
182 Easytronic
Winter programme T
In the event of difficulties starting off on
slippery roads, press button T ("A",
currently engaged gear and T appear in
the transmission display). Easytronic
switches to automatic mode and the
vehicle sets off in second gear.
The winter program is switched off by:
z pressing button T again,
z turning off the ignition.
In order to protect the Easytronic the winter
programme automatically switches itself
off at extremely high clutch temperatures.
If the Winter programme is activated,
SPORT mode is deactivated.
If the vehicle is switched to manual mode
while the winter programme is active, the
winter programme is interrupted. The
winter programme resumes upon return to
automatic mode.
Kickdown
Accelerator pedal pressed past the
pressure point: below certain speeds, the
transmission shifts down into a lower gear.
Full engine power is available for
acceleration.
During kickdown no manual gear shifting is
possible.
183Easytronic
When the engine speed approaches its
upper limit, the transmission shifts to a
higher gear during kickdown even in
Manual mode.
Without kickdown this automatic shift is
not effected in Manual mode.
If SPORT mode is engaged, the drive
wheels may spin slightly when starting off
with kickdown. This allows for maximum
acceleration of the vehicle.
Braking assistance from
engine
Automatic mode:
When driving downhill, Easytronic does not
shift into higher gears until a fairly high
engine speed has been reached. When
braking, Easytronic shifts down in good
time.
Manual mode:
To utilise the engine braking effect, select a
lower gear in good time when driving
downhill.
"Rocking the car"
If it becomes necessary to rock the vehicle
to free it from sand, mud, snow or a hole,
move the selector lever between R and A
(or + or -) in a repeat pattern while applying
light pressure to the accelerator pedal. Do
not race the engine and avoid sudden
acceleration.
This applies only to the exceptional
circumstances mentioned above.
Manoeuvring the vehicle
To manoeuvre the vehicle back and forth
during attempts to park or in garage
entrances the creeping movement can be
utilised by releasing the foot brake.
Never actuate accelerator and brake
pedals simultaneously.
To prevent damage, Easytronic
disengages the "creep function" when the
temperature of the automatic clutch is
high.
184 Easytronic
Stopping the vehicle
In Automatic or Manual mode, when the
vehicle has stopped first gear (with Winter
mode engaged, second gear) is engaged
automatically and the clutch released. In R
reverse remains engaged.
A warning buzzer sounds when the driver’s
door is opened if the engine is running, a
gear is engaged and the foot brake is not
depressed. The vehicle creeps if the hand
brake is not engaged. Move the selector
lever to N and apply the hand brake.
When stopping on gradients, engage the
hand brake or depress the brake pedal. To
prevent overheating of the clutch, do not
increase engine speed to ensure smooth
idling when in gear.
To prevent damage to the Easytronic, the
clutch is closed automatically at high
clutch temperatures.
Switch off engine if stopping for a lengthy
period, e.g. in traffic jams or at level
crossings.
Vehicle storage
Before leaving the vehicle:
z engage hand brake
z Remove the ignition key or, with the
Open&Start system 3, remove the
electronic key from the vehicle.
The most recently engaged gear (indicator
in transmission display) remains engaged.
With N, no gear is engaged.
When the ignition is switched off the
Easytronic no longer responds to
movement of the selector lever.
Lock the vehicle. Otherwise the battery
may become discharged if the vehicle is
parked for long periods.
If the hand brake has not been applied, the
control indicator R flashes for a few
seconds after the ignition is switched off.
With the engine off and the hand brake not
applied, when the driver’s door is opened a
warning buzzer sounds and the control
indicator R flashes; switch on ignition,
engage gear, switch off ignition and apply
hand brake.
Fault
Control indicator A illuminates in the
event of a fault in the Easytronic system. In
the event of serious faults, F also appears
in the transmission display.
It is possible to continue driving if only
control indicator A illuminates. Manual
mode can then no longer be selected.
If F appears in the transmission display,
continued driving is not possible.
Have the cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer. The system’s
integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to
be quickly remedied.
185Easytronic
Interruption of power supply
The clutch is not disengaged if the vehicle
battery is discharged and a gear has been
selected. The vehicle cannot move.
If the battery is flat, start the vehicle using
jump leads – page 248.
If the interruption of power supply was not
caused by a discharged battery, consult a
workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer. If the vehicle must be
moved out of the flow of traffic, disengage
the clutch on vehicles with 5-speed
Easytronic. Disengaging the clutch is not
possible on vehicles with 6-speed
Easytronic 3. The vehicle must be moved.
Raise the vehicle by the front axle when
towing.
To disengage the clutch (only on vehicles
with 5-speed Easytronic):
1. Apply hand brake and switch off
ignition.
2. Open bonnet and engage support.
3. Clean Easytronic around the cap (see
figure) so that no dirt can get into the
opening when the cap is removed.
4. Rotate cap to slacken and remove by
lifting upwards – see figure.
5. Turn the adjusting screw clockwise using
a flat-head screwdriver (vehicle tools 3
– page 256) until clear resistance can be
felt. The clutch has now been
disengaged.
Do not turn beyond the resistance, since
this can damage the Easytronic.
6. Fit cleaned cap again. The cap must be
in full contact with the housing.
Towing the vehicle and starting the engine
is not permitted when the clutch has been
released in this way, although the vehicle
can be moved a short distance.
Consult a workshop immediately. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
186 Automatic transmission
Automatic
transmission
The automatic transmission 3 allows
automatic selection.
The engine can only be started when the
gear selector is in position P or N . When
starting in position N, depress the foot
brake or apply the hand brake. After
starting the engine, depress the brake
before selecting a gear. Do not accelerate
whilst selecting a gear. If a gear has been
selected and the brake is released, the
vehicle will "creep". Never operate the
accelerator and the brake pedal
simultaneously. The selected gear is
displayed in the transmission display.
Only select 3, 2 or 1 to prevent automatic
upshifting or as an aid in engine braking.
Transmission display
Display of mode or selected gear in left
position of transmission display. The gear
that has been selected by the transmission
appears in the right position of the
transmission display.
Selector lever positions P, R, N and D 187
Gears 3, 2, 1 ......................................... 187
Electronically controlled driving
programmes ...................................... 188
Winter programme T ......................... 189
Kickdown.............................................. 189
Engine braking..................................... 189
"Rocking the car" ................................. 189
Manoeuvring the vehicle..................... 190
Stopping the vehicle............................ 190
Fault...................................................... 190
Interruption of power supply .............. 191
9 Warning
Disregard of these instructions may lead
to injuries or endanger life.
P Park position.
R Reverse gear.
N Neutral.
D Drive position.
3, 2, 1 Selected gear 3.
187Automatic transmission
Selector lever positions P, R, N
and D
The selector lever can only be moved from
P when the ignition is switched on and the
foot brake depressed (selector lever lock).
To engage P or R, push button on selector
lever.
The engine can only be started with lever in
position P or N . When position N is
selected, press foot brake or engage hand
brake before starting.
Do not accelerate during the selection
procedure.
Gears 3, 2, 1
Press button on selector lever to
engage 3 or 1.
The current gear is displayed in the
transmission display.
P Park position. Front wheels locked.
Only engage when the vehicle is
stationary and the hand brake is
applied. "P" appears on the
transmission display.
R Reverse gear. Only engage when the
vehicle is stationary. "R" appears on
the transmission display.
N Neutral or idle. "N" appears on the
transmission display.
D Drive position for normal driving in 1st
gear to highest gear. "D" and the
current gear appear in the
transmission display.
3, 2, 1 Transmission does not shift above
the selected gear.
188 Automatic transmission
Electronically controlled driving
programmes
z When SPORT mode is engaged, the
transmission shifts at higher engine
speeds (unless cruise control is on).
Control indicator 1 illuminates in the
transmission display. SPORT mode
– page 214.
z Winter programme: Press button T
– page 189.
z Automatic neutral shift function
automatically sets the transmission to N
to reduce fuel consumption, e.g. at
traffic lights.
The automatic neutral is activated when:
As soon as the brake is released and the
accelerator pedal is depressed, the
vehicle starts off in the usual manner.
z By means of delayed gear changing
(higher engine speeds) following a cold
start, the operating temperature
programme quickly and automatically
brings the catalytic converter to the
temperature required for optimum
pollutant reduction.
z The adaptive programme automatically
tailors gearshifting to the driving
conditions, e.g. greater load or
gradients.
the selector lever is in automatic
mode 3,
the selector lever is in position 3, 2 or
1,
the foot brake is depressed,
the vehicle is stationary,
the accelerator pedal is not
actuated,
the transmission fluid temperature is
greater than 0 °C.
189Automatic transmission
Winter programme T
Press button T if you are having problems
starting off on a slippery road surface.
To activate
The winter programme can be activated in
P , R, N , D and 3 (T illuminates in the
transmission display). The vehicle starts off
in 3rd gear.
To deactivate
The winter program is switched off by:
z pressing button T again,
z shifting to 2 or 1 manually,
z turning off the ignition.
In order to prevent damage, the winter
program switches off automatically at high
transmission oil temperatures.
Kickdown
Depressing the accelerator pedal past the
pressure point: depending on the engine
speed the transmission shifts to a lower
gear. Full engine power is available for
accelerating.
Engine braking
In order to utilise the engine braking effect
when driving downhill, select drive range 3,
2 or, if necessary, 1 in good time.
The braking action is most effective in drive
range 1 . If drive range 1 is selected at too
high a speed, the transmission remains in
second gear until the shift point for first
gear is reached, e.g. as a result of
deceleration.
"Rocking the car"
If it becomes necessary to rock the vehicle
to free it from sand, mud, snow or a hole,
move the selector lever from D to R in a
repeat pattern while simultaneously
applying light pressure to the accelerator
pedal. Do not race the engine and avoid
sudden acceleration.
This applies only to the exceptional
circumstances mentioned above.
190 Automatic transmission
Manoeuvring the vehicle
To manoeuvre the vehicle back and forth
during attempts to park or in garage
entrances, the vehicle’s creeping
movement can be utilised by releasing the
brake pedal.
Never actuate accelerator and brake
pedals simultaneously.
Stopping the vehicle
The selector lever can be left in the chosen
gear with the engine running.
When stopping on gradients engage hand
brake or depress brake pedal. To prevent
overheating of the transmission, do not
increase engine revolutions to ensure
smooth idling while standing if a gear has
been selected.
Switch off engine if stopping for a lengthy
period, e.g. in traffic jams or at level
crossings.
Before leaving the vehicle, first apply the
hand brake. Then select P . Remove the
ignition key or, with Open&Start system,
remove the electronic key 3 from the
vehicle. Lock the vehicle. Otherwise the
battery may become discharged if the
vehicle is parked up for long periods.
The ignition key can only be removed when
the selector lever is in position P.
With the Open&Start system 3 , "P" fl ashes
in the transmission display for 10 seconds
when the ignition is switched off if P has
not been engaged or the hand brake has
not been applied.
Fault
If there is a problem with the automatic
transmission, control indicator A
illuminates. The transmission no longer
shifts automatically. The vehicle can
continue to be driven.
Illumination of control indicator A may
also indicate a problem with the engine
electronics – page 210.
For diesel engines
1)
Z 19 DTL, Z 19 DT and
Z 19 DTH , illumination of control
indicator A could also indicate that the
diesel fuel filter must be drained of water
- page 300.
Have the cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
1)
Sales designation – see page 315.
191Automatic transmission
The transmission no longer shifts
automatically. Vehicle can continue to be
driven. Second gear is not available.
Forward gears 1, 3 and 4 must be shifted
manually using selector lever:
Interruption of power supply
If the vehicle battery is flat, the selector
lever cannot be moved out of position P.
If the battery is flat, start the vehicle using
jump leads – see page 248.
If the battery is not the cause of the fault,
release selector lever:
1. Apply hand brake.
2. Disengage selector lever trim rearward
from centre console and fold upwards.
3. Push the yellow catch forward with a
screwdriver and move the selector lever
out of P.
4. Mount selector lever trim on centre
console and refit.
Re-selecting P locks the selector lever
again. Have cause of power supply
interruption remedied. We recommend
that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
1 = 1st gear
2 =3rd gear
3, D =4th gear
192 Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect
Automatic
transmission
with ActiveSelect
This automatic transmission 3 allows both
automatic gearchanges
(automatic mode ) and manual
gearchanges (manual mode) 3.
The engine can only be started when the
selector lever is in position P or N . When
starting in position N, depress the foot
brake or apply the hand brake. After the
engine has started, depress the brake
before selecting a gear. Do not accelerate
whilst selecting a gear. If a gear has been
selected and the brake is released, the
vehicle will "creep". Never operate the
accelerator and the brake pedal
simultaneously. The selected gear is
displayed in the transmission display
– page 193.
Selecting D puts the transmission in
automatic mode.
If the selector lever is moved to the left from
the D position, manual mode is activated.
Gearchanges can then be made manually
by tipping the selector lever toward + or -.
Transmission display ........................... 193
Selector lever settings P, R, N and D
(automatic mode)............................. 193
ActiveSelect (manual mode) .............. 194
Electronically controlled driving
programmes ...................................... 195
Winter programme T ......................... 196
Kickdown.............................................. 196
Engine braking..................................... 197
"Rocking the car" ................................. 197
Manoeuvring the vehicle..................... 197
Stopping the vehicle............................ 198
Fault...................................................... 198
Interruption of power supply .............. 199
9 Warning
Disregard of these instructions may lead
to injuries or endanger life.
193Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect
Transmission display
Display of mode or selected gear in left
position of transmission display. The gear
that has been selected by the transmission
appears in the right position of the
transmission display.
Selector lever settings P, R, N
and D (automatic mode)
The selector lever can only be moved out of
position P or N with the ignition switched
on and the foot brake applied (selector
lever lock). In selector lever position N the
selector lever lock is activated after a delay
and only if the vehicle is stationary.
P Park position.
R Reverse gear.
N Neutral.
D Automatic mode.
M Manual mode with display of
selected gear.
P Park position. Front wheels locked.
Only engage when the vehicle is
stationary and the hand brake is
applied. "P" appears on the
transmission display.
R Reverse gear. Only engage when the
vehicle is stationary. "R" appears on
the transmission display.
N Neutral or idle. "N" appears on the
transmission display.
D Drive position for normal driving in 1st
gear to highest gear. "D" and the
current gear appear in the
transmission display.
194 Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect
In position P or N , control indicator j
illuminates red in the selector lever
indicator strip if the selector lever is
blocked.
To engage P or R, push button on selector
lever.
The engine can only be started with lever in
position P or N . When position N is
selected, press foot brake or engage hand
brake before starting.
Do not accelerate during the selection
procedure.
ActiveSelect (manual mode)
Move selector lever out of position D and
then forwards or backwards.
+ Shift to a higher gear
- Shift to a lower gear
If a higher gear is selected at a speed that
is too slow or a lower gear is selected at a
speed that is too high, the gear will not be
changed. This prevents the revs from being
too low or too high.
If the engine revs are too low the
transmission automatically shifts to a lower
gear, but not unless a certain speed has
been reached.
No automatic shifting to a higher gear
takes place at high engine revs.
For safety reasons, kickdown is also
available in manual mode – page 196.
The selected gear is displayed in the
transmission display – page 193.
195Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect
Electronically controlled driving
programmes
z When SPORT mode is engaged, the
transmission shifts at higher engine
speeds (unless cruise control is on).
Control indicator 1 illuminates in the
transmission display. SPORT mode
– page 214.
z Winter programme: Press button T
– page 196.
z Automatic neutral shift function
automatically sets the transmission to N
to reduce fuel consumption, e.g. at
traffic lights.
The automatic neutral is activated when:
As soon as the brake is released and the
accelerator pedal is depressed, the
vehicle starts off in the usual manner.
z The operating temperature programme
automatically brings the catalytic
converter to the temperature that is
required for optimum emission reduction
after a cold start by selecting an
appropriate gear (increased engine
revs).
z The adaptive programme automatically
tailors gearshifting to the driving
conditions, e.g. greater load or
gradients.
the selector lever is in automatic or
manual mode,
the foot brake is depressed,
the vehicle is stationary,
the accelerator pedal is not
actuated,
the transmission fluid temperature is
greater than 0 °C.
196 Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect
Winter programme T
Press button T if you are having problems
starting off on a slippery road surface.
To activate
The winter programme can be activated in
automatic mode (T illuminates in
transmission display). The vehicle starts off
in 4th gear.
To deactivate
The winter program is switched off by:
z pressing button T again,
z changing to manual mode,
z turning off the ignition.
In order to prevent damage, the winter
program switches off automatically at high
transmission oil temperatures.
Kickdown
Depressing the accelerator pedal past the
pressure point: depending on the engine
speed the transmission shifts to a lower
gear. Full engine power is available for
accelerating.
For safety reasons kickdown is available in
both automatic and manual mode.
197Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect
Engine braking
The automatic transmission automatically
selects the driving programs with the best
possible braking effect.
If necessary, lower gears can also be
selected in manual mode to increase the
braking effect. 1st gear has the greatest
braking effect.
"Rocking the car"
If it becomes necessary to rock the vehicle
to free it from sand, mud, snow or a hole,
move the selector lever from D to R in a
repeat pattern while simultaneously
applying light pressure to the accelerator
pedal. Do not race the engine and avoid
sudden acceleration.
This applies only to the exceptional
circumstances mentioned above.
Manoeuvring the vehicle
To manoeuvre the vehicle back and forth
during attempts to park or in garage
entrances, the vehicle’s creeping
movement can be utilised by releasing the
brake pedal.
Never actuate accelerator and brake
pedals simultaneously.
198 Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect
Stopping the vehicle
The selector lever can be left in the chosen
gear with the engine running.
When stopping on gradients engage hand
brake or depress brake pedal. To prevent
overheating of the transmission, do not
increase engine revolutions to ensure
smooth idling while standing if a gear has
been selected.
Switch off engine if stopping for a lengthy
period, e.g. in traffic jams or at level
crossings.
Before leaving the vehicle, first apply the
hand brake. Then select P. Remove the
ignition key or, with Open&Start system,
remove the electronic key 3 from the
vehicle. Lock the vehicle. Otherwise the
battery may become discharged if the
vehicle is parked up for long periods.
The ignition key can only be removed when
the selector lever is in position P.
If the selector lever is not in position P when
the ignition is switched off, control
indicator
j and P flash in the selector lever
indicator strip – page 194, Fig. 17194 T.
Move the selector lever to position P.
With the Open&Start system 3 , "P" fl ashes
in the transmission display for 10 seconds
when the ignition is switched off if P has
not been engaged or the hand brake has
not been applied.
Fault
If there is a problem with the automatic
transmission, control indicator A
illuminates. The transmission no longer
shifts automatically. The vehicle can
continue to be driven.
Illumination of control indicator A may
also indicate a problem with the engine
electronics – page 210.
For diesel engines
1)
Z19DTL, Z19DT
and Z 19 DTH , illumination of control
indicator A could also indicate that the
diesel fuel filter must be drained of water
- page 300.
Have the cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
1)
Sales designation – see page 315.
199Automatic transmission with ActiveSelect
2nd gear and the highest gear can be
selected in manual mode. Depending on
the nature of the problem, only the highest
gear may be available.
Only the highest gear is available in D in
automatic mode.
Interruption of power supply
If the vehicle battery is flat, the selector
lever cannot be moved out of position P or
N.
If the battery is flat, start the vehicle using
jump leads – page 248.
If the battery is not the cause of the fault,
release selector lever:
1. Apply hand brake.
2. Remove the ashtray insert 3 or the
rubber covering on the bottom of the
stowage compartment 3 - page 108.
3. To open, push the yellow catch down
with a screwdriver and move the selector
lever out of P or N.
4. Refit the ashtray insert 3 or rubber
covering on the bottom of the stowage
compartment 3 - page 108.
Re-selecting P or N locks the selector lever
again. Have cause of power supply
interruption remedied. We recommend
your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
200 Driving hints
Driving hints
The first 600 miles / 1000 km
Drive your vehicle at various speeds. Do
not use full throttle. Never allow the engine
to labour at low revs.
Make good use of all gears. Depress the
accelerator pedal a maximum of around
three quarters of the available pedal travel
in all gears.
Do not drive faster than three quarters of
maximum speed.
Do not brake unnecessarily hard for the
first 120 miles (200 km).
Never coast with engine not
running
Many units will not function in this situation
(e.g. brake servo unit, electro-hydraulic
power steering). Driving in this manner is a
danger to yourself and others.
Brake servo unit
When the engine is not running, the brake
servo unit is no longer effective once the
brake pedal has been depressed once or
twice. Braking effect is not reduced, but
significantly greater force is required for
braking.
Electro-hydraulic power assisted
steering
If the power-assisted steering fails when
being towed with the engine switched off,
the vehicle can still be steered, but
considerably more force is required.
Driving in mountainous terrain or
with a trailer/caravan
The cooling fan is electrically operated. Its
cooling power is therefore independent of
the engine speed.
Since a considerable amount of heat is
generated at high engine speeds and less
at slower speeds, do not shift down when
climbing hills whilst the vehicle is still coping
with the gradient in the higher gear.
Driving with a roof load
Do not exceed the permissible roof load
- pages 238, 324. For reasons of safety,
distribute the load evenly and secure it
properly with retaining straps. Adjust the
tyre pressure to the load conditions. Do not
drive faster than 75 mph (120 km/h). Check
and retighten the straps frequently.
Observe country-specific regulations. Roof
loads are not permitted on the Astra
TwinTop.
Switching off the engine
When you switch off, fans in the engine
compartment may continue running for a
time to cool the engine.
If the engine temperature is very high, e.g.
after driving in mountainous terrain: allow
the engine to idle for approximately two
minutes in order to prevent heat
accumulation.
201Driving hints
Vehicles with turbocharged engine
After running at high engine speeds or high
engine loads, operate the engine briefly at
a low load or run in neutral for approx. 30
seconds before switching off in order to
protect the turbocharger.
Save energy – more miles
Please observe the running-in hints on the
previous page and the tips for saving
energy on the following pages.
Good, technically correct and economical
driving ensures maximum durability and
performance for your vehicle.
Overrun
The fuel supply is automatically shut off
during overrun, e.g. when the vehicle is
being driven down long gradients or when
braking. To enable the overrun cut-off to
take effect, do not accelerate during
overrun and, if in manual transmission
mode, do not de-clutch. To prevent
damage to the catalytic converter, overrun
cut-off is temporarily deactivated when the
catalytic converter temperature is high.
Vehicles with turbocharged engine
Flow-generated noises may be audible if
the accelerator is released quickly on
account of air flow in the turbocharger.
Engine speed
Drive in a low engine speed range for each
gear as much as possible.
Warming up
Allow the engine to warm up while driving.
Do not warm it up by letting it run at idling
speed. Do not apply full throttle until the
engine has reached operating
temperature.
After a cold start, the automatic
transmission 3 or Easytronic 3 in
automatic mode shifts into higher gears at
higher rpm. This allows the catalytic
converter to quickly reach the temperature
required for optimum pollutant reduction.
Correct gear selection
Engine in neutral and without revving in the
lower gears. Stop-and-go traffic and
driving at a speed too high for the selected
gear or transmission ratio increases wear
and fuel consumption.
Change down
When decreasing speed, shift down into
the next lowest gear. Do not slip the clutch
with a high-revving engine. This is
especially important when hill climbing.
Clutch operation
Always depress the clutch pedal hard to
the floor to prevent shifting difficulties and
transmission damage.
When driving do not use the pedal as a
foot rest; this will cause substantial clutch
wear.
Cooling fan
The cooling fan is controlled via a
thermoswitch and therefore only runs if
necessary.
Vehicles with diesel particle filter 3 : the
cooling fan comes on automatically during
particle filter cleaning.
Pedals
Do not place any objects in the foot well
which could slip under the pedals and
inhibit the pedal travel.
To ensure the pedal travel is uninhibited,
there must be no mats in the area of the
pedals.
Battery care
When driving slowly or when the vehicle is
stationary, e.g. in slow urban traffic, stop-
and-go traffic or traffic jams, turn off all
unnecessary electrical loads where
possible (e.g. heated rear window, heated
seats).
Declutch when starting in order to relieve
the strain on the starter and the battery.
202 Saving fuel, Protecting the environment
Saving fuel,
Protecting the
environment
Trend-setting technology
When developing and manufacturing your
vehicle, Vauxhall used environment-
friendly and in the main recyclable
materials. The production methods used to
make your vehicle are likewise
environmentally-compatible.
Recycling of production wastes keeps the
circulation of material closed. Reduction of
energy and water requirements also helps
to conserve natural resources.
A highly advanced design means that your
vehicle can be easily disassembled at the
end of its working life, and the individual
materials separated for subsequent re-use.
Materials such as asbestos and cadmium
are not used. The refrigerant in the air
conditioning system 3 is CFC-free.
New painting techniques employ water as
a solvent.
End-of-life vehicle recovery
For detailed information on Vauxhall’s
on-going commitment to achieving an
environmentally sustainable future,
including; design for recycling, take back of
End-of-Life Vehicle (ELVs) and the
recycling of ELVs, view
www.vauxhall.co.uk/recycling for details.
Energy and environment-
conscious driving
z High noise levels and exhaust emissions
are often a result of driving without due
attention to saving energy and
protecting the environment.
z You should therefore drive with energy in
mind – "more miles with less fuel".
Reduce the noise level and exhaust
emissions by adopting an environment-
conscious driving style. This is extremely
worthwhile and improves the quality of
life.
Fuel consumption depends to a great
extent on your own personal driving
style. The following hints are intended to
help you consume fuel at a rate that is as
close as possible to the specified levels
– page 319.
Check your vehicle’s fuel consumption
every time you refuel. This facilitates
early detection of any irregularities
causing increased fuel consumption.
Warming up
z Full throttle and warming up at idle
speed increase wear, fuel consumption,
exhaust emission, the amount of
pollutant in the exhaust and the amount
of noise.
z Drive off as soon as possible after
starting.
Uniform speed
z Hectic driving significantly increases fuel
consumption, the exhaust emissions, the
proportion of pollutant in the exhaust
gas and the noise level.
z Do not accelerate and brake
unnecessarily. Drive at uniform speed,
watching the road.
Avoid frequent starting off and stopping
e.g. at traffic lights, in short distance
traffic and in queues of traffic by means
of clever planning. Select roads with
good traffic flow.
Idling
z The engine also consumes fuel when
idling.
z If you have to wait for more than one
minute, it is worthwhile switching off the
engine. Five minutes of idling
corresponds to approximately 0.6 miles
(1 km) of driving.
203Saving fuel, Protecting the environment
Overrun
z The fuel supply is automatically shut off
during overrun, e.g. when the vehicle is
being driven down long gradients or
when braking – page 201.
z To enable the overrun cut-off to come
into action and save fuel, do not
accelerate or declutch during overrun.
Correct gear selection
z High revs increase engine wear and fuel
consumption.
z Do not race your engine. Avoid driving at
high engine speeds.
Making use of the tachometer helps to
save fuel. Drive in a low engine speed
range for each gear as much as possible
with uniform engine speeds. Drive as
often as possible in top gear, select the
next higher gear as soon as possible,
and only change down when the engine
is no longer running perfectly smoothly.
High speed
z The higher the speed, the higher the
consumption and the noise level. At top
speed, you consume a great deal of fuel
and produce excessive noise and
exhaust emissions.
z Slightly releasing the accelerator pedal
results in distinct fuel savings with no
major loss of speed.
Drive at no more than around three
quarters of maximum speed and you will
use up to 50 % less fuel, without losing a
great deal of time.
Tyre pressure
z Inadequate tyre pressure, leading to
higher road resistance, costs money in
two ways: for more fuel and increased
tyre wear.
z Regular checks (every 14 days) pay off.
Electrical loads
z The power consumption of electrical
equipment increases fuel consumption.
z Switch off all auxiliary electrical loads
(e.g. air conditioning 3, heated rear
window) when not needed.
Roof racks, ski-holders
z Due to air resistance, a roof load can
increase fuel consumption by approx.
3.5 gal. /1000 miles (1 l/100 km).
z Remove them if they are not being used.
Repair and maintenance
z Improper repairs or adjustment and
maintenance work can increase fuel
consumption. Do not carry out work on
the engine yourself.
You may out of ignorance infringe
environmental laws by not disposing of
materials properly.
Appropriate parts might not be recycled.
Contact with some of the materials
involved may pose a health hazard.
z We recommend that repair and
maintenance be entrusted to your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Extreme driving conditions
z Going up steep slopes, cornering, driving
on poor roads and winter driving all
increase fuel consumption.
Fuel consumption increases dramatically
in urban traffic and at winter
temperatures, especially on short trips
when the engine operating temperature
is not reached.
z Follow the hints given above to keep
consumption to a minimum under such
conditions.
204 Fuel consumption, fuel, refuelling
Fuel consumption,
fuel, refuelling
Fuel consumption
Fuel consumption is determined under
specific driving conditions – page 319.
Special equipment increases the weight of
the vehicle. As a result, they can increase
fuel consumption and reduce the specified
maximum speed.
For the first few thousand miles, friction
between the engine and transmission
components is higher. This increases fuel
consumption.
Fuel for petrol engines
Normal commercial high-quality fuels with
a maximum ethanol content of 5% in
accordance with DIN EN 228 are suitable
(for catalytic converter – page 207, for
octane numbers – pages 314, 315). The
quality thereof has considerable effect on
the performance, running and service life
of the engine. The additives mixed with the
fuel are extremely important. For this
reason you must only refuel with
high quality fuels containing additives.
Fuels with ethanol content greater than 5%
do not comply with DIN EN 228 and must
not be used unless the vehicle has been
specifically developed and approved for
these fuels.
Fuel with too low an octane number can
cause pinking. Vauxhall cannot be held
liable for resulting damage.
Petrol with a higher octane number can
always be used.
The ignition timing adjusts automatically
to the grade of fuel used (octane number)
– pages 314, 315.
Use of petrol with an octane rating of 95
will ensure economical driving.
For vehicles with Z20 LEH
1)
engine, use of
95 RON fuel reduces performance and
torque.
Fuel for diesel engines......................... 205
Fuel filler cap........................................ 205
Refuelling.............................................. 205
1)
Sales designation – see page 314.
205Fuel consumption, fuel, refuelling
Fuel for diesel engines
Diesel engines must be operated only on
commercially available diesel fuel meeting
the specifications of DIN EN 590.
Since January 2004, some oil companies
have mixed their diesel fuel with upto 5%
Bio fuel (FAME = Fatty Acid Methyl Esters)
like RME (Rape-Oil Methyl Ester). This is in
accordance with the current DIN EN 590
and does not harm the fuel/injection
system. The characteristics of a diesel fuel
mixed up with 5% Bio fuel (FAME) do not
differ from conventional diesel fuel and do
not influence the vehicle’s driveability.
Important:
Diesel fuel mixed with 5% FAME
according to DIN EN 590 must not be
confused with 100% Bio Diesel, which is not
to be used in Vauxhall engines.
The flow and filterability of diesel fuel are
temperature-dependent.
Diesel fuels with improved low temperature
properties are therefore available on the
market during the winter months. Make
sure that you fill the tank with winter fuel
before the start of the cold weather
season.
Additives can be used with diesel fuels with
winter properties that are guaranteed by
the manufacturer and when using diesel
fuel filters that are heated depending on
the outside temperature.
Fuel filler cap
If replacing the fuel filler cap, be sure to use
a genuine Vauxhall fuel filler cap for your
model to ensure full functionality.
Diesel-engined vehicles have special fuel
filler caps.
Refuelling
6
9 Warning
Care must be taken when handling fuel.
Before refuelling, switch off the engine
and where applicable any auxiliary
heating with combustion chambers (see
sticker on fuel filler cap). Switch off
mobile phones.
206 Fuel consumption, fuel, refuelling
Fuel filler neck at right rear side of vehicle.
The tank flap is locked together with the
doors – page 76.
Open the tank flap.
Unscrew the fuel filler cap, remove and
suspend from the tank flap.
The fuel tank has a limiting system which
prevents overfilling of the tank.
Correct filling depends to a large extent on
proper operation of the fuel dispensing
pump:
1. Fully insert the pump nozzle and switch it
on.
2. After automatic switch off, the specified
tank capacity is reached after continued,
measured filling. Leave the filler nozzle in
place until the stop.
To close, position the fuel filler cap and
rotate past the resistance until the cap
audibly clicks over the retainer.
Close fuel tank cover.
Wipe off any overflowing fuel immediately.
9 Warning
Fuel is flammable and explosive. avoid
naked flames or sparks when handling
fuel or just in its vicinity. Do not smoke.
This also applies where fuel is perceptible
only from its characteristic odour. If fuel
odours occur in the vehicle itself,
eliminate the cause immediately. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
207Catalytic converter, exhaust gases
Catalytic converter,
exhaust gases
Catalytic converter for petrol
engines
Leaded fuel will damage the catalytic
converter and parts of the electronic
system, rendering them inoperative.
High quality fuels other than those listed on
pages 204, 314 (e. g. LRP
1)
) could damage
the catalytic converter.
Damage to the catalytic converter or the
vehicle may result if the following points
are not observed:
z Consult a workshop, such as your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, as quickly
as possible in the event of misfiring,
irregular engine running following a cold
start, a significant loss of engine power
or other unusual malfunctions which
may indicate a fault in the ignition
system. If necessary, driving may be
continued for a short time at a low speed
and with a low engine speed.
Irregular engine running and a loss of
engine power when the Electronic
Stability Program (ESP ®
Plus
3) comes
into action are the result of operating
conditions and are therefore of no
significance - page 212.
6
Catalytic converter for petrol engines 207
Catalytic converter for diesel engines 208
Controlling exhaust emission.............. 209
Exhaust gases...................................... 210
Maintenance ........................................ 211
1)
LRP = L ead R eplacement P etrol.
208 Catalytic converter, exhaust gases
z If unburned fuel enters the catalytic
converter, this may result in overheating
and irreparable damage to the catalytic
converter.
You should therefore avoid
unnecessarily long use of the starter
when starting off, running the tank dry
(an irregular fuel supply will lead to
overheating) and starting the engine by
pushing or towing.
z If the emission control indicator Z
flashes, slow down until the flashing
stops and the control indicator is steady.
Consult a workshop immediately. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer. For emission control indicator
Z – page 209.
Catalytic converter for diesel
engines
Damage to the catalytic converter or the
vehicle may result if the following points
are not observed:
z Consult a workshop, such as your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, as quickly
as possible in the event of irregular
engine running, a significant loss of
engine power or other unusual
malfunctions. If necessary, driving may
be continued for a short time at a low
speed and with a low engine speed.
Irregular engine running and a loss of
engine power when the Electronic
Stability Program (ESP ®
Plus
3) comes
into action are the result of operating
conditions and are therefore of no
significance - page 212.
209Catalytic converter, exhaust gases
Controlling exhaust emission
Some of the damaging substances in the
exhaust such as carbon monoxide (CO),
hydrocarbons (HC) and nitrous oxides
(NO
x
) are reduced to a minimum by
making structural changes – mainly in the
injection system and the ignition system in
conjunction with the catalytic converter.
Control indicator Z for exhaust
Illuminates when the ignition is switched on
and during the start attempt. Goes off
shortly after the engine starts running.
If it illuminates while the engine running
there is a fault in the emission control
system. The permitted emission values may
be exceeded. Consult a workshop
immediately. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Flashing with the engine running indicates
a fault that may damage the catalytic
converter. You can continue to drive
without causing damage by slowing down
until the flashing stops and the control
indicator is steady. Consult a workshop
immediately. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
210 Catalytic converter, exhaust gases
Control indicator A for engine
electronics
Illuminates for a few seconds after the
ignition is switched on.
If it illuminates when the engine is running,
there is a fault in engine or transmission
electronics. The electronic system switches
to an emergency running programme. Fuel
consumption may be increased and the
driveability of the vehicle may be impaired.
In some cases, the fault can be remedied
by switching the engine off and on again. If
the control indicator illuminates again
when the engine is running, consult a
workshop to have the cause of the fault
remedied. We recommend your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
If it illuminates briefly, but does not recur, it
is of no significance.
Illumination of A could indicate the
presence of water in the diesel fuel filter 3 .
A text message will appear in the service
display at the same time, – page 44. Have
the fuel filter checked for moisture. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
If it flashes after the ignition is switched on,
there is a fault in the immobiliser system.
The engine cannot be started – page 67.
Exhaust gases
During the first drive smoke may develop
because of wax and oil evaporating on the
exhaust system. Park the vehicle in the
open for a while after the first drive and
avoid inhaling the fumes.
9 Warning
Engine exhaust gases contain poisonous
carbon monoxide, which is colourless and
odourless and could be fatal if inhaled.
If exhaust fumes penetrate the vehicle
interior, open the windows and consult a
workshop immediately. We recommend
your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Avoid driving with an open luggage
compartment. Otherwise, exhaust gases
could penetrate the interior.
211Catalytic converter, exhaust gases
Diesel particle filter 3
The diesel particle filter system contains a
self-cleaning function at certain intervals.
The filter is cleaned by burning soot
particles. The amount of noise and fumes
that is generated is normal.
The heated rear window is automatically
switched on for the duration of the self-
cleaning 3.
Maintenance
Have all maintenance work carried out at
the intervals specified by Vauxhall. We
recommend that you entrust this work to
your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who
has proper equipment and trained
personnel available. Electronic testing
systems permit rapid diagnosis and
remedy of faults. This way you can be
certain that all components of the vehicle’s
electrical, injection and ignition systems
operate correctly, that your vehicle has a
low level of pollutant emission and that the
catalytic converter system will have a long
service life.
You are thereby making an important
contribution towards keeping the air clean
and compliance with emissions legislation.
Checking and adjustment of the
fuel-injection and ignition systems is part of
the scope of inspection. For this reason you
should have all maintenance work carried
out at the intervals specified in your Service
Booklet.
212 Drive Control Systems
Drive Control Systems
Interactive Driving System
(IDS+)
3
IDS+ unites the sensors and control units of
the Electronic Stability Program (ESP ®
Plus
),
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) and
Continuous Damping Control (CDC). This
provides both excellent driving dynamics
and greater safety.
Electronic Stability Program
(
ESP®
Plus
) 3
ESP ®
Plus
improves driving stability as
necessary in any driving situation
regardless of the type of road surface or
tyre grip. It also prevents the drive wheels
from spinning irrespective of road surface
and tyre grip.
The system monitors vehicle movements.
As soon as the vehicle starts to swerve
(understeers/oversteers) engine output is
reduced (the sound of the engine changes)
and individual wheels are specifically
braked. This considerably improves the
driving stability of the vehicle on snow and
ice and on wet or slippery road surfaces.
ESP ®
Plus
is ready for operation as soon as
the ignition is switched on and control
indicator v goes out.
When ESP ®
Plus
comes into action, v
flashes.
The vehicle is now in a critical situation; ESP
®
Plus
allows you to keep control of the
vehicle and reminds you to match your
speed to the road conditions.
Interactive Driving System .................. 212
Electronic Stability Program ............... 212
Continuous Damping Control 3 ......... 214
SPORT mode 3 .................................... 214
Cruise control 3 ................................... 216
Parking distance sensor 3 .................. 218
Automatic level control 3 ................... 220
Deflation Detection System ................ 221
Tyre pressure monitoring system 3 ... 222
9 Warning
Do not let this special safety feature
tempt you into taking risks when driving.
Traffic safety can only be achieved by
adopting a responsible driving style.
213Drive Control Systems
Control indicator v
Illuminates for a few seconds when the
ignition is switched on. The system is now
ready for operation.
Flashing during driving
This shows the system has come into
action. The engine output may be reduced
(the sound of the engine changes) and the
vehicle may be braked automatically to a
small degree.
Illuminates while driving
The system is switched off or a fault is
present. Continued driving is possible. The
driving stability can however deteriorate
depending on road surface conditions.
Reactivate ESP®
Plus
or have the cause of
the fault remedied. We recommend that
you consult your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer. The system’s integrated self-
diagnostics allow faults to be quickly
remedied.
Switching off 3
With SPORT mode 3 engaged (LED in
SPORT button illuminated ), the ESP®
Plus
can be disengaged for sports
performance.
Hold the SPORT button depressed for
around 4 seconds. Control indicator v will
illuminate. ESPoff will also appear in the
service display – see page 44.
ESP®
Plus
is reactivated by pressing the
SPORT button again or switching on the
ignition.
SPORT mode – page 214.
9 Warning
ESP®
Plus
should not be deactivated if one
of the run-flat tyres 3 has no pressure.
214 Drive Control Systems
Continuous Damping Control 3
(CDC)
CDC adapts vehicle damping to the current
driving situation and road conditions.
The system continually monitors wheel and
vehicle movements and immediately
modifies the damping of each shock
absorber. Chassis calibration is optimally
adapted to the driving situation and road
conditions.
When SPORT mode is engaged, the
damping control is adapted to a sportier
driving style ("harder" chassis setting).
SPORT mode - see right column.
Control indicator IDS+ for Continuous
Damping Control
Illuminates for approx. 10 seconds after
the driver’s door is opened. If it illuminates
while driving, there is a fault in the system.
The system is not operational. For reasons
of safety "harder" chassis calibration will
be activated. Have the cause of the fault
remedied. We recommend that you consult
your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. The
system’s integrated self-diagnostics allows
faults to be quickly remedied.
SPORT mode 3
SPORT mode is used to change
damping 3, steering 3 , throttle
application 3 and the shift point for
automatic transmission 3 and
Easytronic 3 while driving.
Damping and steering become more direct
and provide better contact with the road
surface. The engine reacts more quickly to
accelerator movements.
For automatic transmission 3 and
Easytronic 3, the shift times are reduced
and gearchanges occur at a higher engine
speed (except when cruise control is on).
215Drive Control Systems
To activate
Press the SPORT button. The LED in the
button illuminates.
In vehicles with automatic transmission 3
or Easytronic 3, control indicator 1 also
illuminates.
SPORT mode cannot be activated if the
Winter programme 3 is running (vehicles
with automatic transmission 3 or
Easytronic 3). Winter programme
– pages 182, 189, 196.
To deactivate
Briefly press the SPORT button again or
switch off the ignition. The LED in the
button goes out.
Holding it pressed switches off ESP ®
Plus
– page 213. SPORT mode remains
engaged.
SPORT mode is deactivated if the Winter
programme 3 is switched on (vehicles with
automatic transmission 3 or
Easytronic 3). Winter programme
– pages 182, 189, 196.
Control indicator IDS+ for SPORT mode
Illuminates for approx. 10 seconds when
the driver’s door is opened. If it illuminates
while driving, there is a fault in the system.
The system is not operational. Have the
cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer. The system’s
integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to
be quickly remedied.
216 Drive Control Systems
Cruise control 3
Cruise control can store and maintain
speeds between 20 mph (30 km/h) and
125 mph (200 km/h). Deviation from the
stored speed may occur when driving up or
downhill.
For safety reasons the cruise control
cannot be activated until the foot brake
has been operated once.
Cruise control is operated with buttons m,
g , and § on the turn signal stalk.
Do not use the cruise control if it is not
advisable to maintain a constant speed
(e.g. in situations presenting a danger to
yourself and other road users, in heavy
traffic or on winding, slippery or greasy
roads).
With automatic transmission 3, only use
cruise control in D or in automatic mode
with Easytronic 3.
When the cruise control is active, reaction
times may be increased due to the different
position of the feet.
Control indicator m
When driving, control indicator m will
illuminates as soon as the system is
switched on.
9 Warning
The driver is always responsible for
ensuring that vehicle speed is
appropriate for the speed limit and
driving conditions - even if cruise control
is engaged. Failure to follow the
instructions could lead to injuries or
endanger life.
217Drive Control Systems
To activate
Briefly press button m : the current speed is
stored and maintained. The accelerator
pedal can be released.
Vehicle speed can be increased by
depressing the accelerator pedal. When
the accelerator pedal is released, the
previously stored speed is resumed.
Increase
With cruise control active, hold down
button m or briefly press it repeatedly:
speed is increased continuously or in steps
of 1.2 mph (2 km/h) without using the
accelerator pedal.
When button m is released the current
speed is stored and maintained.
Decelerate
With cruise control active, hold down
button
g or briefly press it repeatedly:
speed is reduced continuously or in steps of
1.2 mph (2 km/h).
When button
g is released the current
speed is stored and maintained.
To deactivate
Briefly press button §: Cruise control is
switched off, control indicator m goes out
and the vehicle slowly decelerates. To
continue driving, depress the accelerator
pedal in the usual manner.
For reasons of safety, cruise control
deactivates under certain driving
conditions.
For example:
z the vehicle’s speed drops below approx.
1.2 mph (2 km/h) or
z the brake pedal is depressed or
z the clutch pedal is depressed or
z Selector lever of automatic
transmission 3 or Easytronic 3 in N.
Resuming the stored speed
Briefly press button
g at a speed above
20 mph (30 km/h): the speed selected
before the cruise control was switched off is
resumed.
The value of the stored speed is deleted
when the ignition is turned off.
218 Drive Control Systems
Parking distance sensor 3
Parking distance sensor makes reverse
parking easier by measuring the distance
between the vehicle and an obstacle in the
rear, and giving an acoustic signal in the
passenger compartment.
The system records the distance using four
sensors in the rear bumper.
To activate
The parking distance sensor system
activates automatically when the ignition is
switched on and reverse gear is engaged.
Its operational readiness is indicated by
illumination of the LED in button
r.
If the vehicle approaches an obstacle when
reversing, a series of signals can be heard
in the vehicle interior. The interval between
the signals becomes shorter as the
distance is reduced. If the distance is less
than 30 cm, the signal will be continuous.
To deactivate
The system deactivates automatically
when reverse gear is disengaged.
To deactivate the system when reverse
gear is engaged, press button
r. The
LED in the button goes out.
To reactivate, press button
r again.
9 Warning
Under certain circumstances, various
reflective surfaces on objects or clothing
as well as external noise sources may
cause the system to fail to detect
obstacles. For this reason, care must be
taken when reversing even if the parking
distance sensor is operational. This is of
particular importance when in the vicinity
of pedestrians.
219Drive Control Systems
Control indicator r
Illuminated
Fault in the system. The system is not ready
for operation. Have the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer. The system’s
integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to
be quickly remedied.
If it flashes
The fault is due to sensors obstructed with
snow or ice. The sensors must be
undamaged and free of dirt, snow and ice.
Interference due to external sources of
ultra sound (e.g. pneumatic drills, rotary
machines). Once the source of interference
is removed, the system will operate
normally.
Caravan/trailer towing equipment 3,
caravan/trailer towing
The system automatically detects if a
towbar is properly fitted to the vehicle.
When towing, the parking distance sensor
is automatically deactivated when the
trailer cable is plugged into the socket.
Fitting rear load racks 3
Rear load racks, e.g. bicycle racks, fitted
near the sensors could disrupt the system.
Observe the note on the Astra TwinTop on
page 151.
220 Drive Control Systems
Automatic level control 3
Automatic level control makes it possible to
keep the height of the vehicle constant
when subjected to different loads in the
rear (e.g. when towing a caravan or trailer).
This significantly improves driving
conditions.
The vehicle is automatically raised at the
rear, increasing the spring travel and
ground clearance.
The automatic level control system is
activated after approx. 2 miles (3 km),
depending on the vehicle loading and the
nature of the road surface.
Headlight range adjustment – page 138.
In the event of malfunctions, do not utilise
the vehicle’s full load capacity. Have the
cause remedied without delay. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
221Drive Control Systems
Deflation Detection System
(DDS = Deflation Detection
System)
3
The deflation detection system
continuously monitors the speed of all
wheels while driving. If a tyre loses
pressure, it grows smaller and rotates more
quickly than the other wheels. If the system
detects a difference in speed, control
indicator
w illuminates red.
Stop immediately and check tyre pressure.
Mount the spare wheel if necessary
– pages 254, 257.
The system is operational when the ignition
is switched on and can detect pressure loss
from a speed of 20 mph (30 km/h).
Control indicator
w
If control indicator
w illuminates red while
driving, there is a loss of pressure. Stop
immediately and check tyre pressures. A
maximum speed of 50 mph (80 km/h) is
permitted for run-flat tyres 3. Observe the
information on page 235.
If control indicator
w illuminates yellow,
there is a fault in the system. Have the
cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer. The system’s
integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to
be quickly remedied.
The control indicator flashes three times
when the system is initialising.
Tyre pressure – pages 232, 333.
System initialisation
After correcting tyre pressure or changing
a tyre/wheel, the system must be initialised:
With the ignition switched on, press the
DDS button for approx. 4 seconds. Control
indicator
w flashes 3 times. The system is
operational after driving a certain
distance.
Only initialise the system if all tyres have
the prescribed pressure.
9 Warning
The deflation detection system does not
replace manual checks with a suitable
gauge.
Check tyre pressures at least every
14 days and prior to any long journey; the
tyres should be checked when cold. Don’t
forget to check the spare 3.
222 Drive Control Systems
Tyre pressure monitoring
system 3
The tyre pressure monitoring system
continually checks the pressure and speed
of all four wheels while driving.
A pressure sensor is integrated in each
wheel. Once a minute, the pressure of each
tyre is sent to a control unit, where it is
compared. If the system detects one or
more pressure differences, a message
appears on the information display.
In vehicles with graphical information
display 3 or colour information display 3
and trip computer 3, current tyre pressures
can be shown in the information display.
For the system to be operational, all wheels
must be equipped with pressure sensors
and all tyres must be filled to the
prescribed pressure. The tyre pressure
monitoring system automatically detects if
the vehicle is being driven with a load of up
to 3 persons or a full load.
Once the ignition is switched on, the system
is operational and will continuously
monitor the tyre pressures at speeds of
approx. 20 mph (30 km/h) and above.
Tyre pressure – see pages 232, 333.
Display of current tyre pressure 3
Select menu item Tyresfrom the Board
Computer menu.
The current pressure of each tyre is
displayed.
Warning messages
A message is given on the information
display to warn of inconsistent tyre
pressures. In some versions, the message is
displayed in abbreviated form.
For example, the following messages can
be displayed:
9 Warning
The tyre pressure monitoring system does
not replace manual checks with a
suitable gauge.
Check tyre pressures at least every 14
days and prior to any long journey; the
tyres should be checked when cold. Don’t
forget to check the spare 3.
Ü Board Computer
BC 1
BC 2
Timer
Tyres
223Drive Control Systems
A graphic 3 indicating the left rear tyre is
shown together with the current tyre
pressure: Slight pressure deviation. Reduce
speed. Check pressure at next opportunity
with appropriate gauge and correct if
necessary.
On the colour information display this
report will appear in yellow.
A graphic 3 indicating the front left tyre is
shown together with the current tyre
pressure: Significant pressure deviation or
direct pressure loss! Steer out of flow of
traffic as quickly as possible without
endangering other drivers. Stop and check
the tyres.
Mount the spare wheel if necessary
- pages 254, 257. A maximum speed of 50
mph (80 km/h) is permitted for run-flat
tyres 3. Observe the information on
page 235.
On the colour information display this
report will appear in red.
Acknowledgement of warnings – page 54.
Navi active
Tyre pressure
OK
check rear
leftturn
(value in bar)
Navi active
Attention!
OK
Front left tyre
pressure loss
(value in bar)
224 Drive Control Systems
Control indicator w
If control indicator
w illuminates yellow
while driving, there is a fault in the tyre
pressure monitoring system. Fitting a wheel
without pressure sensor (e.g. spare wheel)
will also generate a fault in the system.
Have the cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer. The system’s
integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to
be quickly remedied.
System initialisation
The system must be initialised after a
wheel/tyre change:
With the ignition switched on, press button
DDS approx. 4 seconds. Control indicator
w
flashes 3 times. The system is operational
after driving a certain distance.
Only initialise the system if all tyres have
the prescribed pressure (check when tyres
are cold).
General information
The spare wheel/temporary spare is not
equipped with a pressure sensor. The tyre
pressure monitoring system is not
operational if the spare wheel/temporary
spare is in use. Control indicator
w
illuminates yellow –.– appears in the
display of tyre pressures. Tyre pressure is
monitored by the deflation detection
system – page 221.
If a complete set of wheels without tyre
pressure control system sensors is mounted
(e.g. four winter tyres), no error message
will be displayed. The tyre pressure
monitoring system is not operational. The
tyre pressure of a set of wheels without
sensors is monitored by the deflation
detection system – page 221.
225Drive Control Systems
Sensors for the tyre pressure monitoring
system can be retrofitted. We recommend
that you consult your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
When manually checking tyre pressure with
a pressure gauge, screw the adapter onto
the valve. Tyre pressure – page 333.
The tyre pressure monitoring system valve
cores and sealing rings must be replaced
each time the tyres are changed. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
The use of commercially available liquid
filled run-flat systems or repair kits can
impair the function of the system.
Vauxhall-approved systems can be used.
Radio transmitters (e.g. radio headphones,
walkie-talkies) operated in the area could
cause interference in the tyre pressure
monitoring system.
226 Brakes
Brakes
Brake system
The brakes are an important factor for
traffic safety.
To improve effectiveness, do not brake
unnecessarily hard for the first 125 miles
(200 km) after new brake pads have been
fitted.
Brake pad wear must not exceed a
specified limit. Regular maintenance as
detailed in the Service Booklet is therefore
of the utmost importance for traffic safety.
Have worn brake pads replaced. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer, who will fit pads that
have been tested and approved by
Vauxhall and guarantee optimum braking
power.
Brake pads worn to their minimum
thickness generate a grinding noise.
Continued driving is possible. Have the
brake pads replaced as soon as possible
by a workshop. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Brake assist
If the brake pedal is operated with a
powerful push, the vehicle is automatically
braked at full braking power in order to
achieve the shortest possible braking
distance when full-on braking occurs
(braking assistant).
Maintain steady pressure on the brake
pedal for as long as full-on braking is to
continue. When the brake pedal is
released, the maximum brake force
amplification is taken away.
Adaptive brake light 3
During full-on braking, all three brake
lights flash for the duration of ABS control.
Brake system........................................ 226
Anti-lock brake system (ABS u)........ 228
227Brakes
Foot brake
The foot brake comprises two independent
brake circuits.
If a brake circuit fails, the vehicle can still be
braked using the other brake circuit. If this
occurs, however, the brake pedal must be
depressed quite far using considerable
force before braking effect occurs. The
distance required for braking will be
greater. Consult a workshop before
continuing your journey. We recommend
your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
To ensure the full pedal travel can be
utilized, especially in case of a fault in one
of the brake circuits, there must be no mats
in the vicinity of the pedals – page 201.
When the engine is not running, the
support of the brake servo unit disappears
once the brake pedal has been depressed
once or twice. Braking effect is not
reduced, but braking requires significantly
greater force. This is especially important
to bear in mind when towing.
Check the brake lights before starting out
on a journey. On vehicles with check
control 3 the brake lights are checked
automatically – page 62.
Shortly after starting each journey the
effectiveness of the brake system should
be tested at low speed and without
inconveniencing other traffic, especially if
the brakes are wet, e.g. after the vehicle
has been washed.
The brake fluid level should be checked
regularly. If the brake fluid level is too low
and the hand brake is not applied, control
indicator R on the instrument panel
illuminates – page 38.
Hill Start Assist 3
(HSA)
The system helps pull away on inclines.
After releasing the footbrake, if the hand
brake is not applied the brakes are only
released after 2 seconds. As soon as the
acceleration is sufficient to prevent rolling
back, the brake is released.
Hand brake
Always apply hand brake firmly. On slopes
apply the hand brake as firmly as possible.
The mechanical hand brake acts on the
brakes on the rear wheels. It engages
automatically when applied.
To release the hand brake pull the lever up
slightly, press the ratchet knob, and fully
lower the lever.
To reduce the operating forces of the hand
brake, depress the foot brake at the same
time.
228 Brakes
Brake system control indicator R
The control indicator illuminates when the
ignition is switched on if the hand brake is
applied or if the brake or clutch fluid level is
too low. Brake fluid - page 302.
For vehicles with Easytronic 3, the control
indicator flashes for a few seconds when
the ignition is turned off if the hand brake
is not applied.
Anti-lock brake system (ABS u)
ABS continually monitors the brake system
and prevents the wheels from locking
regardless of the type of road surface or
tyre grip.
It starts to regulate the braking pressure as
soon as a wheel shows a tendency to lock.
The vehicle remains steerable, even in the
event of very heavy braking, for instance
on bends or when swerving to avoid an
obstacle. Even in the case of full-on
braking, the ABS makes it possible to drive
round an obstacle without releasing the
brakes.
ABS control is made apparent though a
pulse in the brake pedal and the noise of
the regulation process.
9 Warning
If the control indicator illuminates when
the hand brake is not applied: Stop.
Interrupt your journey immediately.
Consult a workshop. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
9 Warning
For optimum braking, keep the brake
pedal fully depressed throughout the
braking process, despite the fact that the
pedal is pulsating. Do not reduce the
pressure on the pedal.
Do not let this special safety feature
tempt you into taking risks when driving.
Traffic safety can only be achieved by
adopting a responsible driving style.
229Brakes
Control indicator u for ABS
It comes on for a few seconds after the
ignition is turned on. The system is ready
for operation when the control indicator
goes out.
If the control indicator does not go out
after a few seconds, or if it illuminates while
driving, there is a fault in the ABS. The
brake system remains operational without
ABS regulation.
Self-check
Each time the ignition is turned on and the
engine started, after moving away from a
speed of around (2 mph) 3 km/h the system
performs a self-check which may be
audible.
Fault
You can continue driving, provided you
drive with care and anticipation.
Have the cause of the fault remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer. The system’s
integrated self-diagnostics allows faults to
be quickly remedied.
9 Warning
If there is a fault in ABS, the wheels may
be subject to locking due to braking that
is heavier than normal. The advantages
of ABS are no longer operational. The
vehicle can no longer be steered and may
swerve.
230 Wheels, tyres
Wheels, tyres
Tyres
See page 333 for suitable tyres and
restrictions.
Tyres fitted in the factory are adapted to
the chassis and provide optimum driving
comfort and safety.
Changing tyre/wheel type
Before switching to different tyres or
wheels, seek advice on the technical
possibilities. We recommend that you
consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer,
who will be able to advise you of any
necessary modifications.
If tyres of a different size than those fitted
at the factory are used, the electronic
speedometer may require reprogramming
to ensure that the correct speed is
displayed.
Vehicles with
tyre pressure monitoring system 3
If winter tyres or tyres of a different size are
fitted, tyre pressure monitoring system
sensors can be retrofitted if so desired.
Otherwise, the system will not indicate tyre
pressure deviations. We recommend that
you consult your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
Deflation detection system 3 – page 221,
tyre pressure monitoring system 3
– page 222.
Vehicles with run-flat tyres
3
When switching wheels, e.g. when
switching to winter tyres, use run-flat tyres
as there is no spare wheel or tyre repair kit
in the vehicle.
Run-flat tyres 3 - page 235.
Tyres ..................................................... 230
Changing tyre/wheel type................... 230
Tyre pressure........................................ 232
Tyre condition, wheel condition ......... 233
Run-flat tyres (RFT) 3.......................... 235
Winter tyres 3 ...................................... 236
Wheel covers 3 .................................... 236
Tyre chains........................................... 236
9 Warning
Use of unsuitable tyres or wheels may
lead to accidents and render the vehicle
unroadworthy.
231Wheels, tyres
Fitting new tyres
Fit tyres in pairs or in sets, which is even
better. Ensure that tyres on one axle are
z the same size
z the same design
z the same make
z and have the same tread pattern.
Fit directional tyres such that they roll in the
direction of travel. The rolling direction is
indicated by a symbol (e.g. an arrow) on
the sidewall.
Tyres fitted opposing the rolling direction
(e.g. when a tyre is changed) should be
refitted as soon as possible. This is the only
way to obtain full benefit from the design
properties of the tyre.
Run-flat tyres 3 must not be combined with
conventional tyres.
Some brands of tyres have a beaded edge
for alloy wheels to protect against
damage. If wheel trim is used on steel
wheels with beaded-edge tyres, the
following specification must be followed:
z Use of wheel trims and tyres that
approved by Vauxhall for the vehicle in
question and thereby fulfil all
requirements for the wheel and tyre
combination.
z If the wheel trims and tyres used are not
Vauxhall-approved, the tyres must not
have a beaded edge.
9 Warning
We recommend that you have your tyres
changed by your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer, who will be familiar with the
requirements of the law as regards
disposal of tyres and can thus help to
protect the environment and your health.
9 Warning
Use of unsuitable tyres or wheel trims
could lead to sudden loss of air and
thereby accidents.
232 Wheels, tyres
Tyre pressure
Check tyre pressure, including the spare
wheel, at least every 14 days and prior to
any long journey; the tyres should be
checked when cold. Don’t forget to check
the spare 3.
Use the valve cap key to make unscrewing
the valve caps easier. The key is located on
the inside of the tank flap.
In vehicles with tyre pressure monitoring
system 3 there is an adapter in the valve
cap key. Screw adapter to valve before
attaching tyre pressure gauge – page 222.
Tyre pressure – page 333 and the adhesive
foil 3 on the inside of the tank flap. Have
adhesive foil replaced after changing to
different tyre size.
Do not reduce tyre pressure when the tyres
are warm. Otherwise the pressure may
drop below the permissible minimum when
the tyres cool down.
After having checked the tyre pressure,
tighten the valve caps using the valve cap
key.
Incorrect inflation pressures will impair
safety, vehicle handling, comfort and fuel
economy and will increase tyre wear.
If the pressure is too low, this can result in
considerable tyre warm-up and internal
damage, leading to tread separation and
even to tyre blow-out at high speeds.
233Wheels, tyres
Hidden tyre damage is not eliminated by
adjusting the inflation pressure.
Tyre condition, wheel condition
Drive over edges slowly and at a right
angle if possible. Driving over sharp edges
can lead to hidden tyre damage and wheel
damage which is only noticed later on.
When parking, ensure that the tyres are not
pressed against the edge of the kerb.
Check tyres regularly for damage (foreign
bodies, punctures, cuts, cracks, bulges in
sidewalls). Check wheels for damage. In
the event of damage or abnormal wear,
consult a workshop. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
9 Warning
Incorrect tyre pressure could lead to a flat
tyre.
9 Warning
Damage may lead to tyre blow-out.
234 Wheels, tyres
Tread depth
Check tread depth regularly.
If wear in the front is greater than that in
the rear, move the rear wheels to the front
axle and vice versa.
Correct tyre pressure. For vehicles with
deflation detection system 3 or tyre
pressure control system 3, initialise the
system – pages 221, 224.
For reasons of safety, tyres should be
replaced when their tread depth has worn
down to 2 to 3 mm (winter tyres: 4 mm).
The legally permissible minimum tread
depth (1.6 mm) has been reached when
the tread has worn down as far as one of
the wear indicators (TWI
1)
). A number of
wear indicators are spaced at equal
intervals around the tyre within the tread.
Their position is indicated by markings on
the tyre sidewall.
General information
z The danger of aquaplaning is greater if
the tyres are worn.
z Tyres age, even if they are used only very
little or not at all. A spare wheel which
has not been used for six years should be
used only in emergencies; drive slowly
when using such tyres.
z Never fit used tyres the previous history
and use of which you do not know.
z So as not to impair brake cooling, use
only wheel trims approved for use on
your vehicle.
1)
TWI = T read W ear I ndicator.
235Wheels, tyres
Tyre designations
Meanings:
e.g. 195/65 R 15 91 H
195 =Tyre width in mm
65 = cross-section ratio
(tyre height to tyre width) in %
R = belt type: R adial
RF = type: RunFlat
15 = rim diameter in inch
91 =load index
z. B.: 91 corresponds to 618 kg
H = speed code
Speed code letters:
Q Up to 100 mph (160 km/h)
S Up to 112 mph (180 km/h)
T Up to 118 mph (190 km/h)
H Up to 130 mph (210 km/h)
V Up to 150 mph (240 km/h)
W Up to 168 mph (270 km/h)
Run-flat tyres
(RFT) 3
Run-flat tyres have reinforced, self-
supporting sidewalls, which ensure that the
tyres always have a certain amount of
driveability, even when there is no pressure.
Run-flat tyres are only permitted on
vehicles with ESP ®
Plus
and tyre pressure
monitoring system or deflation detection
system.
Depending on tyre manufacturer, run-flat
tyres can be identified from a marking on
the tyre wall. E.g. ROF = RunonFlat for
Goodyear or SSR = Self Supporting Runflat
Tyre for Continental.
Run-flat tyres may only be used in
combination with Vauxhall-approved alloy
wheels; this also applies to winter tyres.
Driving with a damaged tyre
A loss in tyre pressure is indicated by the
tyre pressure monitoring system 3 or the
deflation detection system 3.
If a tyre has no pressure, continued driving
is possible
z at a speed of max. 50 mph (80 km/h),
z up to a distance of 50 miles (80 km).
Do not use a tyre repair kit.
Deflation detection system 3 – page 221,
tyre pressure monitoring system 3
– page 222.
9 Warning
Even the tyre pressure of run-flat tyres
must be checked regularly.
Check tyre pressures at least every 14
days and prior to any long journey; the
tyres should be checked when cold.
9 Warning
When driving with a flat tyre, do not
exceed a speed of 50 mph (80 km/h) or a
distance of 50 miles (80 km).
The vehicle will be more difficult to steer
and handle and the braking distance will
be longer.
Adapt driving style and speed to the
conditions at hand.
236 Wheels, tyres
Winter tyres 3
For notes on fitting new tyres – page 230.
Limitations - pages 235, 333.
Winter tyres improve safety at
temperatures below 7 °C and should
therefore be fitted on all the wheels.
The design of summer tyres means they
have limited qualities for winter driving.
If the maximum permissible speed for the
winter tyres is less than that of the vehicle,
a notice indicating the maximum
permissible speed for the tyres must be
affixed within the driver’s field of vision
1)
.
If you use the spare wheel when it is fitted
with a summer tyre, the vehicle’s
driveability may be affected, especially on
slippery road surfaces. Obtain a
replacement for the faulty tyre as soon as
possible, and have the wheel balanced
and fitted to the vehicle.
Wheel covers 3
If the wheel trims and tyres used are not
Vauxhall-approved, make sure that the
tyres do not have a beaded edge – see
page 231.
Tyre chains
Limitations and further information
– page 333.
Tyre chains are only permitted on the drive
wheels (front axle). They must be fitted to
the tyres symmetrically in order to achieve
a concentric fit.
Always use fine mesh chains that add no
more than 10 mm to the tyre tread and the
inboard sides (including chain lock).
We recommend that you consult your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
1)
Varies from country to country on account of
national regulations.
237Wheels, tyres
Wheel trim on steel wheels could come into
contact with parts of the chain and be
damaged. Remove the wheel trim – see
page 257.
Tyre chains may only be used at speeds up
to 50 km/h and, when travelling on roads
that are free of snow, they may be used for
brief periods only since they are subject to
rapid wear on a hard road and may snap.
Temporary spare wheel
Tyre chains must not be used on the
temporary spare wheel. If you need to use
tyre chains after suffering a flat front tyre,
fit the temporary spare on the rear axle
and transfer one of the rear wheels to the
front axle.
For notes on the temporary spare wheel –
see page 255.
Wheel changing – see page 257.
Correct tyre pressure. Deflation detection
system 3 – see page 221, tyre pressure
control system 3 – see page 222.
238 Roof racks, Caravan and trailer towing
Roof racks,
Caravan and trailer
towing
Roof racks 3
For reasons of safety and to avoid
damaging the roof, we recommend that
you use the Vauxhall roof rack system
approved for your vehicle. Consult your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Roof loads are not permitted on the Astra
TwinTop.
Fasten the roof rack following the
instructions that accompany the system.
Driving hints – see page 200.
Version without roof railing
Lift the covers from the fitting openings.
Attach roof rack at appropriate points, see
enclosed roof luggage rack system
instructions.
Roof racks 3......................................... 238
Towing equipment 3........................... 239
Towing equipment with detachable
coupling ball bar 3 ........................... 239
Stowage of coupling ball bar ............. 242
Caravan and trailer loads................... 243
Coupling socket load........................... 244
Rear axle load during towing............. 244
Tyre pressure........................................ 244
Trailer Stability Assist 3 (TSA) ............ 244
Driving characteristics, towing tips .... 245
Starting on inclines .............................. 246
9 Warning
Disregard of these notes can lead to
injuries which may be fatal. Vehicle
passengers should be informed
accordingly.
239Roof racks, Caravan and trailer towing
Version with roof railing 3
Attach roof rack to roof railing at points
shown in figure, see enclosed roof luggage
rack system instructions.
Towing equipment 3
Use only towing equipment that has been
approved for your vehicle. We recommend
entrusting the retrofitting of towing
equipment to your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer, who will advise you on any
possible towed load increases. Your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer has
instructions on how to install the towing
equipment and make any necessary
changes to the vehicle that affect the
cooling system, heat shields or other
equipment.
Observe the note on the Astra TwinTop on
page 151.
Do not mount towing equipment to
vehicles with Z 20 LEH
1)
engine.
For installation dimensions of the trailer
towing equipment – pages 345, 346.
Towing equipment with
detachable
coupling ball bar 3
Stowage of coupling ball bar
In Saloons, the coupling ball bar is in a
pouch, fastened in the luggage
compartment cargo box with a strap
- page 242.
In Estates, the coupling ball bar is fastened
with a strap in a compartment in the spare
wheel well of the luggage compartment.
6
9 Warning
The coupling ball bar is to be removed
when not towing.
1)
Sales designation – see page 314.
240 Roof racks, Caravan and trailer towing
Fitting the coupling ball bar
Disengage and fold down the socket.
Remove the sealing plug from the hole for
the coupling ball bar and stow it in the
luggage compartment.
Checking the tensioning of the coupling
ball bar
z Red marking on turn knob points
towards white marking on coupling ball
bar.
z Gap of approx. 6 millimetres between
rotary knob and coupling ball bar.
z Key is in lock at position 1.
Otherwise, the coupling ball bar must be
tensioned before it is inserted into the
coupling housing:
z Unlock coupling ball bar (key to position
1) – see Fig. 17222 T.
z Pull turn knob out and then turn it
clockwise as far as it will go – see Fig.
17223 T.
241Roof racks, Caravan and trailer towing
Inserting the coupling ball bar
Insert the tensioned coupling ball bar into
the coupling housing and push firmly
upwards until the coupling ball bar audibly
engages in position.
The turn knob snaps back into its home
position resting against the coupling ball
bar.
Lock coupling ball bar (key to position 2
– page 240, Fig. 17222 T). Remove key and
press protective flap into position.
When the coupling ball bar is locked the
turn knob can no longer be pulled out.
Important
Check that the coupling ball bar is correctly
installed:
z Green marking on turn knob points
towards white marking on coupling ball
bar.
z No gap between turn knob and coupling
ball bar.
z Coupling ball bar must be seated firmly
in coupling housing.
z Coupling ball bar must be locked and
key must be removed.
Eye for break-away stopping cable
In the case of caravans/trailers with brake,
attach the break-away stopping cable to
the eye (arrow in Fig. 17225 T).
9 Warning
Do not touch the turn knob when
inserting the coupling ball bar - risk of
injury.
9 Warning
Towing a caravan/trailer is only
permitted with a properly attached
coupling ball bar. If the coupling ball bar
cannot be properly attached, consult a
workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
242 Roof racks, Caravan and trailer towing
Dismounting the coupling ball bar
Unlock coupling ball bar (key to position 1
– page 240, Fig. 17222 T).
Pull out turn knob and then turn it clockwise
as far as it will go. Pull coupling ball bar
down out of the coupling housing and stow
in compartment in the luggage
compartment – page 239.
Insert the sealing plug in the hole for the
coupling ball bar. Fold away the socket
– page 240, Fig. 17221 T.
Do not use steam-jet cleaners or other
high-pressure cleaners to clean the
coupling ball bar.
Stowage of coupling ball bar
Hatch
Stow the coupling ball bar in the pouch and
fasten it in the luggage compartment
cargo box with the strap.
Estate
Stow the coupling ball bar in the
compartment in the spare wheel well of the
luggage compartment, fastening it with
the strap.
243Roof racks, Caravan and trailer towing
Caravan and trailer loads
1)
The permissible caravan/trailer loads are
vehicle- and engine-dependent maximum
values which must not be exceeded. The
actual caravan/trailer load is the difference
between the actual gross weight of the
caravan/trailer and the actual coupling
socket load with the caravan/trailer
coupled. When the caravan/trailer load is
being checked, therefore, only the
caravan/trailer wheels – and not the jockey
wheel – must be standing on the weighing
apparatus.
The permissible caravan/trailer loads for
your vehicle are given in the vehicle
documents. Unless otherwise stated, they
are valid for gradients up to max. 12 %.
The permissible caravan/trailer load should
be fully utilised only by drivers who are
adequately experienced in towing large or
heavy caravans/trailers.
The permitted caravan/trailer load applies
up to the specified incline and up to an
altitude of 1000 metres above sea level.
Since engine power decreases as altitude
increases because of the air becoming
thinner, therefore reducing climbing ability,
the permitted towing weight also
decreases by 10 % for every 1000 metres of
additional altitude. The towing weight
does not have to be reduced when driving
on roads with slight inclines (less than 8 %,
e. g. motorways).
The actual caravan/trailer load plus the
actual gross weight of the towing vehicle
must not exceed the maximum permitted
towing weight. For example, if the
permitted gross vehicle weight is utilised,
the trailer/caravan load must only be used
until the maximum permitted towing
weight is reached. The maximum
permitted towing weight is shown on the
identification plate – page 312.
1)
Observe national regulations.
244 Roof racks, Caravan and trailer towing
Coupling socket load
The coupling socket load is the load
exerted by the caravan/trailer on the
coupling ball. It can be varied by changing
the weight distribution when loading the
caravan/trailer.
The maximum permissible coupling socket
load (75 kg) is specified on the towing
equipment identification plate and in the
vehicle documents. Always aim for the
maximum load, especially in the case of
heavy caravans/trailers. The coupling
socket load should never fall below 25 kg.
When measuring the coupling socket load,
make sure that the drawbar of the loaded
caravan/trailer is at the same height as it
will be when the caravan/trailer is coupled
with the towing vehicle loaded. Particularly
important for caravans/trailers with
tandem axle.
Rear axle load during towing
With a trailer coupled and the towing
vehicle fully loaded (including all
occupants), the permissible rear axle load
(see identification plate or vehicle
documents) may be exceeded by 65 kg
and the permissible gross vehicle weight by
45 kg for the Hatch. For the Estate, the
permissible rear axle load may be
exceeded by 60 kg and the permissible
gross vehicle weight by 30 kg. If the
permissible rear axle load is exceeded a
maximum speed of 60 mph (100 km/h)
applies 50 mph (80 km/h) if approved for
use as a commercial vehicle). If national
regulations specify a lower maximum
speed for vehicles towing a trailer, this
must be observed.
Tyre pressure
Increase the tyre pressure on the towing
vehicle to the value specified for a full load
– page 333. Check the pressure of the
spare wheel and caravan/trailer wheels.
Trailer Stability Assist 3
(TSA)
TSA monitors vehicle movements when
towing a caravan or trailer. If the system
detects lurching movements, engine power
is reduced and the vehicle/trailer
combination is selectively braked until the
lurching ceases.
245Roof racks, Caravan and trailer towing
Driving characteristics, towing
tips
In the case of caravans/trailers with brakes,
attach breakaway stopping cable to eye.
Before attaching the trailer/caravan,
lubricate the ball of the trailer/caravan
towing device. However, do not lubricate
the ball if a stabiliser, which acts on the
coupling ball, is being used to damp
hunting.
Check caravan/trailer lighting before
starting to drive. The fog tail lights on the
vehicle are deactivated when towing a
caravan or trailer.
Trailers with LED turn signals must have a
provision enables light monitoring for
commercial bulbs.
Turn signal control indicator - page 40.
Parking distance sensor 3 is deactivated
when towing.
Handling is greatly influenced by the
loading of the trailer/caravan. Loads
should therefore be secured so that they
cannot slip and be placed in the centre of
the trailer/caravan if possible, i.e. above
the axle.
In the case of trailers with low driving
stability or caravans with a permitted gross
vehicle weight of over 1300 kg (Hatch) /
1200 kg (Estate), do not exceed a speed of
50 mph (80 km/h); the use of a friction-type
stabiliser is highly recommended.
Do not drive faster than 50 mph (80 km/h)
if possible, even in countries where higher
speeds are permitted.
Make sure that you have enough room
when cornering and avoid sudden
manoeuvres.
If the trailer/caravan starts to sway, drive
more slowly, do not attempt to correct the
steering and brake sharply if necessary.
If it is necessary to apply the brakes fully,
depress the brake pedal as hard as
possible.
Remember that the braking distance for
vehicles towing caravans/trailers with and
without brake is always greater than that
for vehicles not towing a caravan/trailer.
6
246 Roof racks, Caravan and trailer towing
When driving downhill, the brakes are
under considerably more load when towing
a caravan/trailer. For this reason, drive in
the same gear as if driving uphill and drive
at a similar speed.
Automatic transmission 3 or Easytronic 3
in automatic mode will automatically
select the driving programme with the
optimum engine braking effect.
Gear position 3, 2 or 1 can also be
manually selected if required.
The cooling fan is electrically operated. Its
cooling power is therefore independent of
the engine speed.
Since a considerable amount of heat is
generated at high engine speeds and less
at slower speeds, do not shift down when
climbing hills whilst the vehicle is still coping
with the gradient in the higher gear.
Starting on inclines
For vehicles with manual transmission, the
most favourable engine speed when
starting off on an incline is between 2500
and 3000 rpm for petrol engines and
between 2000 and 2200 rpm for diesel
engines. Hold engine speed constant,
engage clutch gradually (let slip), release
hand brake and open throttle. If possible,
the engine speed should not drop during
this procedure.
For vehicles with automatic transmission 3
or Easytronic 3 in automatic mode, apply
full throttle.
Before starting off under extreme
conditions (high combination weight,
mountainous terrain with steep inclines),
switch off all unnecessary electrical loads
(e.g. heated rear window, air conditioning
system 3 , heated front seats 3 ).
247Self-help
Self-help
Diesel fuel system, bleeding
Never let the tank run dry! If control
indicator Y illuminates, refuel as soon as
possible. Refuel immediately if it flashes.
It is possible to restart the engine if the tank
has been run dry. A delayed start is to be
expected. Switch on the ignition three times
for approx. 15 seconds. Then attempt to
start the engine for approx. 40 seconds
1)
. If
the engine does not start, wait at
least 5 minutes and try again. If the engine
does not start, consult a workshop. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
Starting
Do not start with quick charger
This prevents damage to electronic
components.
Do not start by
pushing or towing
Because your vehicle is fitted with a
catalytic converter, it must not be started
by pushing or towing – page 207.
Vehicle with the Open&Start system 3 must
not be started by pushing or towing if the
battery is discharged, since the steering
column lock cannot be released.
The vehicle can only be started using jump
leads – see following page.
Starting the engine with jump leads 3 248
Towing the vehicle............................... 249
Towing service ..................................... 250
Towing another vehicle....................... 251
Warning triangle ¨3.......................... 252
First-aid kit (cushion) + 3................... 252
Spare wheel placed in luggage
compartment..................................... 254
Jack £3 and vehicle tools 3 ............ 256
Changing wheels ................................. 257
Tyre repair kit 3................................... 261
Electrical system .................................. 264
Fuses and the most important circuits
they protect ....................................... 266
Bulb replacement ................................ 274
Halogen headlight system.................. 274
Xenon headlight system 3, Adaptive
Forward Lighting system 3.............. 278
Front indicator lights ........................... 281
Fog lights 3.......................................... 281
Tail lights .............................................. 282
Number plate light .............................. 291
Courtesy lights ..................................... 292
9 Warning
Disregard of these notes can lead to
injuries which may be fatal. Vehicle
passengers should be informed
accordingly.
1)
For engine Z 17 DTH: For technical reasons,
only possible for 30 seconds. Sales designation
- see page 315.
248 Self-help
Starting the engine with jump
leads 3
A vehicle with a discharged battery can be
started using jump leads and the battery of
another vehicle.
z Never expose the battery to naked
flames or sparks.
z A discharged batter can freeze at
temperatures of 0 °C. Defrost the frozen
battery in a warm room before
connecting jump leads.
z Do not allow battery fluid to come into
contact with eyes, skin, fabrics or
painted surfaces. The fluid contains
sulphuric acid which can cause injuries
and damage in the event of direct
contact.
z Wear eye protection and protective
clothing when handling a battery.
z Use auxiliary battery with same voltage
(12 volts). Its capacity (Ah) must not be
considerably less than that of the
discharged battery. Voltage and
capacity information can be found on
the batteries.
z Use jump leads with insulated terminals
and a cross section of at least 16 mm
2
(25 mm
2
for diesel engines).
z Do not disconnect the discharged
battery from the vehicle.
z Switch off all unnecessary electrical
consumers.
z Do not lean over the battery during jump
starting.
z Do not allow the terminals of one lead to
touch those of the other lead.
z Do not touch the vehicles while jump
starting.
z Apply hand brake. Manual transmission
or Easytronic 3 in neutral, automatic
transmission 3 in P.
9 Warning
Be extremely careful when starting with
jump leads. Any deviation from the
following instructions can lead to injuries
or damage caused by battery explosion
or damage to the electrical systems of
both vehicles.
249Self-help
Connect the leads in the order shown in the
illustration:
1. Connect one end of the first jump lead to
the positive terminal 1 of the battery
providing the jump start (identified by
"+" sign on battery case or terminal).
2. Connect the other end of this lead to the
positive terminal 2 of the discharged
battery ("+" sign).
3. Connect the first end of the other jump
lead to the negative terminal 3 of the
battery providing the start ("–" sign).
4. Connect the other end of the second
jump lead 4 to ground on the other
vehicle, e.g. engine block or screw
connection in the engine suspension.
z Do not connect leads to negative
terminal of discharged battery!
z The connection point should be as far
away from the discharged battery as
possible.
z Route the leads so that they cannot
catch on rotating parts in the engine
compartment.
z Start the engine of the vehicle providing
the jump start.
z After 5 minutes, start the other engine.
Start attempts should be made at
intervals of 1 minute not last longer than
15 seconds.
z After starting, allow both engines to idle
for approx. 3 minutes with the leads
connected.
z In order to avoid excess voltage in the
electrical system, before removing a
lead, switch on an electrical consumer
(e.g. light, heated rear window) in the
vehicle receiving the jump start.
z Reverse above sequence exactly when
removing leads.
Towing the vehicle
To open the cover concealing the towing
eye socket at the front right of the vehicle:
disengage the cover at the bottom and pull
it off downwards.
For versions with tyre repair set 3, the
towing eye is in the stowage compartment
in the boot below the loading floor cover
– page 261.
For versions with spare wheel 3, the towing
eye is in the stowage compartment for the
jack 3 and tool kit 3 below the spare
wheel – page 256.
6
250 Self-help
Screw in the towing eye anticlockwise as far
as it will go until it stops in a horizontal
position.
Attach a tow rope 3 – or better still a
tow rod 3 – to the eye.
The towing eye must only be used for
towing and not recovering a vehicle.
Switch on ignition to release steering
column lock and to permit operation of
brake lights, horn and windscreen wiper.
Vehicles with the Open&Start system 3
must not be towed when the battery is
discharged because the steering column
lock cannot be released. Towing is only
possible with the ignition switched on. Use
jump leads to start the engine if necessary.
Manual transmission or Easytronic 3 in
neutral, automatic transmission 3 in N.
Drive slowly. Do not drive jerkily. Excessive
tractive force can damage the vehicle.
To prevent the entry of exhaust fumes from
the towing vehicle, switch on the air
recirculation 3 and close the windows.
Vehicles with automatic transmission 3
should be towed facing forward only and
must not be towed faster than 50 mph (80
km/h) or further than 60 miles (100 km). If
the transmission is defective, or if the
above speed or distance is to be exceeded,
the front axle must be raised off the
ground.
Consult a workshop. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who will
serve you best to get your vehicle back on
the road.
If the automatic clutch has been manually
released in vehicles with Easytronic 3
because of an interruption to the power
supply, towing is not permitted
– see page 185. In this case, consult a
workshop as soon as possible. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
After towing, unscrew the towing eye
clockwise and refit the cover.
Towing service
Entrust your vehicle only to the towing
service of your choice and obtain an
estimate on towing costs before employing
any towing service. In this way you avoid
unnecessary costs and possible insurance
problems during claim processing.
9 Warning
For braking and steering, significantly
higher forces are required: brake
assistance and steering assistance are
effective only with the engine running.
251Self-help
Towing
another vehicle
To open the cover concealing the towing
eye socket at the rear right of the vehicle:
disengage the cover at the bottom and pull
it off downwards.
On some versions 3: remove the cover
concealing the towing eye at the rear right
of the vehicle by disengaging the tabs at
the bottom and pulling off the cover from
the top.
For versions with tyre repair set 3, the
towing eye is in the stowage compartment
in the boot below the loading floor cover
– page 261.
For versions with spare wheel 3, the towing
eye is in the stowage compartment for the
jack 3 and tool kit 3 below the spare
wheel – page 256.
Screw in the towing eye anticlockwise as far
as it will go until it stops in a horizontal
position.
Attach a tow rope 3 – or better still a
tow rod 3 – to the eye.
The towing eye must only be used for
towing and not recovering a vehicle.
Drive slowly. Do not drive jerkily. Excessive
tractive force can damage the vehicle.
After towing, unscrew the towing eye
clockwise and refit the cover.
Version with cover 3: install by inserting
the bottom lugs of the cover 3 in the
bumper, folding and then press the lugs at
the top into place.
252 Self-help
Warning triangle ¨3
Hatch, Astra TwinTop
Store warning triangle in rear luggage
compartment wall: first fit warning triangle
into recess on left and the insert in guide on
right.
To remove the warning triangle, lift to the
right and pull out to the right.
For vehicles with cargo box 3: Lift the
warning triangle with the right half of the
cargo box. Pull out the warning triangle to
the right.
Estate, Van
Insert the warning triangle in the retaining
straps of the tailgate inner panelling.
First-aid kit (cushion) + 3
Hatch
Secure the first-aid kit to the right luggage
compartment wall using the retaining
strap.
253Self-help
Estate
Fasten the first-aid kit (cushion) to the left
luggage compartment wall with a
retaining strap.
Van
Place first aid kit in stowage compartment
behind driver’s seat. To open the cover,
press the locking tab.
Astra TwinTop
Store the first-aid kit (cushion) in the recess
behind the strap in the left luggage
compartment wall.
254 Self-help
Spare wheel 3
Some vehicles are equipped with a tyre
repair kit instead of a spare wheel
– page 261.
Spare wheel placed in
luggage compartment
The spare wheel is located in the luggage
compartment below the floor cover and is
fastened with a nut. On Estates, there is
also a spacer over the retaining nut.
Stowing wheels with wide tyres in the
spare wheel well
The spare wheel well is not designed for all
permitted tyre sizes. If a wheel wider than
the spare must be stowed in the spare
wheel well after changing wheels, the floor
cover can be placed on the projecting
wheel.
This must be observed when loading the
luggage compartment, especially for the
Astra TwinTop.
255Self-help
Estate
Take adapter 3 and hooks 3 from the
rails 3 in the luggage compartment walls.
Raise the rear lashing eyes and lift the floor
cover to the vertical position so that it rests
on the roof lining.
When closing, guide the lashing eyes
through the slots in the floor cover.
Vehicles with cargo box 3: Removal
– page 103.
Astra TwinTop
Accessing the spare wheel when the roof is
open: Engage luggage compartment cover
on the rear window frame and activate the
loading aid (see page 104). Raise the floor
cover in the luggage compartment.
General information
Depending on version, the spare wheel
may be in the form of a temporary spare
wheel 3. Refer to the notes on this page
and pages 237, 260, 333.
On vehicles with alloy wheels 3 the spare
wheel may have a steel rim.
If you use winter tyres 3, the spare wheel
may still be fitted with a summer tyre. If you
use the spare wheel the vehicle’s handling
may be altered. Obtain a replacement for
the faulty tyre as soon as possible, and
have the wheel balanced and fitted to the
vehicle.
The spare wheel may have a smaller tyre
and a smaller rim than the wheels mounted
on the vehicle
1)
: Using the spare wheel
may alter vehicle handling. Have the
defective tyre replaced as soon as possible,
balance the wheel and have it mounted on
the vehicle.
Notes on temporary spare wheel 3
z Using a temporary spare wheel may
change the driving behaviour of the
vehicle, particularly if using winter
tyres 3. Replace defective tyre as quickly
as possible, balance wheel and fit to
vehicle.
z Fit only one temporary spare wheel.
z Do not drive faster than 50 mph
(80 km/h).
z Take curves slowly.
z Do not use the temporary spare wheel
for a lengthy period.
z Replace temporary spare wheel with full
specification wheel without delay.
z Tyre chains are not permitted on the
temporary spare wheel. If tyre chains are
necessary after a front wheel puncture,
fit the temporary spare wheel to the rear
and a rear wheel to the front. Check tyre
pressure and adjust if necessary
– page 334.
z Follow temporary spare wheel
instructions on pages 237, 260, 333.
1)
Country-specific version: The spare wheel is
only to be used as a temporary spare wheel.
256 Self-help
Notes on directional tyres 3
Directional tyres only provide maximum
performance when they are mounted in the
correct direction of rotation. If the tyres or
spare wheel must be mounted opposing
the specified direction of rotation (e.g.
after changing a flat tyre), observe the
following:
z Vehicle handling may change. Have the
defective tyre replaced as soon as
possible, and have the wheel balanced
and mounted on the vehicle.
z Do not drive faster than 50 mph
(80 km/h).
z Be especially careful when driving in rain
and snow.
Further information on directional tyres
– page 230.
Jack £3 and
vehicle tools 3
The jack and the vehicle tools have been
specially developed for your vehicle and
must only be used on that vehicle. Only use
jack for changing wheels.
Vehicles with spare wheel 3
The jack and tool kit are in a stowage
compartment in the boot below the spare
wheel. Remove spare wheel, – page 254.
Vehicles with tyre repair set 3
The tool kit and tyre repair set are in a
storage compartment below the floor
cover in the luggage compartment.
After use, stow away the jack and tools in
the compartment as shown in illustration.
Astra TwinTop:
The tools for emergency
operation of the convertible hardtop are
stowed in the glove compartment.
257Self-help
Changing wheels
There may be a tyre repair kit instead of a
spare wheel – page 261.
To ensure your safety, make the following
preparations and observe the following
information when changing wheels:
z Park the vehicle on a level, firm and non-
skid surface.
z Switch on hazard warning lights, apply
hand brake, automatic transmission 3 -
selector lever in P, manual transmission
or Easytronic 3
- engage 1st or reverse gear.
z Correctly set up the warning triangle 3.
Warning triangle – page 252.
z Remove spare wheel from luggage
compartment, see previous page 254.
z Before raising the vehicle, set the front
wheels to the straight-ahead position.
z On the Astra TwinTop, the roof must be
closed before the vehicle is raised.
z Never change more than one wheel at
once.
z Block the wheel diagonally opposite the
wheel to be changed by placing wedge
blocks or equivalent in front and behind
the wheel.
z Use the jack 3 only to change wheels.
z If the ground on which the vehicle is
standing is soft, a solid board (max. 1 cm
thick) should be placed under the
jack 3 . Using a thicker board could
damage the jack 3 and the vehicle.
z No people or animals may be in the
vehicle when it is jacked up.
z Never crawl under a jacked-up vehicle.
z Do not start or run the engine while the
vehicle is on the jack.
z Apply a light coating of grease to the
cone of each wheel bolt before screwing
in the wheel bolts after a wheel change.
Some normal commercial grease will be
required for this purpose. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
258 Self-help
1. Prise off the wheel trim using the hook
included with the vehicle tools 3. For
vehicle tools, – page 256.
On wheel trims with visible wheel bolts 3:
The trim can remain on the wheel. Do not
remove the retaining washers 3 on the
wheel bolts.
Alloy wheels 3 : Disengage the wheel
bolt caps with a screwdriver and remove.
Protect the wheel by inserting a soft cloth
between the screwdriver and ally wheel.
2. Turn wheel bolts half a turn using the
wheel bolt wrench 3, pushing the
wrench 3 on as far as possible.
259Self-help
3. The location of each jacking point 3 is
indicated by a mark on the bottom edge
of the vehicle.
For vehicles with side skirt trims 3 , the
jack 3 may not be used as it may
damage the vehicle.
4. Before positioning the jack 3 , set it to
the necessary height by rotating the eye
by hand. Position the jack 3 at the front
or rear so that the jack claw spans the
vertical base and grips in the recess in
the vertical base. Make sure it is properly
positioned.
The jack base must be on the ground
directly below the jacking point in a
manner that prevents it from slipping.
Attach crank to eye of threaded rod and
turn crank to raise vehicle.
If this is not the case, carefully lower the
vehicle immediately and reposition the
jack.
5. Unscrew wheel bolts and wipe clean with
a cloth. Then apply a light coating of
grease to the wheel bolts. Do not grease
the thread of the bolts. Do not put the
wheel bolts down in a location where
they may become soiled.
If the wheel bolts have retaining
washers 3, they must not be removed.
260 Self-help
6. Change the wheel. Notes on spare wheel
– page 254, notes on temporary spare
wheel – page 255.
7. Screw in wheel bolts and tighten slightly,
inserting the wheel bolt wrench 3 as far
as possible.
8. Lower vehicle.
9. Tighten wheel bolts crosswise, putting on
wheel bolt wrench 3 as far as possible.
10. Before refitting the wheel trim, clean the
wheel around the retaining clips. Valve
symbol 3 on back of wheel trim must
point towards valve on wheel.
Align and refit wheel trim or wheel bolt
caps 3.
Alloy wheels 3 : Align and refit wheel
bolt caps 3.
11. Stow replaced wheel, tools and warning
triangle 3 in luggage compartment,
see pages 252 to 256.
12. Check the tyre pressure of the newly
fitted wheel. Adjust as necessary.
13. Have the tightening torque of the wheel
bolts on the new wheel checked on the
vehicle using a torque wrench as soon
as possible and, if necessary, corrected.
Tightening torque – page 333.
14. Replace the faulty tyre on the wheel
that was removed.
15. Replace temporary spare wheel 3 with
a full specification wheel without delay.
16. Initialise the deflation detection
system 3 or tyre pressure monitoring
system 3 – pages 221, 224.
261Self-help
Tyre repair kit 3
Minor damage to the tyre tread or side
wall, e.g. from foreign bodies, can be
repaired using the tyre repair kit (does not
apply to run-flat tyres).
Do not remove the foreign body from the
tyre.
Tyre damage exceeding 4 mm or that is on
the rim cannot be repaired with the tyre
repair kit.
Important information – page 264.
In the event of a flat tyre:
z Switch on hazard warning lights, apply
hand brake, automatic transmission 3 -
selector lever in P , manual transmission
or Easytronic 3 - engage 1st or reverse
gear.
z Correctly set up the warning triangle 3,
warning triangle – page 252.
The tyre repair kit is in a compartment
under the floor cover luggage
compartment.
1. Take the pouch with the tyre repair kit
from the compartment. Carefully remove
the components from the pouch.
2. Remove the compressor.
3. Remove the electrical connection cable
and air hose from the stowage
compartments on the underside of the
compressor.
9 Warning
Driving with inadequate tyre pressure or
a flat tyre can lead to hidden tyre
damage, which cannot be eliminated by
using the tyre repair kit. Park the vehicle
and consult a workshop. We recommend
your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
262 Self-help
4. Screw the compressor air hose to the
connection on the sealant bottle.
5. Fit the sealant bottle in the retainer on
the compressor.
Set the compressor near the tyre in such
a way that the sealant bottle is upright.
6. Remove the valve cap from the defective
tyre.
7. Screw the filler hose to the tyre valve.
8. The switch on the compressor must be
set to §.
9. Connect the compressor plug to the
accessory socket or cigarette lighter
socket. Accessory socket – page 107.
To avoid discharging the battery, we
recommend running the engine.
10. Set the rocker switch on the
compressor to I. The tyre is filled with
sealant.
11. While the sealant bottle drains (approx.
30 seconds) the pressure indicator on
the compressor briefly points to 6 bar.
Pressure then sinks again.
12.All of the sealant is pumped into the
tyre. Afterwards, the tyre is filled with
air.
13. The prescribed tyre pressure
– page 333 should be reached within 10
minutes. Switch off the compressor
when the correct pressure is obtained.
263Self-help
If the prescribed tyre pressure is not
reached within 10 minutes, detach the
tyre repair kit. Move the vehicle one tyre
revolution (approx. 2 metres) in or
against the flow of traffic. Reconnect
the tyre repair kit and continue the
filling procedure for 10 minutes. If the
prescribed tyre pressure is still not
reached, the tyre is too badly
damaged. Park the vehicle and consult
a workshop. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Drain excess tyre pressure with the
button over the pressure indicator.
Do not run the compressor for more
than 10 minutes - see "Important
information" on page 264.
14. Detach the tyre repair kit. Screw the
filler hose to the free connection on the
sealant bottle. This prevents sealant
leakage. Stow the tyre repair kit in the
luggage compartment.
15. Wipe away any sealant spill with a
cloth.
16. Disassemble the warning triangle 3
and store in luggage compartment
– page 252.
17. The enclosed sticker shows the
maximum permitted speed at which the
tyre repair may be used. Apply sticker in
the driver’s field of vision.
18. Continue driving immediately to allow
the sealant to distribute evenly
throughout the tyre. Stop after approx.
6 miles / 10 km (no more than 10
minutes) and check tyre pressure. Screw
the compressor air hose directly onto
the tyre valve (see Fig. 17256 T).
If tyre pressure is more than 1.3 bar,
adjust to the prescribed value. Repeat
the procedure until there is no more
pressure loss.
If tyre pressure is below 1.3, the vehicle
must not be driven. Consult a workshop.
We recommend your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
19. Stow the tyre repair kit in the luggage
compartment – page 261.
264 Self-help
Important
The driving comfort of the repaired tyre is
severely affected, therefore have this tyre
replaced.
If the compressor makes abnormal noises
or heats up greatly, switch it off for at least
30 minutes.
The integrated safety valve opens at a
pressure of 7 bar.
Protect the compressor from moisture and
rain.
The sealant can only be stored for approx.
4 years. After this time, the sealing
properties can no longer be guaranteed.
Heed the expiration date on the sealant
bottle.
The sealant bottle can only be used once.
Replace a used sealant bottle.
The compressor and sealant can be used
from approx. -30 °C.
Dispose of a used tyre repair kit in
accordance with applicable legislation.
The adapters supplied 3 can be used to
inflate other items e.g. footballs, air
mattresses, inflatable dinghies etc.
They are located on the underside of the
compressor. To remove, screw on
compressor air hose and withdraw
adapter.
When using the tyre repair set, no
consumers may be connected to the front
accessory socket.
Electrical system
Fuses
The vehicle has two fuse boxes: one behind
a cover on the left side of the luggage
compartment and one in the front left of
the engine compartment.
9 Warning
Do not drive faster than 50 mph
(80 km/h).
Do not use the temporary spare wheel for
a lengthy period.
Steerability and driving behaviour may
be impaired.
9 Warning
Electronic ignition systems generate very
high voltages. Do not touch the ignition
system; high voltage can be fatal.
265Self-help
We recommend carrying a complete set of
spare fuses –available from your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer. Store spare fuses in
the fuse box in the luggage compartment.
Open cover, see page 266.
Before replacing a fuse, turn off the
respective switch and the ignition.
A blown fuse (see figures to the right) can
be recognised by its melted wire. Do not
install a new fuse until the cause of the
fault has been remedied.
Different versions of fuses are used.
Fuse Fuse
colour rating
Brownish yellow 5 A
Brown 7.5 A
Red 10 A
Blue 15 A
Yellow 20 A
Transparent 25 A
Green 30 A
Fuse Fuse
colour rating
Blue 20 A
Transparent 25 A
Pink 30 A
Green 40 A
266 Self-help
There is a fuse extractor in the luggage
compartment fuse box to facilitate
replacement of fuses - see figure above for
an example.
Place the fuse extractor on the various
types of fuse from the top or side, and
withdraw fuse.
Only fit fuses of the specified current
rating. Each fuse has its current rating
written on it, in addition the ratings are
colour coded.
Fuses and the most important
circuits they protect
Fuse box in luggage compartment
Depending on the equipment version,
there are two different fuse boxes for
differing electrical circuits.
z Version A – see figure 18453 T,
z Version B – see figure 17958 T
Astra TwinTop always has version B.
Spare fuses, fuse extractor – page 264.
The fuse box is located on the left side of
the luggage compartment behind a cover.
Do not store any objects behind the cover.
267Self-help
5-door saloon,
Estate, van
To open, turn both catches with a coin and
fold cover down.
3-door hatch
To open, fold the cover upwards.
Astra TwinTop
To open, pull the two knobs, remove the
clips and fold the cover upwards.
Fuse box, version A
Some functions are protected by several
fuses. To replace a fuse, pull off its
protective cap.
No
.
Circuit Rating
1 Luggage compartment
socket
15 A
2 Rear socket 15 A
3 Electric
windows, front
30 A
4 Electric
windows, rear
30 A
5 Reversing lights 7.5 A
6 Air conditioning system 10 A
7 Heated exterior mirrors 7.5 A
268 Self-help
Fuse box, version B
Some functions are protected by several
fuses.
No
.
Circuit Rating
1 Electric
windows, front
25 A
2 ––
3 Instruments 7.5 A
4 Heating,
air conditioning system,
climate control system
5 A
5 Airbags 7.5 A
6 ––
7 ––
8 ––
9 ––
10 ––
11 Heated rear window 25 A
12 Tailgate wiper 15 A
No
.
Circuit Rating
13 Parking distance sensor 5 A
14 Heating,
air conditioning system
7.5
15 ––
16 Seat occupancy recognition,
Open&Start system
5 A
17 Rain sensor,
air quality sensor,
tyre pressure monitoring
system,
interior mirror
5 A
18 Instruments, switches 5 A
19 ––
20 CDC 10 A
21 heated exterior mirrors 7.5 A
22 Sun roof 20 A
23 Electric
windows, rear
25 A
269Self-help
No
.
Circuit Rating
24 Diagnostics plug 7.5 A
25 ––
26 Electrically retractable
exterior mirrors
7.5 A
27 Ultrasonic sensor,
Vauxhall alarm system
5 A
28 ––
29 Cigarette lighter,
front socket
15 A
30 Rear socket 15 A
31 ––
No
.
Circuit Rating
32 ––
33 Open&Start system 15 A
34 Sun roof, TwinTop 25 A
35 Rear socket 15 A
36 Towing equipment 20 A
37 ––
No
.
Circuit Rating
38 Central locking system,
clamp 30
25 A
39 Seat heater (left) 15 A
40 Seat heater (right) 15 A
41 ––
42 ––
43 ––
44 ––
270 Self-help
Fuse box in engine compartment
The fuse box is at the front left side of the
engine compartment.
To open the cover, release the catch by
inserting a screwdriver into the opening as
far as it will go and swivelling it to the side.
Open the cover upwards and remove.
Depending on the equipment version,
there are two different fuse layouts for the
engine compartment fuse box, handling
different electrical circuits:
z If the luggage compartment fuse box is
version A - see Fig. 18453 T on page 267
- the fuse layout in the engine
compartment is version A – see next
column.
z If the luggage compartment fuse box is
version B – see Fig. 17958 T on page 269
- the fuse layout in the engine
compartment is version B – see next
page.
Astra TwinTop always has version B.
Spare fuses, fuse extractor – page 264.
Fuse layout, version A
Some functions are protected by several
fuses.
9 Warning
Turn off engine before opening engine
compartment fuse box; risk of injury
– page 297.
No
.
Circuit Rating
1 ABS 20 A
2 ABS 30 A
3 Interior fan
climate control system
30 A
4 Interior fan,
heating,
air conditioning system
30 A
5 Radiator fan 1
1)
1)
Different ratings depending on
engine and equipment level.
30 A
40 A
271Self-help
No
.
Circuit Rating
6 Radiator fan 2
1)
1)
Different ratings depending on
engine and equipment level.
20 A
30 A
40 A
7 Central locking system 20 A
8 Windscreen wash system,
tailgate
10 A
9 Heated rear window,
heated exterior mirrors
30 A
10 Diagnostics plug 7.5 A
11 Instruments 7.5 A
12 Mobile telephone,
digital radio,
Twin Audio,
display
7.5 A
13 Courtesy light 5 A
No
.
Circuit Rating
14 Windscreen wiper 30 A
15 Windscreen wiper 30 A
16 Horn,
ABS,
brake light switch,
air conditioning system
5 A
17 Diesel filter
or
air conditioning system
25 A
20 A
18 Starter 25 A
19 ––
20 Horn 15 A
No
.
Circuit Rating
21 Engine electronics 20 A
22 Engine electronics 7.5 A
23 Headlight range adjustment 5 A
24 Fuel pump 15 A
25 ––
26 Engine electronics 10 A
27 Heating,
air conditioning system,
air quality sensor
7.5 A
28 ––
29 Power steering 5 A
30 Engine electronics 10 A
31 Tailgate wiper 15 A
32 Brake light switch 5 A
33 Headlight range
adjustment,
light switch,
clutch switch,
instrument assembly,
driver’s door module
5 A
34 Control unit
Steering column module
7.5 A
35 Infotainment system 20 A
36 Cigarette lighter,
front socket
15 A
272 Self-help
Fuse layout, version B
Some functions are protected by several
fuses.
No
.
Circuit Rating
1 ABS 20 A
2 ABS 30 A
3 Interior fan
climate control system
30 A
4 Interior fan,
heating,
air conditioning system
30 A
5 Radiator fan 1
1)
1)
Different ratings depending on
engine and equipment level.
30 A
40 A
6 Radiator fan 2
1)
20 A
30 A
40 A
No
.
Circuit Rating
7 Windscreen wash system 10 A
8 Horn 15 A
9 Headlight wash system 25 A
10 ––
11 ––
12 ––
13 Fog lights 15 A
14 Windscreen wiper 30 A
15 Windscreen wiper 30 A
No
.
Circuit Rating
16 Electronics control units,
Open&Start system,
ABS,
brake light switch,
TwinTop
5 A
17 Diesel filter heating 25 A
18 Starter 25 A
19 Transmission electronics 30 A
20 Air conditioning system 10 A
21 Engine electronics 20 A
22 Engine electronics 7.5 A
23 Adaptive Forward Lighting,
headlight range adjustment
10 A
273Self-help
No
.
Circuit Rating
24 Fuel pump 15 A
25 Transmission electronics 15 A
26 Engine electronics 10 A
27 Power steering 5 A
28 Transmission electronics 5 A
29 Transmission electronics 7.5 A
30 Engine electronics 10 A
No
.
Circuit Rating
31 Adaptive Forward Lighting,
headlight range adjustment
10 A
32 Brake system,
air conditioning system,
clutch switch
5 A
33 Adaptive Forward Lighting,
headlight range adjustment,
light switch
5 A
34 Control unit,
steering column module
7.5 A
35 Infotainment system 20 A
36 Mobile telephone,
digital radio,
Twin Audio,
display
7.5 A
274 Self-help
Bulb replacement
Before replacing a bulb, switch ignition off
and switch relevant switch off.
Only hold new bulb at base! Do not touch
the bulb glass with bare hands, otherwise
fingerprints on the glass evaporate.
Residue builds up on the reflector
eventually resulting in a dull reflector.
Inadvertently stained bulbs may be
cleaned with a clean non-fluffy cloth, using
alcohol or white spirits.
The replacement bulb must be in
accordance with the data on the base of
the defective bulb. Do not exceed wattage
given on bulb base.
The bulbs of the front outer lights are
replaced through openings in the front
wheel arch: turn relevant wheels to gain
access, release catch and remove cover.
Headlight aiming
We recommend that headlight aiming be
carried out by your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer, who will have special equipment.
When adjusting headlights, headlight
range adjustment must be set to 0.
Halogen headlight system
Headlights with separate systems for main
beam 1 (inner bulbs) and dipped beam 2
(outer bulbs).
275Self-help
Dipped beam
1. Replace bulb through opening the front
wheel arch: turn relevant wheel to gain
access, release catch and remove cover
– page 274.
2. Remove headlight protective cover.
3. Rotate left bulb holder and disengage. 4. Remove the bulb holder with bulb from
the reflector.
276 Self-help
5. Detach bulb from bulb holder.
6. Insert new bulb into bulb holder,
without touching the glass.
7. Insert new bulb so that the two lugs on
the bulb holder engage in the recesses
in the reflector.
8. Rotate bulb holder to right as far as it
will go.
9. Place headlight protective cover in
position and close.
10. Position cover on opening in wheel arch
and engage.
Main beam
1. Open bonnet and engage support.
2. Replace bulbs from engine
compartment out.
To replace the bulb on the right-hand
side, remove the air hose from the air
filter.
To replace the bulb on the left-hand
side, remove the plug from the fuse
box.
3. Remove headlight protective cover.
4. Detach plug connector from bulb.
5. Disengage spring clip from retainer by
pressing forward and then swing
downward.
6. Remove bulb from reflector housing.
7. When fitting a new bulb, engage the
lugs in the recesses on the reflector
without touching the glass.
277Self-help
8. Engage spring wire clip, plug connector
onto bulb.
9. Place headlight protective cover in
position and close.
After bulb replacement on the right-
hand side, reattach air hose to air filter
and engage.
After bulb replacement on the left-
hand side, reconnect the fuse box plug
and engage.
Parking lights
1. Open bonnet and engage support.
2. Replace bulbs from engine compartment
out.
To replace the bulb on the right-hand
side, remove the air hose from the air
filter.
To replace the bulb on the left-hand
side, remove the plug from the fuse box.
3. Remove main beam headlight protective
cover.
4. Remove parking light socket from
reflector.
6
278 Self-help
5. Remove bulb from socket.
6. Insert new bulb, without touching the
glass.
7. Insert holder in reflector. Place headlight
protective cap in position and close.
After bulb replacement on the right-
hand side, reattach air hose to air filter
and engage.
After bulb replacement on the left-hand
side, reconnect the fuse box plug and
engage.
Xenon headlight system 3,
Adaptive Forward Lighting
system 3
Headlights with separate systems for
dipped beam 1 (inner bulbs) and main
beam 2 (outer bulbs).
Dipped beam
Main beam
1. Replace bulb through opening the front
wheel arch: turn relevant wheel to gain
access, release catch and remove cover
– page 274.
2. Remove headlight protective cover.
9 Warning
The dipped beam operates at very high
voltage. Do not touch; high voltage can
be fatal. Have bulbs changed by a
workshop. We recommend your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
279Self-help
3. Rotate left bulb holder and disengage. 4. Remove the bulb holder with bulb from
the reflector.
5. Detach bulb from bulb holder.
6. Insert new bulb into bulb holder,
without touching the glass.
7. Insert new bulb so that the two lugs on
the bulb holder engage in the recesses
in the reflector.
8. Rotate bulb holder to right as far as it
will go.
9. Place headlight protective cover in
position and close.
10. Position cover on opening in wheel arch
and engage.
280 Self-help
Parking lights
1. Open bonnet and engage support.
2. Replace bulb through opening the front
wheel arch: turn relevant wheel to gain
access, release catch and remove cover
– page 274.
3. Remove main beam headlight protective
cover.
4. Remove parking light socket from
reflector.
5. Remove bulb from socket.
6. Insert new bulb, without touching the
glass.
7. Insert holder in reflector. Place headlight
protective cap in position and close.
8. Position cover on opening in wheel arch
and engage.
281Self-help
Front indicator lights
1. Open bonnet and engage support.
2. Replace bulb through opening the front
wheel arch: turn relevant wheel to gain
access, release catch and remove cover
– page 274.
3. Rotate bulb holder to left and
disengage.
4. Push bulb into socket slightly, rotate left
and remove.
5. Insert new bulb, without touching the
glass.
6. Insert light holder in reflector, rotate
clockwise and engage in position.
7. Position cover on opening in wheel arch
and engage.
Fog lights 3
Have the bulbs replaced by a workshop.
We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
282 Self-help
Tail lights
Hatch 5-door
1. To replace bulbs on the right side, use a
coin to open the lock as indicated in the
Fig. and fold the cover down.
To replace bulbs on the left side, use a
coin to turn both locks as illustrated on
page 266 in Fig. 17261 T and fold the
cover down.
2. Detach plug connector from bulb holder.
3. Hold outside of bulb housing, loosen
fastening nuts with wheel bolt wrench 3
and unscrew by hand. Wheel bolt
wrench 3 – see vehicle tools on
page 256.
4. Detach bulb housing towards the rear.
283Self-help
5. Unscrew three screws using a screwdriver
(vehicle tools – page 256). Press locking
tabs on outside of bulb holder inward
and remove the bulb holder.
Bulbs in bulb holder:
1 = Reversing light
2 = Turn signal
3 = Tail light/brake light
4 = Tail light
5 = Fog tail light
6. Remove bulb from socket.
7. Insert new bulb, without touching the
glass.
8. Engage bulb holder in bulb housing,
ensuring that it properly engages. Insert
three screws with washers and tighten as
far as possible.
284 Self-help
9. Ensure that the seals are applied to the
bulb holder and fixing screws.
10. Insert the bulb housing in the body,
engaging the lug and the ball pin in the
recesses. Tighten the fastening nuts
using a wheel bolt wrench 3. Attach the
plug connector. Close and engage the
flap.
11. Carry out the following steps to ensure
proper function of the tail lights:
– Switch on ignition
– Operate brake
– Switch on parking lights
285Self-help
Hatch 3-door
1. To replace bulbs, fold the cover down.
2. Detach plug connector from bulb holder.
3. Hold outside of bulb housing, loosen
fastening nuts with wheel bolt wrench 3
and unscrew by hand. Wheel bolt
wrench 3 – see vehicle tools on
page 256.
4. Detach bulb housing towards the rear.
286 Self-help
5. Remove the round seal from the
fastening bolt. Press the locking tabs on
the outside of the bulb holder outward
and remove the bulb holder.
Bulbs in bulb holder:
1 = Reversing light
2 = Turn signal
3 = Tail light/brake light
4 = Tail light
5 = Fog tail light
6. Remove bulb from socket.
7. Insert new bulb, without touching the
glass.
8. Engage bulb holder in bulb housing,
ensuring that it properly engages.
287Self-help
9. Ensure that the seals are applied to the
bulb holder and fixing screws.
10. Insert the bulb housing in the body,
engaging the lug and the ball pin in the
recesses. Tighten the fastening nuts
using a wheel bolt wrench 3. Attach the
plug connector. Close and engage the
flap.
11. Carry out the following steps to ensure
proper function of the tail lights:
– Switch on ignition
– Operate brake
– Switch on parking lights
288 Self-help
Estate, van
1. Disengage cover by pressing retaining
lugs and remove.
2. Detach plug connector from bulb holder.
3. Hold the outside of the bulb housing,
unscrew the three fastening nuts and
remove the bulb housing rearwards.
4. Unscrew the three screws with a
screwdriver (vehicle tools – page 256)
and remove the bulb holder.
289Self-help
Bulbs in bulb holder:
1 = Tail light/brake light
2 = Turn signal
3 = Reversing light
4 = Fog tail light
5. Remove bulb from socket.
6. Insert new bulb without touching the
glass. Insert bulb holder in bulb housing
and screw in place. Insert bulb housing
into body and tighten fastening nuts by
hand. Attach plug connector. Close and
lock cover.
7. Carry out the following steps to ensure
proper function of the tail lights:
– Switch on ignition
– Operate brake
– Switch on parking lights
Astra TwinTop
1. Unscrew retaining nuts.
6
290 Self-help
2. Remove bulb housing from outside.
Disengage plug by pressing on flap and
remove from bulb holder.
3. Detach seal from bulb holder.
4. Disengage sockets by turning and
remove.
Press locking tabs on the long sides of
the bulb holder outwards; lift bulb holder
at front end (arrow) and remove.
Bulbs in bulb holder:
1 = Tail light/brake light
2 = Tail light
3 = Fog tail light
4 = Reversing light
5 = Turn signal
291Self-help
5. Remove bulb from socket.
6. Insert new bulb, without touching the
glass.
7. Insert bulb holder in bulb housing by first
inserting the lug in the front of the plug.
Fold together bulb holder, ensuring that
it engages properly.
Insert sockets and engage by turning.
8. Fit seal on bulb holder as illustrated.
Ensure that the seal is flat in the area of
the screws.
9. Engage plug. Insert light housing in
body, ensuring proper positioning of
the ball pins in the recesses. Tighten the
retaining nuts.
10. Carry out the following steps to ensure
proper function of the tail lights:
– Switch on ignition
– Operate brake
– Switch on parking lights
Number plate light
1. Insert screwdriver vertically in bulb insert
as illustrated in figure. Press to the side
and release spring.
292 Self-help
2. Remove bulb housing downward, taking
care not to pull on the cable.
3. Lift flap and disconnect plug from bulb
socket.
4. Rotate bulb socket anticlockwise and
disengage.
5. Remove bulb from socket.
6. Insert new bulb, without touching the
glass.
7. Insert bulb holder in bulb housing and
twist to right.
8. Connect plug to bulb socket.
9. Insert and engage bulb housing.
Courtesy lights
Front courtesy light, reading lights 3
To ensure that no power is supplied to the
lights, close the doors before removing.
1. Disengage lens by hand at location
illustrated in figure, press it downward
slightly and remove at a downward
angle.
2. Remove bulb from socket.
3. Insert new bulb, without touching the
glass.
4. Mount lens and engage in position.
293Self-help
Rear courtesy lights 3 ,
rear reading lights 3
Have the bulbs replaced by a workshop.
We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
Glove compartment lighting,
luggage compartment lighting,
foot well lighting 3
To ensure that no power is supplied to the
lights, close the doors or hold the contact
switch depressed before removing.
1. Prise the light out with a screwdriver.
2. Press bulb slightly towards spring clip
and remove.
3. Insert new bulb, without touching the
glass.
4. Insert light in opening and engage in
position.
Instrument illumination,
Information display illumination 3
Have the bulbs replaced by a workshop.
We recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
294 If you have a problem
If you have a problem
In our experience the most common cause
of all complaints is the result of
misunderstanding or lack of
communication between the customer and
the Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
We sincerely hope you will never have
cause to complain about your vehicle.
However, if things do go wrong, the best
course of action for you to take is to
contact your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer’s Service Reception Staff and
explain the difficulty you are having. We
are confident they will do their utmost to
resolve the problem to your complete
satisfaction.
Sometimes, however, despite the best of
intentions of all concerned,
misunderstandings can occur. If your
problem has not been resolved to your
satisfaction, please make an appointment
to discuss the matter with the Manager of
the department concerned.
The majority of areas of concern can be
quickly resolved in this way.
Should you wish to pursue the matter
further, the Principal of the Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer should be made
aware of your concern. It is advisable in
cases such as this to write to him to confirm
your problem and the solutions that have
been offered.
You can be assured the Authorised
Repairer’s Principal will only be too anxious
to fully investigate your problems and
correct any errors made. After all, he has a
large investment in his business and is
proud of his reputation and
professionalism and fully realises that
satisfied customers are his key to success.
In the unlikely event that you are still not
happy with the answer your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer has given, or the
action he proposes to correct the problem,
you may contact the Customer Care
Department
1)
where a team of Customer
Care Consultants will spare no effort to
ensure your complete satisfaction.
Vauxhall Motors Ltd.
Customer Care,
Griffin House,
Osborne Road,
LUTON,
Beds., LU1 3YT
Telephone: 01582 427200
They will review all the facts involved. Then
if it is felt some further action can be taken,
the Vauxhall Authorised Repairer will be
advised accordingly. In any case, your
contact will be acknowledged confirming
Vauxhall Motors’ position in the matter.
If you are not satisfied with the outcome,
you can if you wish, seek advice from an
independent third party such as:
Automobile Association (A.A.)
Fanum House,
BASINGSTOKE,
Hants., RG21 2EA
Royal Automobile Club (R.A.C.),
R.A.C. Motoring Services Ltd.,
89-91 Pall Mall,
LONDON, SW1Y S45
The Customer Relations Department,
Society of Motor Manufacturers and
Traders Ltd. (S.M.M.T.),
Forbes House, Halkin Street,
LONDON, SW1X 7DS
Customer Complaints Service,
Scottish Motor Trade Association,
(S.M.T.A.),
3 Palmerston Place,
EDINBURGH, EH12 5AQ
The National Conciliation Service,
Retail Motor Industry Federation,
9 North Street,
RUGBY, CV21 2AB
If you have a problem whilst abroad:The
Service Departments of ADAM OPEL
GmbH and General Motors branches
everywhere will provide information and
assistance:
1)
Calls may be monitored and recorded for
training purposes.
295If you have a problem
In Luxembourg, please contact
the General Motors Service Department in
Antwerp – Belgium
Tel. 00 32-34 50 63 29
General Motors Austria GmbH
Groß-Enzersdorfer Str. 59
1220 Vienna – Austria
Tel. 00 43 1-2 88 77 444 or
00 43-1-2 88 77 0
General Motors Belgium N.V.
Noorderlaan 401 Haven 500
2030 Antwerp – Belgium
Tel. 00 32-34 50 63 29
General Motors Southeast Europe,
org. složka
Olbrachtova 9
140 00 Prague – Czech Republic
Tel. 00 420-2 39 004 321
General Motors Danmark
Jaegersborg Alle 4
2920 Charlottenlund – Denmark
Tel. 00 45-39 97 85 00
Vauxhall Motors Ltd.
Customer Care
Griffin House, Osborne Road
Luton, Bedfordshire, LU1 3YT – England
Tel. 00 44-15 82-42 72 00
General Motors Finland Oy
Pajuniityntie 5
00320 Helsinki – Finland
Tel. 00 358-9 817 101 47
General Motors France
1 – 9, avenue du Marais
Angle Quai de Bezons
95101 Argenteuil Cedex – France
Tel. 00 33-1-34 26 30 51
ADAM OPEL GmbH
Bahnhofsplatz 1
65423 Rüsselsheim – Germany
Tel. 00 49-61 42-77 50 00 or
00 49-61 42-7 70
General Motors Hellas S.A.
56 Kifisias Avenue & Delfon str.
Amarousion
151 25 Athens – Greece
Tel. 00 30-1-6 80 65 01
General Motors Southeast Europe Ltd.
Szabadsag utca 117
2040 Budaörs – Hungary
Tel. 00 36-23 446 100
General Motors India
Sixth Floor, Tower A
Global Business Park
Mehrauli – Gurgaon Road
Gurgaon – 122 022, Haryana – India
Tel. 00 91-124 280 3333
General Motors Ireland Ltd.
Opel House, Unit 60, Heather Road
Sandyford, Dublin 18 – Ireland
Tel. 00 353-1-216 10 00
General Motors Italia Srl
Piazzale dell’Industria 40
00144 Rome – Italy
Tel. 00 39-06-5 46 51
General Motors Nederland B.V.
Lage Mosten 49 – 63
4822 NK Breda – Netherlands
Tel. 00 31-76-5 44 83 00
General Motors Norge AS
Kjeller-Vest 6
2027 Kjeller – Norway
Tel. 00 47-23 50 01 04
General Motors Poland Sp. z o. o.
Domaniewska 41
06-672 Warsaw – Poland
Tel. 00 48-22-606 17 00
General Motors Portugal
Quinta da Fonte
Edificío Fernão Magalhães, Piso 2
2780-190 Paço d’Arcos – Portugal
Tel. 00 351-21 440 75 00
General Motors Southeast Europe,
org. zložka
Apollo Business Centre
Mlynské Nivy 45
821 09 Bratislava – Slovakia
Tel. 00 421-2 58 275 543
General Motors España S.L.
Paseo de la Castellana, 91
28046 Madrid – Spain
Tel. 00 34-902 25 00 25
General Motors Norden AB
Årstaängvägen 17
100 73 Stockholm – Sweden
Tel. 00 46-20 333 000
General Motors Suisse S.A.
Stelzenstraße 4
8152 Glattbrugg – Switzerland
Tel. 00 41-44 828 28 80
General Motors Türkiye Ltd. Sti.
Kemalpasa yolu üzeri
35861 Torbali/Izmir – Turkey
Tel. 00 90-2 32-8 53-14 53
In Albania, Bosnia-Herzegovina,
Bulgaria, Croatia, Estonia,
Latvia, Lithuania, Macedonia,
Romania, Serbia-Montenegro
and Slovenia
please contact the Opel
Service Department in Budaörs – Hungary
Telephone 00 36-23 446 100
296 Maintenance, Inspection System
Maintenance,
Inspection System
In order to guarantee economical and safe
vehicle operation and to maintain the
value of your vehicle, it is of vital
importance that all maintenance work is
carried out at the proper intervals as
specified by Vauxhall.
In vehicles with a fixed engine oil change
and service interval, InSP appears in the
odometer display when the ignition is
switched on if the vehicle is due for service.
Have service work performed within a week
or 300 miles (500 km). We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
The service interval display takes account
of off-the-road periods during which the
battery is disconnected.
For vehicles with flexible engine oil change
and service intervals, the length of these
intervals is based on several parameters
stemming from usage. For this reason,
various engine-specific data is continually
gathered and is used to calculate the
remaining distance until the next service.
This remaining distance can be displayed
with the ignition off: briefly press the trip
odometer reset button, the mileage
reading shows. Press the button again for
around 2 seconds, InSP and the remaining
distance is shown.
If the remaining distance is less than 1000
miles (1500 km), InsP is displayed with a
remaining distance of 600 miles (1000 km)
when the ignition is switched on and off.
InsP is displayed for several seconds if the
remaining distance is less than 600 miles
(1000 km). Have the service work that is
due carried out within one week or 300
miles (500 km). Have this work carried out
by a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer in order
to avoid invalidation of warranty claims.
A note on safety .................................. 297
Checking and topping up fluids......... 297
Engine oil.............................................. 298
Diesel fuel filter .................................... 300
Coolant................................................. 300
Brake fluid ............................................ 302
Windscreen wiper ................................ 303
Windscreen and headlight wash
systems 3........................................... 305
Battery.................................................. 306
Protecting electronic components ..... 306
Vehicle decommissioning.................... 307
Vehicle recommissioning..................... 307
297Maintenance, Inspection System
Further information on maintenance and
the inspection system can be found in the
service booklet, which is in the glove
compartment.
Have maintenance work, as well as repairs
to the bodywork and equipment, carried
out by a professional. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who is
familiar with Vauxhall vehicles and in
possession of the necessary special tools
and the latest service instructions from
Vauxhall. It is particularly advisable to use
a Vauxhall Authorised Repairer during the
warranty period to avoid invalidation of
warranty claims. See the Service Booklet for
further information.
Separate anti-corrosion service
Have the work carried out at the intervals
specified in the Service Booklet. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
A note on safety
To avoid injury from moving parts and
cables conducting ignition voltage, only
carry out engine compartment checks
(e.g. checking brake fluid or engine oil
level) when the ignition is switched off.
Never carry out any repairs or adjustment
and maintenance work on the vehicle
yourself. This especially applies to the
engine, chassis and safety parts. You may
unwittingly infringe the provisions of the
law and, by not performing the work
properly, endanger yourself and other
road users.
Checking and topping up fluids
To aid identification, the caps used when
topping up engine oil, coolant and wash
fluid as well as the oil dipstick are coloured
yellow.
9 Warning
The cooling fan is controlled by a
thermoswitch and can therefore start
unexpectedly even if the ignition is
switched off. Risk of injury.
Electronic ignition systems generate very
high voltages. Do not touch the ignition
system; high voltage can be fatal.
298 Maintenance, Inspection System
Engine oil
Information on engine oils is found in the
Service Booklet.
Engine oil level and consumption
Every engine consumes engine oil for
technical reasons. The engine oil
consumption cannot be assessed until a
fairly long distance has been driven, and
may be above the specified value when the
vehicle is first being driven (run-in period).
Frequent driving at high revs increases
engine oil consumption.
The engine oil level 3 is checked
automatically
1)
, see page 40. Before
embarking on a long journey it is advisable
to check the engine oil level.
Checking the engine oil level,
topping up engine oil
The figures on this page indicate checks on
one petrol and two diesel engines.
The oil level must be checked with the
vehicle on a level surface and with the
engine (which must be at operating
temperature) switched off. Wait at least 5
minutes before checking the level to allow
the normal engine oil accumulation in the
engine to drain into the oil pan.
9 Warning
It is the Owner’s Responsibility to
maintain the proper level of an
appropriate quality oil in the engine.
1)
Not on Z 14 XEP or Z 20 LEH engine. Sales
designation – see page 314.
299Maintenance, Inspection System
To check the engine oil level, insert wiped
oil dipstick into handle as far as it will go.
Top engine oil up if the level has dropped
into the range of the top-up mark MIN.
The engine oil level must not exceed the
upper mark MAX on the dipstick. Excess
engine oil must be drained off or extracted.
If the engine oil level is above the MAX
mark there is a risk of damage to the
engine or the catalytic converter.
Capacity between MIN and MAX marks
– pages 343, 343.
Top up with the same brand of engine oil
that was used during the previous oil
change, following the instructions in the
service booklet.
To close, position the cap and screw it into
place.
Capacities – pages 343, 343.
Engine oil change, oil filter change
Change the oil at the displayed service
intervals.
We recommend that you use genuine
Vauxhall engine oil filters.
9 Warning
Drained engine oil filters cannot be
placed with domestic refuse. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer for engine oil and filter change.
He is familiar with the legal requirements
on the disposal of old oil and filters. This
ensures protection for the environment
and your health.
300 Maintenance, Inspection System
Diesel fuel filter
Check fuel filter for any water residue when
each engine oil change takes place. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
Illumination of A indicates water in the
fuel filter 3.
Have fuel filter checked at shorter intervals
if the vehicle is subjected to extreme
operating conditions such as high humidity
(primarily in coastal areas), extremely high
or low outside temperatures and
substantially varying daytime and night-
time temperatures.
Coolant
The glycol-based coolant provides
excellent corrosion protection for the
heating and cooling systems as well as
antifreeze protection down to –28 °C. It
remains in the cooling system throughout
the year and need not be changed.
Use of certain antifreezes can lead to
engine damage. We therefore recommend
that you use antifreezes that have been
approved by Vauxhall.
Antifreeze and corrosion protection
Before the start of the cold weather season,
have the coolant checked for correct
concentration. We recommend that you
consult your Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
The amount of antifreeze must provide
protection down to approx. –28 °C. If the
antifreeze concentration is too low, this
reduces protection from freezing and
corrosion. Top up antifreeze if necessary.
If coolant loss is topped up with water,
have concentration checked and add
antifreeze if necessary.
9 Warning
Antifreeze is a danger to health; it must
therefore be kept in the original container
and out of the reach of children.
301Maintenance, Inspection System
Coolant level
Hardly any losses occur since the cooling
system is sealed and it is thus rarely
necessary to top up the coolant.
The coolant should be a little above the
KALT/COLD mark in the expansion tank
with a cold cooling system. The coolant
level can also be read off from the outside
of the expansion tank.
When the engine is at operating
temperature, coolant level rises. It falls
again when the system cools. If it falls
below the KALT/COLD mark when the
system is cold, top up to the mark.
Top up antifreeze. If no antifreeze is
available, top up with clean tap water. If
tap water is unavailable, distilled water
can be used.
After topping up with drinking water or
distilled water, check the anti-freeze level
and add anti-freeze if required. Eliminate
the cause of the coolant loss. We
recommend your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
Too low a coolant level can cause engine
damage.
To close, position the cap and screw it into
place.
Coolant temperature
Control indicator W illuminates when
coolant temperature is too high. Check
coolant level immediately:
z Coolant level low:
Top up coolant. Pay attention to the
instructions given under "Antifreeze and
corrosion protection" and "Coolant
level". Have the cause of coolant loss
remedied. We recommend that you
consult your Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer.
z Coolant level OK:
Have the cause of increased coolant
temperature remedied. Consult a
workshop. We recommend your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
9 Warning
Allow engine to cool down before
removing coolant filler cap. Remove filler
cap carefully so that pressure can escape
slowly, otherwise there is a risk of
scalding.
302 Maintenance, Inspection System
Brake fluid
Brake fluid level
The fluid level in the reservoir must be
neither higher than the MAX mark nor
lower than the MIN mark.
Use of certain brake fluids can lead to
damage or reduced braking effect. We
therefore recommend that you use only
high performance brake fluid approved by
Vauxhall.
When topping up, ensure maximum
cleanliness as contamination of the brake
fluid can lead to function problems in the
braking system.
After correcting the brake fluid level, have
the cause of brake fluid loss remedied. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
Brake fluid change
Brake fluid is hygroscopic, i.e. it absorbs
water. If the brakes become hot, such as
when driving on long downhill stretches,
vapour bubbles can occur in the water,
which can have an extremely adverse
effect on braking power (depending on the
proportion of water).
The fluid change intervals specified in the
Service Booklet must therefore be
observed.
9 Warning
Caution – brake fluid is poisonous and
corrosive. Do not allow it to come into
contact with eyes, skin, fabric or painted
surfaces. Direct contact could cause
injury and damage.
9 Warning
We recommend that you have brake fluid
changed by a Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer, who will be familiar with the
requirements of the law as regards
disposal of brake fluid and can thus help
to protect the environment and your
health.
303Maintenance, Inspection System
Windscreen wiper
Clear vision is essential for safe driving.
Perform regular checks on the windscreen
wiper and headlight wash system 3 to
ensure they are operating correctly. We
recommend wiper blade replacement at
least once a year.
If the windscreen is dirty, operate the
windscreen wash system before switching
on the windscreen wiper or setting the
wiper to automatic operation with the rain
sensor 3. This will avoid wiper blade wear.
Do not switch on the windscreen wiper or
set them to automatic operation with the
rain sensor 3 if the windscreen is iced up as
this could damage the wiper blades or the
wiper system.
If the wiper becomes frozen on to the glass,
we recommend that they be released with
the aid of VauxhallDe-icer Spray.
Smearing wiper blades can be cleaned with
a soft cloth and Vauxhall Windscreen
Wash Solvent.
Wiper blades whose lips have become
hardened, cracked or covered with silicone
must be replaced. This may be necessary
as a result of the effects of ice, thawing salt
or heat, or the incorrect use of cleaning
agents.
Switch off the windscreen wiper or
automatic wiper with rain sensor 3 in car
washes – pages 17, 18, 309.
Windscreen wiper care – page 310.
To ensure proper operation of the rain
sensor 3 the sensor area must be free from
dust, dirt and ice, which is why the
windscreen wash system must be operated
at regular intervals and the sensor area de-
iced. Vehicles with rain sensor 3 can be
identified by the sensor area near the top
of the windscreen.
304 Maintenance, Inspection System
Service setting for front windscreen wiper
(e.g. for changing or cleaning the front
wiper blades).
Within 4 seconds from turning off the
ignition, with the key still in the lock 3 or for
the Open&Start System after switching off
the ignition and before opening the driver’s
door, press the wiper stalk down. Release
wiper stalk as soon as the wiper is vertical.
Wiper blades on the windscreen
Activate service setting - see previous
column. Raise wiper arm, tilt wiper blade at
a 90° to the wiper arm and remove to the
side.
Wiper blade on the rear window 3
Lift wiper arm. Disengage wiper blade as
shown in illustration and remove.
305Maintenance, Inspection System
Windscreen and headlight
wash systems 3
The fluid reservoir filler neck for the
windscreen wash system and headlight
wash system 3 is located at the front next
to the left headlight.
Capacities – pages 343, 343.
Fill only with clean water to prevent the
nozzles from clogging. To improve
cleaning efficiency, we recommend that
you add a little Vauxhall Windscreen Wash
Solvent.
The windscreen wash system and
headlight wash system will not freeze in
winter:
When closing the reservoir, press the lid
firmly over the beaded edge all the way
round.
Frost protection
down to
Mixture
Vauxhall
Windscreen Wash
Solvent: Water
– 5 °C 1 : 3
– 10 °C 1 : 2
– 20 °C 1 : 1
– 30 °C 2 : 1
306 Maintenance, Inspection System
Battery
The battery is maintenance-free.
Retrofitted electrical or electronic
accessories can place an additional load
on the battery or even discharge the
battery. We recommend that you consult a
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer regarding
technical possibilities, such as fitting a
more powerful battery.
Laying up the vehicle for more than 4
weeks can lead to battery discharge, which
may reduce the service life of the battery.
Disconnect battery from on-board power
supply by detaching negative terminal
(anti-theft alarm system 3 is then
disabled).
Ensure that ignition is switched off before
connecting battery. Then perform the
following actions:
z Setting date and time in the information
display – pages 48, 51, 56.
z If necessary activate the windows 3 and
sun roof 3 – pages 145, 146.
In order to prevent the battery from
discharging, some consumers such as the
courtesy light automatically switch off
after approx. 20 minutes.
Protecting electronic components
In order to prevent faults in electronic
components in the electrical system, never
connect or disconnect battery with engine
running or ignition switched on. Never start
engine with battery disconnected, e.g.
when starting using jump leads.
To avoid damaging the vehicle, do not
make any modifications to the electrical
system, e. g. connecting additional
consumers or tampering with electronic
control units (chip tuning).
Disconnecting/connecting the battery
from/to the electrical system
Disconnect the battery from the vehicle
electrical system before charging: First
detach the negative and then the positive
lead. Do not reverse the polarity of the
battery, i.e. do not confuse the terminals
for the positive and negative leads. When
connecting, start with the positive lead and
then connect the negative lead.
9 Warning
We recommend that you have battery
changes carried out by a Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer. They knows the laws
concerning the disposal of used batteries
and therefore protects the environment
and your health.
9 Warning
Electronic ignition systems generate very
high voltages. Do not touch the ignition
system; high voltage can be fatal.
307Maintenance, Inspection System
Vehicle decommissioning
Observe national regulations.
If the vehicle is decommissioned for several
months, the following work must be carried
out in order to prevent damage. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
z Wash and preserve the vehicle
– page 309.
z Check corrosion protection in engine
compartment and on underbody and
repair if necessary.
z Clean and wax the rubber seals of the
bonnet, doors and roof. Intermediate
position of the Astra TwinTop roof for
cleaning – page 151.
z Change engine oil – page 299.
z Check antifreeze and corrosion
protection – page 300.
z Check the coolant level, top up with
antifreeze if necessary – page 301.
z Empty windscreen wash system and
headlight wash system.
z Increase tyre pressure to value specified
for full load – page 334.
Vehicle storage
z Park vehicle in dry, well ventilated place.
With manual transmission or
Easytronic 3, engage 1st or reverse
gear. With automatic transmission 3 ,
selector lever in P. Use chocks or the like
to prevent the vehicle from rolling.
z Do not apply hand brake.
z Disconnect battery by disengaging
negative terminal from vehicle electrical
system – page 306.
Vehicle recommissioning
Observe national regulations.
Perform the following work before
recommissioning the vehicle:
z Connect battery – see page 306.
z Check tyre pressure and correct if
necessary – page 334.
z Fill up windscreen wash system
– page 305.
z Check engine oil level – page 298.
z Check the coolant level; top up with
antifreeze if necessary – page 301.
z Fit the number plate if necessary.
308 Vehicle care
Vehicle care
Obtain advice from a Vauxhall Authorised
Repairer regarding cleaning materials that
have been tested and recommended by
Vauxhall.
When caring for your vehicle, observe all
national environmental regulations,
particularly when washing it.
Regular, thorough care helps to improve
the appearance of your vehicle and
maintain its value over the years. It is also
prerequisite for warranty claims for any
paint or corrosion damage. The following
pages contain tips for vehicle care which, if
used properly, will help combat the
unavoidable, damaging effects of the
environment.
Vehicle care aids 3
Vehicle wash:
z Wash brush
z Shampoo
z Sponge
z Insect Removal Sponge
z Chamois
Vehicle care:
z Paintwork Cleaner
z Paintwork Polish
z Cream Polish
z Metallic Paintwork Wax
z Hard wax
z VauxhallTouch-Up Paint
z VauxhallTouch-Up/Aerosol Paint
z Wheel Preserver
z Insect Remover
z Window Cleaner,
z Vauxhall Windscreen Wash Solvent
z Silicone Oil for Rubber Seals,
z Cleaner
Vehicle care aids 3.............................. 308
Washing ............................................... 309
Waxing ................................................. 309
Polishing ............................................... 309
Wheels .................................................. 309
Paintwork damage.............................. 310
Exterior lights ....................................... 310
Plastic and rubber parts ..................... 310
Wheels and tyres ................................. 310
Interior and upholstery........................ 310
Seat belts.............................................. 310
Windows............................................... 310
Windscreen wiper blades.................... 310
Locks..................................................... 311
Engine compartment........................... 311
Underbody ........................................... 311
Astra TwinTop ..................................... 311
309Vehicle care
Washing
The paintwork of your vehicle is exposed to
environmental influences, e.g. continuous
changes in weather conditions, industrial
waste gases and dust or thawing salts, so
wash and wax your vehicle regularly. When
using automatic car washes, select a
programme which includes waxing.
Bird droppings, dead insects, resin, pollen
and the like should be cleaned off
immediately, as they contain aggressive
constituents which can cause paint
damage.
If using a car wash, comply with the
pertinent instructions of the car wash
manufacturer. The windscreen wiper and
rear window wiper must be switched off
– pages 17, 18. Remove antenna 3 and
roof rack 3. Stand on the door sill to reach
them more easily.
If you wash your vehicle by hand, make
sure that the insides of the wings are also
thoroughly rinsed out.
Clean edges and folds on opened doors
and flaps as well as the areas they cover.
Thoroughly rinse off and leather-off the
vehicle. Rinse leather frequently. Use
separate leathers for paint and window
surfaces: remnants of wax on the windows
will impair vision.
Observe national regulations.
Waxing
Wax your vehicle regularly, in particular
after it has been washed using shampoo
and at the latest when water no longer
forms beads on the paintwork, otherwise
the paintwork will dry out.
Also wax edges and folds on opened doors
and flaps as well as the areas they cover.
Sun roof 3
Never clean with solvents or abrasive
agents, fuels, aggressive media (e.g. paint
cleaner, acetone-containing solutions etc.),
acidic or highly alkaline media or abrasive
pads.
No stickers may be applied to the sun roof.
Polishing
Polishing is necessary only if the paint has
become dull or if solid deposits have
become attached to it.
Paintwork polish with silicone forms a
protective film, making waxing
unnecessary.
Plastic body parts should not be treated
with wax and polish.
Use Metallic Paintwork Wax on vehicles
with a metallic-effect paint finish.
Wheels
Use a pH-neutral wheel cleaning agent to
clean the wheels.
Wheels are painted and can be treated
with the same agents as the body. For alloy
wheels we recommend use of Alloy Wheel
Preserver.
310 Vehicle care
Paintwork damage
Repair small areas of paint damage such
as stone impacts, scratches etc.
immediately using a Vauxhalltouch-up
applicator or Vauxhall spray and touch-up
paint before rust can form. If rust has
already formed, have the cause remedied.
We recommend that you consult your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer. Please also
pay attention to surfaces and edges
beneath the vehicle where which rust may
have formed unnoticed for some time.
Exterior lights
Headlight and other protective light bezels
are made of plastic. If they require
additional cleaning after the vehicle has
been washed, clean them with Car
Shampoo. Do not use any abrasive or
caustic agents, do not use an ice scraper,
and do not clean them dry.
Plastic and rubber parts
For additional cleaning of plastic and
rubber parts use Cleaner. Do not use any
other agent, and in particular do not use
solvents or petrol.
Do not use high-pressure jet cleaners.
Wheels and tyres
Do not use high-pressure jet cleaners.
Interior and upholstery
Clean the vehicle interior, including the
instrument panel fascia, using interior
cleaner.
The instrument panel should only be
cleaned using a soft damp cloth.
Clean fabric upholstery with a vacuum
cleaner and brush. To remove stains, use
cleaner that is suitable for both fabrics and
vinyl.
Do not use cleaning agents such as
acetone, tetrachloride, paint thinner, pint
remover, nail varnish remover, washing
powder or bleach. petrol is also unsuitable.
Open Velcro fasteners on clothing could
damage seat upholstery. Make sure Velcro
fasteners are closed.
Seat belts
Always keep seat belts clean and dry.
Clean only with lukewarm water or Cleaner.
Windows
When cleaning the heated rear window,
make sure that the heating element on the
inside of the window is not damaged.
Use a soft lint-free cloth or chamois leather
in conjunction with Window Cleaner and
Insect Remover.
Vauxhall Windscreen Wash Solvent is
suitable for de-icing windows.
For mechanical removal of ice, use a
commercially available sharp-edged ice
scraper. Press the scraper firmly against
the glass so that no dirt can get under it
and scratch the glass.
Windscreen wiper blades
Wax, such as that used in car washes, can
cause streaks to form on the windscreen
when the wiper is used.
311Vehicle care
Smearing wiper blades can be cleaned with
a soft cloth and Vauxhall Windscreen
Wash Solvent, and replaced if necessary
– page 303.
Locks
The locks are lubricated with a high-grade
lock cylinder grease at the factory.
Vauxhall lock cylinder grease prevents the
locks from freezing up. Only use de-icing
agent in emergencies, as they have a
degreasing effect and will impair the
function of the locks. After using a de-icing
agent, have the locks re-greased. We
recommend that you entrust this to your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
Engine compartment
Areas of the engine compartment that are
painted in the same colour as the vehicle
must be looked after like any other painted
surface.
It is advisable to wash the engine
compartment before and after winter and
preserve it with wax. Cover alternator and
brake fluid reservoir with plastic sheets
before washing the engine.
When washing the engine with a steam-jet
cleaner, do not direct the steam jet at
components of the anti-lock brake system,
the air conditioning system, the climate
control system or the belt drive and its
components.
Protective wax that has been applied is
also removed during the engine wash. For
this reason, have the engine, brake system
components in the engine compartment,
axle components with steering, body parts
and cavities thoroughly preserved with
protective wax after the wash. We
recommend that you consult your Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer.
An engine wash can be performed in the
spring in order to remove dirt that has
adhered to the engine compartment,
which may also have a high salt content.
Check protective wax layer and make good
if necessary.
Do not use high-pressure jet cleaners.
Underbody
Your vehicle has a factory-applied PVC
undercoating in the wheel arches
(including the longitudinal members) which
provides permanent protection and needs
no special maintenance. The surfaces of
the vehicle underbody not covered by PVC
are provided with a durable protective wax
coating in critical areas.
On vehicles which are washed frequently in
automatic car washes with underbody
washing facility, the protective wax
coating may be impaired by dirt-dissolving
additives.
Check the underbody after washing and
have it waxed if necessary. Before the start
of the cold weather season, check the PVC
coating and protective wax coating. Have
them restored to perfect condition if
necessary.
Caution - commercially available bitumen/
rubber materials can damage the PVC
coating. We recommend that you have
underbody work carried out by a Vauxhall
Authorised Repairer, who knows the
prescribed materials and has experience in
the use thereof.
The underbody should be washed
following the end of the cold weather
season to remove any dirt adhering to the
underbody since this may also contain salt.
Check protective wax coating and, if
necessary, have it restored to perfect
condition.
Astra TwinTop
Treat all seals, e. g. on the roof and
windscreen frame, with silicone oil from
time to time. Good contact between the
fine rubber lips and the sealing surfaces
prevents leaks and reduces clamping
forces.
Intermediate roof position for cleaning -
see page 151.
Do not use high-pressure jet cleaners.
312 Technical Data
Technical Data
Vehicle documents, identification
plate
The technical data is determined in
accordance with European Community
standards. We reserve the right to make
modifications. Specifications in the vehicle
documents always have priority over those
given in this manual.
The identification plate is affixed to the
front right door frame.
Information on identification plate:
1 Manufacturer
2 Type approval number
3 Vehicle identification number
4 Permissible gross vehicle weight
5 Permissible gross train weight
6 Maximum permissible front axle load
7 Maximum permissible rear axle load
8 Vehicle-specific or
country-specific data
Vehicle documents, identification
plate................................................... 312
Vehicle identification data.................. 313
Coolant, brake fluid, oils ..................... 313
Engine data.......................................... 314
Performance......................................... 316
Fuel consumption, CO
2
emissions ......
319
Weights, payload and roof load ........ 324
Tyres ..................................................... 333
Electrical system .................................. 342
Capacities ............................................ 343
Dimensions........................................... 344
Installation dimensions of trailer
towing equipment............................. 345
313Technical Data
Vehicle identification data
The vehicle identification number is
stamped on the identification plate (see
previous page) and in the vehicle floor on
the right-hand side under a cover between
the driver’s door and seat.
The vehicle identification number may be
embossed on the instrument panel.
Engine code and engine number: stamped
on left-hand side of engine on crankcase.
Coolant, brake fluid, oils
When topping up
coolant,
brake fluid,
manual transmission oil,
automatic transmission oil,
power steering oil
we recommend that you consult your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer, who can
advise you on the correct products to use.
Use of unsuitable fluids can cause serious
damage to the vehicle.
Engine oils
Information on engine oils is found in the
Service Booklet.
314 Technical Data
Engine data
Sales designation
Engine identifier code
1.4
Z 14 XEP
1.6
Z 16 XEP
1.8
Z 18 XE
1.8
Z 18 XER
2.0 Turbo
Z 20 LEL
Number of cylinders44444
Piston displacement (cm
3
) 1364 1598 1796 1796 1998
Brake horse power (kW/bhp)
at rpm
66
5600
77
6000
92
5600
103
6300
125
5200
Torque (Nm)
at rpm
125
4000
150
3900
170
3800
175
1)
3800
1)
For versions with automatic transmission 170 Nm.
250
1950
Type of fuel Petrol Petrol Petrol Petrol Petrol
Octane requirement (RON)
2)
unleaded
or unleaded
or unleaded
2)
Standard high-quality fuels, e.g. unleaded DIN EN 228; value printed in bold: recommended fuel.
95
3)
98
3)
91
3)4)
3)
Knock control system automatically adjusts ignition timing according to type of fuel used (octane number).
95
3)
98
3)
91
3)4)
4)
Use of 91 RON fuel reduces power and torque.
95
3)
98
3)
91
3)
95
3)
98
3)
91
3)
95
3)
98
3)
91
3)5)
5)
If no unleaded Premium fuel is available, 91 RON can be used to avoid high engine load or full load as well as for driving in mountainous terrain with
a caravan/trailer load or high payload.
Max. permissible engine speed,
continuous operation (rpm)
approx.
6200 6400 6800 6800 6400
Oil consumption (l/1000 km) 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6
315Technical Data
Engine data
Sales designation
Engine identifier code
2.0 Turbo
Z 20 LER
VXR
Z 20 LEH
1.3 CDTI
Z 13 DTH
1.7 CDTI
Z 17 DTH
1.9 CDTI
Z 19 DTL
1.9 CDTI
Z 19 DT
1.9 CDTI
Z 19 DTH
Number of cylinders 4 4 4 4 4 4 4
Piston displacement (cm
3
) 1998 1998 1248 1686 1910 1910 1910
Brake horse power (kW/bhp)
at rpm
147
5400
177
5600
66
4000
74
4400
74
3500
88
3500
110
4000
Torque (Nm)
at rpm
262
4200
320
2400 to 5000
200
1750 to 2500
240
2300
260
1700 to 2500
280
2000 to 2750
320
2000 to 2750
Type of fuel Petrol Petrol Diesel Diesel Diesel Diesel Diesel
Octane requirement (RON)
1)
unleaded
or unleaded
or unleaded
Cetane requirement (CN)
1)
1)
Standard high-quality fuels, e.g. unleaded DIN EN 228, Diesel DIN EN 590; D = Diesel; value printed in bold: recommended fuel.
95
2)
98
2)
91
2)3)
95
2)3)
98
2)
91
2)4)
2)
Knock control system automatically adjusts ignition timing according to type of fuel used (octane number).
3)
Use of 95 RON fuel reduces power and torque. Slight increase in fuel consumption.
4)
If no unleaded Premium fuel is available, 91 RON can be used to avoid high engine load or full load as well as for driving in mountainous terrain with
a caravan/trailer load or high payload.
49 (D)
5)
5)
A lower value is possible with winter diesel fuels.
49 (D)
5)
49 (D)
5)
49 (D)
5)
49 (D)
5)
Max. permissible engine
speed,
continuous operation (rpm)
approx.
6400 6400 5100 to 5300 5200 5200 5200 5200
Oil consumption (l/1000 km) 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6
316 Technical Data
Performance
(approx. mph / km/h), 5-door Hatchback
Engine
1)
1)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 18 XER Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER
Maximum speed
2)
Manual transmission
Easytronic
Automatic transmission
2)
The maximum speed indicated is achievable at kerb weight (without driver) plus 200 kg payload. Optional equipment could reduce the specified
maximum speed of the vehicle.
111/178
110/176
115/185
115/185
123/198
117/188
129/208
117/188
135/217
143/230
Engine
1)
Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Maximum speed
2)
Manual transmission
Easytronic
Automatic transmission
107/172
107/172
112/180
112/180
121/194
117/188
129/208
317Technical Data
Performance
(approx. mph / km/h), 3-door Hatchback
Engine
1)
1)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 18 XER Z 20 LEL
Maximum speed
2)
Manual transmission
Easytronic
Automatic transmission
2)
The maximum speed indicated is achievable at kerb weight (without driver) plus 200 kg payload. Optional equipment could reduce the specified
maximum speed of the vehicle.
112/180
111/178
116/187
187
124/200
118/190
130/210
118/190
137/220
Engine
1)
Z 20 LER Z 20 LEH Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Maximum speed
2)
Manual transmission
Easytronic
Automatic transmission
145/234
152/244
108/174
108/174
113/182
113/182
122/196
118/190
130/210
Performance
(approx. mph / km/h), Van
Engine
1)
Z 14 XEP Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Maximum speed
2)
Manual transmission
Easytronic
Automatic transmission
111/178
107/172
112/180
112/180
120/193
116/187
129/207
318 Technical Data
Performance
(approx. mph / km/h), Estate
Engine
1)
1)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 18 XER Z 20 LEL
Maximum speed
2)
Manual transmission
Easytronic
Automatic transmission
2)
The maximum speed indicated is achievable at kerb weight (without driver) plus 200 kg payload. Optional equipment could reduce the specified
maximum speed of the vehicle.
111/178
115/185
115/185
123/198
115/188
128/207
115/188
135/217
Engine
1)
Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Maximum speed
2)
Manual transmission
Easytronic
Automatic transmission
107/172
107/172
112/180
112/180
120/193
116/187
129/207
Performance
(approx. mph / km/h), TwinTop
Engine
Z 16 XEP Z 18 XER Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Z 19 DTH
Maximum speed
2)
Manual transmission
Easytronic
Automatic transmission
116/186 129/209
139/224
147/237
132/213
319Technical Data
Fuel consumption,
CO
2
emissions
Directive 80/1268/EEC (last changed by
1999/100/EC) has applied for the
measurement of fuel consumption since
1996.
The directive is oriented to actual driving
practices: Urban driving is rated at approx.
1
/
3
and off-road driving with approx.
2
/
3
(urban and extra-urban consumption).
Cold starts and acceleration phases are
also taken into consideration.
The specification of CO
2
emission is also a
constituent of the directive.
The figures given must not be taken as a
guarantee for the actual fuel consumption
of a particular vehicle.
All values are based on the EU base model
with standard equipment.
The calculation of fuel consumption as
specified by directive 1999/100/EC takes
account of the vehicle’s kerb weight,
ascertained in accordance with these
regulations. Optional extras may result in
slightly higher fuel consumption and CO
2
emission levels than those quoted.
To convert l/100 km into mpg, divide 282
by number of litres/100 km.
Saving fuel, protecting the environment
– page 202.
320 Technical Data
Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km) , CO
2
emissions (approx. g/km), Hatch 5-door (tyre width up to 205 mm
1)
)
1)
For Z 17 DTH engine - tyre width up to 195 mm.
Engine
2)
2)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 18 XER
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
8,2/ 7,7/–
5,2/ 4,9/–
6,3/ 5,9/–
151/142/–
8,6/ 8,5/
5,4/ 5,3/–
6,6/ 6,5/–
158/156/–
10,4/–/11,4
6,1/–/ 6,3
7,7/–/ 8,2
185/–/197
9,9/–/10,5
5,8/–/6,2
7,3/–/7,8
175/–/187
Engine
2)
Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
6,2/
3)
/–
4,0/
3)
/ –
4,8/
3)
/–
130/
3)
/–
3)
Values not available at time of printing.
6.4/–/–
4.2/–/–
5.0/–/–
135/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km), CO
2
emissions (approx. g/km), Hatch 5-door (tyre width up to 225 mm)
Engine
2)
Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 18 XER
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
8,4/ 7,9/–
5,4/ 5,1/–
6,5/ 6,1/–
156/146/–
8.8/ 8.7/
5.6/ 5.5/–
6.8/ 6.7/–
163/161/–
10,6/–/11,6
6,3/–/ 6,5
7,9/–/ 8,4
190/–/ 202
10,1/–/10,7
6,0/–/ 6,4
7,5/–/ 8,0
180/–/192
Engine
2)
Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
12.8/–/–
6.8/–/–
9.0/–/–
216/–/–
13.1/–/–
7.1/–/–
9.3/–/–
223/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
6.5/–/–
4.3/–/–
5.1/–/–
138/–/–
7,7/–/–
5,0/–/–
6,0/–/–
162/–/–
7,7/–/ 9,8
5,0/–/ 5,5
6,0/–/ 7,1
162/–/192
7.4/–/–
4.9/–/–
5.8/–/–
157/–/–
321Technical Data
Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km) , CO
2
emissions (approx. g/km), Hatch 3-door (tyre width up to 205 mm
1)
)
1)
For Z 17 DTH engine - tyre width up to 195 mm.
Engine
2)
2)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 18 XER Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Z 20 LEH
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
8,2/ 7,7/
5,2/ 4,9/–
6,3/ 5,9/–
151/142/–
8,6/ 8,5/–
5,4/ 5,3/–
6,6/ 6,5/–
158/156/–
10,4/–/11,3
6,1/–/ 6,2
7,7/–/ 8,1
185/–/194
9,9/–/10,4
5,8/–/ 6,1
7,3/–/ 7,7
175/–/185
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
Engine
2)
Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Manual /Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
6,2/
3)
/–
4,0/
3)
/ –
4,8/
3)
/–
130/
3)
/–
3)
Values not available at time of printing.
6.4/–/–
4.2/–/–
5.0/–/–
135/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km),CO
2
emissions (approx. g/km), Hatch 3-door (tyre width up to 225 mm
4)
)
4)
For Z 20 LEH engine - tyre width up to 235 mm.
Engine
2)
Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 18 XER Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Z 20 LEH
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
8,4/ 7,9/–
5,4/ 5,1/–
6,5/ 6,1/–
156/146/–
8.8/ 8.7/–
5.6/ 5.5/–
6.8/ 6.7/–
163/161/–
10,6/–/11,5
6,3/–/ 6,4
7,9/–/ 8,3
190/–/199
10,1/–/10,6
6,0/–/ 6,3
7,5/–/ 7,9
180/–/190
12.8/–/–
6.8/–/–
9.0/–/–
216/–/–
13.1/–/–
7.1/–/–
9.3/–/–
223/–/–
13,0/–/–
7,0/–/–
9,2/–/–
221/–/–
Engine
2)
Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
6.5/–/–
4.3/–/–
5.1/–/–
138/–/–
7,7/–/–
5,0/–/–
6,0/–/–
162/–/–
7,7/–/ 9,7
5,0/–/ 5,4
6,0/–/ 7,0
162/–/189
7.4/–/–
4.9/–/–
5.8/–/–
157/–/–
322 Technical Data
Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km) , CO
2
emissions (approx. g/km), Estate (tyre width up to 205 mm
1)
)
1)
For Z 17 DTH engine - tyre width up to 195 mm.
Engine
2)
2)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 18 XER Z 20 LEL
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
8,2/–/–
5,2/–/–
6,3/–/–
151/–/–
8,7/ 8,6/
5,5/ 5,4/–
6,7/ 6,6/–
161/158/–
10,5/–/11,4
6,2/–/ 6,3
7,8/–/ 8,2
187/–/197
10,0/–/10,5
5,9/–/ 6,2
7,4/–/ 7,8
178/–/187
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
Engine
2)
Z 20 LER Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
6,2/
3)
/–
4,0/
3)
/ –
4,8/
3)
/–
130/
3)
/–
3)
Values not available at time of printing.
6.4/–/–
4.2/–/–
5.0/–/–
135/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km),CO
2
emissions (approx. g/km), Estate (tyre width up to 225 mm)
Engine
2)
Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 18 XER Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
8.4/–/–
5.4/–/–
6.5/–/–
156/–/–
8.9/ 8.8/
5.7/ 5.6/–
6.9/ 6.8/–
166/163/–
10,7/–/11,6
6,4/–/ 6,5
8,0/–/ 8,4
192/–/202
10,2/–/10,7
6,1/–/ 6,4
7,6/–/ 8,0
182/–/192
12.9/–/–
6.9/–/–
9.1/–/–
218/–/–
13.2/–/–
7.2/–/–
9.4/–/–
226/–/–
Engine
2)
Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
6.5/–/–
4.3/–/–
5.1/–/–
138/–/–
7,8/–/–
5,1/–/–
6,1/–/–
165/–/–
7,8/–/ 9,8
5,1/–/ 5,5
6,1/–/ 7,1
165/–/192
7.5/–/–
5.0/–/–
5.9/–/–
159/–/–
323Technical Data
Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km) , CO
2
emissions (approx. g/km) , TwinTop (tyre width up to 225 mm)
Engine
1)
Z 16 XEP Z 18 XER Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER Z 19 DTH
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
9,1/–/–
5,8/–/–
7,0/–/–
168/–/–
10,3/–/
2)
6,2/–/
2)
7,7/–/
2)
185/–/
2)
13,0/–/–
7,0/–/–
9,2/–/–
221/–/–
13,3/–/–
7,3/–/–
9,5/–/–
228/–/–
7,7/–/–
5,2/–/–
6,1/–/–
165/–/–
Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km) , CO
2
emissions (approx. g/km), Van (tyre width up to 205 mm)
Engine
1)
Z 14 XEP Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
8,0/–/–
5,0/–/–
6,1/–/–
146/–/–
6.2/–/–
4.0/–/–
4.8/–/–
130/–/–
6.4/–/–
4.2/–/–
5.0/–/–
135/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
Fuel consumption (approx. l/100 km) , CO
2
emissions (approx. g/km) , Van (tyre width up to 225 mm)
Engine
1)
Z 14 XEP Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Manual/Easytronic/Automatic transmission
urban
extra-urban
total
CO
2
8,2/–/–
5,2/–/–
6,3/–/–
151/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
–/–/–
6.5/–/–
4.3/–/–
5.1/–/–
138/–/–
7,4/–/–
4,9/–/–
5,8/–/–
157/–/–
7,4/–/ 9,7
4,9/–/ 5,4
5,8/–/ 7,0
157/–/189
7.4/–/–
4.9/–/–
5.8/–/–
157/–/–
1)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
2)
Values not available at time of printing.
324 Technical Data
Weights, payload and roof load
The payload is the difference between the
permitted gross vehicle weight (see
identification plate, page 312) and the EC
kerb weight.
To calculate the kerb weight, enter the
data for your vehicle below:
z Kerb weight from
Table 1,
page 325 + .............. kg
z Additional weight of
equipment versions from
Table 2, page 330 + .............. kg
z Weight of heavy
accessories from Table 3,
page 332 + .............. kg
The total = .............. kg
is the EC kerb weight.
Optional equipment and accessories
increase the kerb weight, which means that
the payload will also change slightly.
Note the weights given in the vehicle
documents.
The combined total of front and rear axle
loads must not exceed the permissible
gross vehicle weight. For example, if the
front axle is bearing its maximum
permissible load, the rear axle can only
bear a load that is equal to the gross
vehicle weight minus the front axle load.
With a connected trailer and full load on
the towing vehicle including all passengers,
in the hatch the maximum permitted rear
axle load (see rating plate or vehicle
documents) may be exceeded by 65 kg (5-
door) or 70 kg (3-door), and the maximum
gross vehicle weight by 45 kg. In the Estate,
the maximum permitted rear axle load
may be exceeded by 60 kg and the
maximum gross vehicle weight by 30 kg. If
the maximum permitted rear axle load is
exceeded, a top speed of 100 km/h applies.
If lower top speeds are stipulated
nationally when towing a trailer these must
be observed.
See the identification plate or vehicle
documents for permissible axle loads.
Roof load
The permissible roof load is 75 kg and
100 kg for caravan with roof railing. The
roof load is the combined weight of the
roof rack and the load.
Roof loads are not permitted on the Astra
TwinTop.
Driving hints – page 200. Roof racks,
caravan and trailer towing – page 238.
325Technical Data
Weight (kg), Table 1, kerb weight
1)
, Hatch 5-door
1)
According to EC Directive, including assumed weights for driver (68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (tank 90 % full).
Model Engine
2)
2)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic
transmission
Astra Z 14 XEP 1230 1230
Z 16 XEP 1265 1265
Z 18 XE, Z 18 XER 1278 1310
Z 13 DTH 1330
3)
3)
Values not available at time of printing.
Z 17 DTH 1365
Z 19 DT 1395 1425
Z 19 DTH 1393
Astra
with
air conditioning
system or
climate control
system
Z 14 XEP 1250 1250
Z 16 XEP 1285 1285
Z 18 XE, Z 18 XER 1298 1330
Z 20 LEL 1385
Z 20 LER 1385
Z 13 DTH 1345
3)
Z 17 DTH 1380
Z 19 DT 1410 1440
Z 19 DTH 1408
326 Technical Data
Weight (kg), Table 1, kerb weight
1)
, Hatch 3-door
1)
According to EC Directive, including assumed weights for driver (68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (tank 90 % full).
2)
Sales designation, see pages 314, 315.
3)
Values not available at time of printing.
Model Engine
2)
Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic
transmission
Astra
Z 14 XEP 1210
Z 16 XEP 1245 1245
Z 18 XE, Z 18 XER 1265 1278
Z 13 DTH 1310
3)
Z 17 DTH 1345
Z 19 DT, Z 19 DTL 1370 1393
Z 19 DTH 1390
Astra
with
air conditioning
system or
climate control
system
Z 14 XEP 1230
Z 16 XEP 1265 1265
Z 18 XE, Z 18 XER 1285 1298
Z 20 LEL 1365
Z 20 LER 1365
Z 20 LEH 1393
Z 13 DTH 1325
3)
Z 17 DTH 1360
Z 19 DT, Z 19 DTL 1385 1408
Z 19 DTH 1405
327Technical Data
Weights (kg) : Table 1, Kerb weight
1)
, Estate
1)
According to EC Directive, including assumed weights for driver (68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (tank 90 % full).
2)
Sales designation, see pages 314, 315.
3)
Values not available at time of printing.
Model Engine
2)
Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic
transmission
Astra
Z 14 XEP 1280
Z 16 XEP 1315 1315
Z 18 XE, Z 18 XER 1325 1350
Z 13 DTH 1380
3)
Z 17 DTH 1393
Z 19 DT 1435 1465
Z 19 DTH 1450
Astra
with
air conditioning
system or
climate control
system
Z 14 XEP 1300
Z 16 XEP 1335 1335
Z 18 XE, Z 18 XER 1345 1370
Z 20 LEL 1425
Z 20 LER 1425
Z 13 DTH 1395
3)
Z 17 DTH 1408
Z 19 DT 1450 1480
Z 19 DTH 1465
328 Technical Data
Weights (kg) : Table 1, Kerb weight
1)
, Van
1)
According to EC Directive, including assumed weights for driver (68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (tank 90 % full).
2)
Sales designation, see pages 314, 315.
Model Engine
2)
Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic
transmission
Astra
Z 14 XEP 1235
Z 13 DTH 1335
Z 17 DTH 1365
Z 19 DT 1385 1420
Z 19 DTL 1385
Z 19 DTH 1395
Astra
with
air conditioning
system or
climate control
system
Z 14 XEP 1250
Z 13 DTH 1350
Z 17 DTH 1380
Z 19 DT 1400 1435
Z 19 DTL 1400
Z 19 DTH 1410
329Technical Data
Weights (kg) : Table 1, Kerb weight
1)
, TwinTop
1)
According to EC Directive, including assumed weights for driver (68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (tank 90 % full).
2)
Sales designation, see pages 314, 315.
Model Engine
2)
Manual transmission Easytronic Automatic
transmission
Astra
Z 16 XEP 1495
Z 18 XER 1500
Z 19 DTH 1613
Astra
with
air conditioning
system or
climate control
system
Z 16 XEP 1515
Z 18 XER 1520
Z 20 LEL 1605
Z 20 LER 1605
Z 19 DTH 1628
330 Technical Data
Weights (kg), Table 2, Additional weight of equipment versions
Hatch
Engine
1)
1)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
Z 14 XEL Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 18 XER Z 20 LEL
Club 2.92.92.92.92.9
Design 12 12 12 12 12 12
SXi, SRi 24.5 24.5 24.5 24.5 24.5 12.6
Engine
1)
Z 20 LER Z 20 LEH
Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Club 2.9 2.9 2.9 2.9 2.9
Design 12 12 12 12 12
SXi, SRi 12.6 24.5 24.5 12.6 12.6 12.6
331Technical Data
Weights (kg) : Table 2, Additional weight of equipment versions
Estate
Engine
1)
1)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
Z 14 XEL Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 18 XER Z 20 LEL
Club 2.9 2.9 2.9 2.9 2.9 2.9
Design 12 12 12 12 12 12
SXi, SRi 24.5 24.5 24.5 24.5 24.5 12.6
Engine
1)
Z 20 LER Z 13 DTH
Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Club 2.9 2.9 2.9 2.9 2.9
Design 1212121212
SXi, SRi 12.6 24.5 24.5 12.6 12.6 24.5
Weights (kg), Table 2, Additional weight of equipment versions
Van
Engine
1)
Z 14 XEP Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Club ––––
Design ––––
SXi, SRi 24.5 24.5 24.5 12.6 12.6 24.5
332 Technical Data
Weights (kg), Table 3, Heavy accessories
Accessories Sun roof Towing equipment Split rear seat bench
Weight 25 (Hatch 5-door, Estate)
23 (Hatch 3-door)
22 (Hatch 5-door, Estate)
20 (Hatch 3-door)
21 (Van)
10 (Hatch 5-door)
20 (Estate)
9 (Hatch 3-door)
333Technical Data
Tyres
Not all tyres available on the market
currently meet the structural requirements.
We recommend that you consult a
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer concerning
suitable tyre makes.
These tyres have undergone special tests
to establish their reliability, safety and
specific suitability for Vauxhallvehicles.
Despite continuous market monitoring, we
are unable to assess these attributes for
other tyres, even if they have been granted
approval by the relevant authorities or in
some other form.
Further information – page 230.
Winter tyres 3
Tyres of size 215/45 R 17, 225/45 R 17, 225/
40 R 18 or 235/35 R 19 are not to be used
as winter tyres. Tyres of size 225/45 R 17
may be used as winter tyres on the Astra
TwinTop.
If you use winter tyres 3, the spare wheel
may still be fitted with a summer tyre. If you
use the spare wheel the vehicle’s handling
may be altered. Obtain a replacement for
the faulty tyre as soon as possible, and
have the wheel balanced and fitted to the
vehicle.
Further information – page 236.
Tyre chains 3
Tyre chains may be used on the front
wheels only.
We recommend the use of Vauxhall-tested
fine-mesh tyre chains that add no more
than 10 mm to the tyre tread and the
inboard sides (including chain lock).
Tyre chains are not permitted on
temporary spare wheel 115/70 R 16 or on
tyres of size 225/45 R 17, 225/40 R 18 or
235/35 R 19. Tyre chains are permitted on
tyres of size 225/45 R 17 for the Astra
TwinTop.
Tyre chains are permitted on tyres size 215/
45 R 17 only if the vehicle is factory-fitted
with 18" wheels.
Further information – page 236.
Wheels
Wheel bolt tightening torque: 110 Nm.
Spare wheel 3
Depending on the version, the spare wheel
may take the form of a temporary spare
wheel 3 : vehicle driveability may be
altered by use of the spare wheel. Obtain a
replacement for the faulty tyre as soon as
possible, and have the wheel balanced
and fitted to the vehicle.
On vehicles with alloy wheels 3 the spare
wheel may have a steel rim.
The spare wheel may be fitted with a
smaller tyre
1)
and smaller wheel than the
wheels fitted to the vehicle.
Tyre pressure in bar / psi
2)
The specified tyre pressures are valid for
cold tyres. The increased tyre pressure
resulting from extensive driving must not
be reduced. The tyre pressures specified on
the following pages apply to both summer
and winter tyres.
Always inflate the spare wheel 3 to the tyre
pressure for full load - see tables on
following pages.
Temporary spare wheel 3 tyre pressure -
see tables on next page.
In vehicles with tyre pressure monitoring
system 3 there is an adapter in the valve
cap key. Screw adapter to valve before
attaching tyre pressure gauge – page 232.
Further information – pages 230 to 237.
1)
Country-specific version: The spare wheel is
only to be used as a temporary spare wheel.
2)
1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi.
334 Technical Data
(ctd.)
Tyre pressure in bar / psi
1)
1)
1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi.
Hatch Tyre pressure
for load of
up to 3 persons
Tyre pressure ECO
2)
loaded
up to 3 people
Tyre pressure
for full load
Engine
3)
Tyres – Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear
Z 14 XEP,
Z 16 XEP,
Z 18 XE
185/65 R 15,
195/60 R 15
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.9/42
195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
1.9/28 1.9/28 2.4/35 2.4/35 2.0/29 2.5/36
215/45 R 17,
225/40 R 18
2.5/36 2.3/33 2.5/36 2.9/42
Z 18 XER 185/65 R 15,
195/60 R 15
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.9/42
195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
1.9/28 1.9/28 2.4/35 2.4/35 2.0/29 2.5/36
Z 20 LEL 195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.7/39 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42
215/45 R 17,
225/40 R 18
2.5/36 2.3/33 2.6/38 3.0/44
all T 115/70 R 16
(temporary
spare)
4)
4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61
2)
To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres.
3)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
4)
For notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 255.
335Technical Data
(ctd.)
Tyre pressure in bar / psi
1)
1)
1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi.
Hatch Tyre pressure
for load of
up to 3 persons
Tyre pressure ECO
2)
loaded
up to 3 people
Tyre pressure
for full load
Engine
3)
Tyres – Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear
Z 20 LER 195/65 R15,
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.7/39 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42
215/45 R 17,
225/40 R 18
2.6/38 2.4/35 2.7/39 3.1/45
Z 20 LEH 205/50 R 17,
225/40 R 18,
235/35 R 19,
225/45 R 17
4)
2.4/35 2.4/35 2.5/36 2.9/42
all T 115/70 R 16
(temporary spare)
5)
4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61
2)
To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres.
3)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
4)
To guarantee a correct speed display, the electronic speedometer must be reprogrammed.
5)
For notes on the temporary spare wheel, see page 255.
336 Technical Data
(ctd.)
Tyre pressure in bar / psi
1)
1)
1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi.
Hatch Tyre pressure
for load of
up to 3 persons
Tyre pressure ECO
2)
loaded
up to 3 people
Tyre pressure
for full load
Engine
3)
Tyres – Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear
Z 13 DTH 185/65 R 15,
195/60 R 15
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.9/42
195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16
2.1/30 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42
Z 17 DTH 195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.1/30 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42
215/45 R 17,
225/40 R 18
2.5/36 2.3/33 2.6/38 3.0/44
Z 19 DTL,
Z 19 DT,
Z 19 DTH
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.7/39 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42
215/45 R 17,
225/40 R 18
2.6/38 2.4/35 2.7/39 3.1/45
all T 115/70 R 16
(temporary spare)
4)
4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61
2) To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres.
3) Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
4) Notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 255.
337Technical Data
(ctd.)
Tyre pressure in bar / psi
1)
1)
1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi.
Estate Tyre pressure
for load of
up to 3 persons
Tyre pressure ECO
2)
loaded
up to 3 people
Tyre pressure
for full load
Engine
3)
Tyres – Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear
Z 14 XEP,
Z 16 XEP,
Z 18 XE
195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.0/29 2.0/29 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.1/30 2.6/38
185/65 R 15,
195/60 R 15,
215/45 R 17,
225/40 R 18
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.9/42
Z 14 XEL,
Z 18 XER
195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.0/29 2.0/29 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.1/30 2.6/38
185/65 R 15,
195/60 R 15
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.9/42
all T 115/70 R 16
(temporary spare)
4)
4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61
2)
To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres.
3)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
4)
For notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 255.
338 Technical Data
(ctd.)
Tyre pressure in bar / psi
1)
1)
1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi.
Estate Tyre pressure
for load of
up to 3 persons
Tyre pressure ECO
2)
loaded
up to 3 people
Tyre pressure
for full load
Engine
3)
Tyres – Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear
Z 20 LEL 205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.7/39 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42
215/45 R 17,
225/40 R 18
2.5/36 2.3/33 2.6/38 3.0/44
Z 20 LER 205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.7/39 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42
215/45 R 17,
225/40 R 18
2.7/39 2.5/36 2.8/41 3.1/45
Z 13 DTH 195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16
2.1/30 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42
185/65 R 15,
195/60 R 15
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.9/42
all T 115/70 R 16
(temporary spare)
4)
4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61
2)
To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres.
3)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
4)
For notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 255.
339Technical Data
(ctd.)
Tyre pressure in bar / psi
1)
1)
1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi.
Estate Tyre pressure
for load of
up to 3 persons
Tyre pressure ECO
2)
loaded
up to 3 people
Tyre pressure
for full load
Engine
3)
Tyres – Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear
Z 17 DTH 195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.1/30 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42
215/45 R 17,
225/40 R 18
2.5/36 2.3/33 2.6/38 3.0/44
Z 19 DTL,
Z 19 DT,
Z 19 DTH
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.7/39 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42
215/45 R 17,
225/40 R 18
2.7/39 2.5/36 2.8/41 3.1/45
all T 115/70 R 16
(temporary spare)
4)
4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61
2)
To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres.
3)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
4)
For notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 255.
340 Technical Data
(ctd.)
Tyre pressure in bar / psi
1)
1)
1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi.
Van Tyre pressure
for load of
up to 2 persons
Tyre pressure ECO
2)
loaded
up to 2 people
Tyre pressure
for full load
Engine
3)
Tyres – Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear
Z 14 XEP 195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.0/29 2.0/29 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.1/30 2.6/38
185/65 R 15,
195/60 R 15,
215/45 R 17,
225/40 R 18
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.9/42
Z 13 DTH 195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16
2.1/30 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42
185/65 R 15,
195/60 R 15
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.9/42
Z 17 DTH 195/65 R 15,
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.1/30 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42
215/45 R 17,
225/40 R 18
2.5/36 2.3/33 2.6/38 3.0/44
Z 19 DTL,
Z 19 DT,
Z 19 DTH
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.7/39 2.5/36 2.5/36 2.9/42
215/45 R 17,
225/40 R 18
2.7/39 2.5/36 2.8/41 3.1/45
all T 115/70 R 16
(temporary spare)
4)
4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61
2)
To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres.
3)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
4)
For notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 255.
341Technical Data
(ctd.)
Tyre pressure in bar / psi
1)
1)
1 bar corresponds to 100 kPa / 14.5 psi.
TwinTop Tyre pressure
for load of
up to 3 persons
Tyre pressure ECO
2)
loaded
up to 3 people
Tyre pressure
for full load
Engine
3)
Tyres – Front Rear Front Rear Front Rear
Z 16 XEP,
Z 18 XER
205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.1/30 2.1/30 2.5/36 2.5/36 2,2/32 2.6/38
225/40 R 18 2.3/33 2.1/30 2.4/35 2.8/41
Z 20 LEL 205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.4/35 2.8/41
225/40 R 18 2.5/36 2.3/33 2.6/38 3.0/44
Z 20 LER 205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.5/36 2.3/33 2.6/38 3.0/44
225/40 R 18 2.6/38 2.4/35 2.7/39 3.1/45
Z 19 DTH 205/55 R 16,
225/45 R 17
2.3/33 2.1/30 2.4/35 2.8/41
225/40 R 18 2.5/36 2.3/33 2.6/38 3.0/44
all T 115/70 R 16
(temporary spare)
4)
4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61 4.2/61
2)
To achieve the smallest amount of fuel consumption possible. Not for use with run-flat tyres.
3)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
4)
For notes on the temporary spare wheel – see page 255.
342 Technical Data
Electrical system
Battery Voltage 12 Volt
Amp hours 36 Ah / 44 Ah 3 / 55 Ah 3 / 60 Ah 3 /
66 Ah 3 / 70 Ah 3
Battery for radio remote control of
central locking system and
electronic key
of Open&Start system
CR 20 32
343Technical Data
Capacities
(approx. litre)
Capacities
(approx. litre)
Engine
1)
1)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
Z 14 XEL Z 14 XEP Z 16 XEP Z 18 XE Z 18 XER Z 20 LEL Z 20 LER
Fuel tank (nominal content) 52 52 52 52 52 52 52
Engine oil with filter change
between MIN and MAX on dipstick
3.5
1.0
3.5
1.0
4.5
1.0
4.5
1.0
4.5
1.0
4.25
1.0
4.25
1.0
Wash fluid reservoir for windscreen wash
systemwith headlight wash system
2.4
4.0
2.4
4.0
2.4
4.0
2.4
4.0
2.4
4.0
2.4
4.0
2.4
4.0
Engine
1)
1)
Sales designation – see pages 314, 315.
Z 20 LEH Z 13 DTH Z 17 DTH Z 19 DTL Z 19 DT Z 19 DTH
Fuel tank (nominal content) 52 52 52 52 52 52
Engine oil with filter change
between MIN and MAX on dipstick
5.0
1.0
3.2
1.0
5.0
1.0
4,3
0,7
4,3
0,7
4,3
0,7
Wash fluid reservoir for windscreen wash
systemwith headlight wash system
2.4
4.0
2.4
4.0
2.4
4.0
2.4
4.0
2.4
4.0
2.4
4.0
344 Technical Data
Dimensions
(approx. mm)
Hatch 5-door Hatch 3-door Estate Van TwinTop
Overall length 4249 4290 4515 4515 4476
Width 1753 1753 1753 1753 1759
Width with two exterior mirrors 2033 2033 2033 2033 2039
Overall height 1460 1435 1500 1500 1411
Wheelbase 2614 2614 2703 2703 2614
Turning circle diameter
1)
1)
In metres.
11.20 11.20 11.50 11.50 11.20
345Technical Data
Installation dimensions of
trailer towing equipment
with detachable coupling ball
bar,
Hatch
1)
All dimensions refer to factory-fitted
towing equipment.
1)
Do not mount towing equipment to vehicles
with Z 20 LEH engine. Sales designation
– page 314.
Dimension mm
A 342.9
B
83
C
513.4
D
488.6
E
211.4
F
94.3
G
160
9 Warning
Only use towing equipment approved for
your vehicle. We recommend entrusting
retrofitting of towing equipment to your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
346 Technical Data
Installation dimensions of
trailer towing equipment
with detachable coupling ball
bar,
Estate, Van
All dimensions refer to factory-fitted
towing equipment.
Dimension mm
A 84.0
B
570.0
C
515.0
D
93.5
E
173.0
F
307.6
G
158.0
H
292.6
9 Warning
Only use towing equipment approved for
your vehicle. We recommend entrusting
retrofitting of towing equipment to your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
347Technical Data
Installation dimensions of
trailer towing equipment
with detachable coupling ball
bar,
Astra TwinTop
All measurements refer to Vauxhall-
approved towing equipment.
Dimension mm
A 68,8
B
570.0
C
515.0
D
485,0
E
93.5
F
288,0
G
245,0
9 Warning
Only use towing equipment approved for
your vehicle. We recommend entrusting
retrofitting of towing equipment to your
Vauxhall Authorised Repairer.
348 Technical Data
349Index
Index
A
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System) .......... 228
Accessories
................... 130, 135, 252
Accessory socket
......................... 107
Adaptive Forward Lighting (AFL)
..... 139
Driving abroad
......................... 142
Air conditioning system
........... 157, 164
Air intake
................................... 177
Air quality sensor
......................... 172
Air recirculation system
.... 164, 168, 176
Air vents
.................................... 159
Alarm system
................................ 83
Alternator
.................................... 39
Antenna
............................... 64, 309
Antifreeze
.................................. 300
Antifreeze protection
.............. 300, 305
Anti-knock quality of fuel
............... 204
Octane number
.................. 314, 315
Anti-theft locking system
................. 77
Towing equipment
.................... 241
Anti-theft protection
....................... 24
Aquaplaning
.............................. 234
Armrest
........................... 90, 91, 110
Ashtray
............................... 108, 142
Automatic
Anti-dazzle interior mirror
........... 134
Automatic air recirculation mode
172, 176
Automatic transmission
. 20, 21, 186, 192
automatic mode
................. 187, 193
Control indicator
................. 188, 195
Driving programme
............. 188, 195
Fault
............................... 190, 198
Interruption of power supply
.. 191, 199
Kickdown
......................... 189, 196
manual mode
........................... 194
Selector lever
..... 20, 21, 187, 193, 194
Winter programme
............. 189, 196
Automatic wiping
........................... 17
B
Battery ......................... 201, 306, 342
Interruption of
power supply
....... 145, 185, 191, 199
Battery discharge protection
........... 142
Before starting off
.......................... 22
Belt force limiters
.......................... 112
Belt tensioners
............................. 113
Bleeding, diesel fuel system
............. 247
Board information display
................ 46
Bonnet
........................................ 86
Boot, see Luggage compartment
.. 81, 91
Brake assist
................................ 226
Brake light
.................................. 226
Brake system
................................ 38
Brakes
....................................... 226
ABS
....................................... 228
Brake assist
............................. 226
Brake fluid
............................... 302
Brake lights
.............................. 282
Brake lights
.............................. 288
Brake servo unit
........................ 200
Foot brake
............................... 226
Hand brake
............................. 227
Bulb replacement
.................. 272, 274
Bulbs
........................... 135, 272, 274
C
Capacities .................................. 343
Car Pass
................................... 2, 66
Caravan/trailer towing
............ 200, 238
Care
.......................................... 308
Cargo box
.................................. 103
Catalytic converter
.......... 207, 211, 247
CDC
(Continuous Damping Control)
... 39, 214
Central locking system
.................... 76
Changing the battery
Radio remote control
....... 69, 75, 342
Changing tyre/wheel type
............... 230
Changing wheels
.......................... 257
Chassis number,
see vehicle identification number
..... 313
Check control
.......................... 30, 62
Child restraint system
............. 130, 135
Child safety locks
..................... 86, 144
Cigarette lighter
.................... 107, 142
Climate control
............................ 157
Climate control system
............ 158, 171
Clock
.......................................... 44
Clutch operation
........................... 201
CO2 emissions
............................. 319
Code numbers
................................ 2
Cold start
................................... 201
Colour information display
............... 46
Continuous Damping Control
...... 39, 214
Continuous Damping Control
(CDC)
.................................. 39, 214
Contrast
...................................... 57
350 Index
Control indicator
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System)
....... 229
Airbag
............................. 123, 132
Engine electronics
..................... 210
Exhaust
.................................. 209
Immobiliser
............................... 67
Parking distance sensor
.............. 219
Transmission
..................... 188, 195
Tyre pressure monitoring system
... 224
Control indicators
..................... 10, 37
Adaptive Forward Lighting
............ 42
Adaptive Forward Lighting (AFL)
.. 139
Belt tensioners
.......................... 113
Brake system
........................... 228
Cruise control
........................... 216
DDS
...................................... 221
Deflation detection system
.......... 221
ESP (Electronic Stability Program)
.. 212
IDS+
................................ 214, 215
Coolant
..................................... 300
Coolant level
.............................. 301
Coolant temperature
...................... 39
Cooled glove compartment
............ 159
Cooling
............................... 165, 170
Correcting time
........................ 50, 56
Coupling socket load
.................... 244
Courtesy light
............................. 141
Courtesy lights
Bulb replacement
...................... 292
Cruise control
............................. 216
Curtain airbags
........................... 122
Curve lighting
........................ 33, 139
D
Dashboard, see Instrument panel ........ 7
Data
.................................... 66, 312
Date
...................................... 48, 51
Daytime running lights
................... 136
Decommissioning
......................... 307
Deflation detection system
........ 32, 221
Deflation Detection System (DDS)
..... 221
Demisting and defrosting
Windows
................................. 163
with climate control system
.......... 174
With air conditioning
.......... 166, 170
Diesel fuel filter
............................ 300
Diesel fuel system
.................. 247, 300
Diesel particle filter
........... 42, 160, 201
Dipped beam
......................... 15, 136
Bulb replacement
...................... 275
Display
................................... 45, 46
Display mode
................................ 58
Door handle lighting
..................... 142
Door locks
............................. 66, 311
Doors
.......................................... 39
Door-to-door lighting
.................... 140
Driving abroad
..................... 204, 294
Headlights
............................... 142
Driving hints
............................... 200
E
Easy Load .................................. 104
Easytronic
............................. 20, 178
Driving programmes
.................. 181
fault
...................................... 184
Interruption of power supply
......... 185
Kickdown
................................. 182
Selector lever
............................. 20
Starting off
............................... 180
Winter programme
..................... 182
Economical driving
................. 200, 202
Electric sun roof
............................ 146
Electric windows
........................... 143
Electrical system
.................... 306, 342
Electro-hydraulic
power assisted steering
................. 200
Electro-hydraulic
power-assisted steering
fluid
....................................... 313
Electronic components
................... 306
Electronic immobiliser
..................... 67
Electronic Stability Program
............. 212
Engine code
.................. 313, 314, 315
Engine control indicator
.................. 210
Engine oil
................................... 298
Engine oil change
......................... 299
Engine oil consumption
.................. 298
Engine oil filter
............................. 299
Engine oil level
........................ 40, 298
Engine oil pressure
......................... 37
Engine speed
............................... 201
Engine wash
................................ 311
Entry lighting
............................... 142
Environmental protection
......... 299, 308
ESP (Electronic Stability Program)
...... 212
Exhaust control indicator
................ 209
Exhaust gases
.............................. 210
Exhaust system
............................ 210
Exterior mirrors
................. 6, 134, 160
351Index
F
Fan ................................ 3, 161, 297
Filling station
Capacities
............................... 343
Engine oil level
......................... 298
Fuel
.......................... 204, 314, 315
Ignition key
................................. 2
Opening the bonnet
.................... 86
Tyre pressure
..................... 203, 333
Vehicle data
............................ 313
Windscreen wash system
............ 305
First-aid kit (cushion)
.............. 135, 252
Flat tyre
.................................... 261
FlexOrganizer
............................. 102
Fog lights
.................................. 137
Fog lights
Bulb replacement
...................... 281
Fog tail light
............................... 137
Bulb replacement
................ 282, 288
Folding roof, see TwinTop
.............. 148
Foot brake
................................. 226
Front passenger airbag
................. 118
Fuel
...................... 204, 205, 314, 315
Fuel consumption
........... 202, 204, 319
Fuel filler cap
.............................. 205
Fuel filter
................................... 300
Fuel gauge
.................................. 43
Fuel level
..................................... 43
Fuel system, diesel
....................... 247
Fuse extractor
............................. 266
Fuses
........................................ 264
G
Gears.......................................... 20
Generator, see Alternator
................. 39
Genuine Vauxhall
Parts and Accessories
.................... 26
Glasses compartment
.................... 110
Glove compartment
...................... 110
Glove compartment lighting
............ 142
Bulb replacement
...................... 293
Graphical information display
............ 46
Gross vehicle weight
...................... 324
H
Halogen headlight system
Driving abroad
......................... 142
Halogen headlight system
.............. 274
Bulb replacement
...................... 274
Hand brake
...................... 23, 24, 227
Hazard warning lights
.............. 16, 134
Head restraints
.................. 28, 88, 135
Headlight flash
.............................. 15
Headlight range adjustment
........... 138
Headlight switch
.............. 14, 136, 137
Headlight wash system
............. 18, 305
Headlights
................................... 14
Daytime running lights
................ 136
Driving abroad
......................... 142
Fog lights
................................ 137
Warning device
........................... 23
Headlight range adjustment
........... 274
Heated exterior mirrors
............. 18, 160
Heated front seats
........................ 160
Heated rear window
................ 18, 160
Heating
.............................. 157, 162
Seats
...................................... 160
with climate control system
........... 173
with the air
conditioning system
............. 166, 170
Height adjustment
seat belts
................................. 115
Steering wheel
............................. 7
High-pressure cleaners
..... 242, 310, 311
Hill Start Assist
............................. 227
Horn
.......................................... 16
I
Identification plate........................ 312
IDS+ (Interactive Driving System)
212, 214
Ignition logic
........................... 51, 58
Ignition system
...................... 297, 306
Immobiliser
.................................. 67
Information display
........................ 46
Infotainment system
....................... 65
Inspection system
......................... 296
Instrument display
......................... 43
Instrument illumination
................... 140
Bulb replacement
....................... 293
Instrument panel
............................. 7
Instruments
.................................. 36
Interactive Driving System (IDS+)
212, 214
Interior mirror
................................. 6
Interruption of power supply
. 60, 63, 145
Easytronic
................................ 185
Electric windows
........................ 145
Selector lever lock
............... 191, 199
ISOFIX
....................................... 129
352 Index
J
Jack ......................................... 256
Jump leads
................................ 248
K
Key
extending
................................. 66
ignition lock
............................... 14
Locking doors
............................ 76
Remove
.................................... 24
Starting the engine
................. 14, 22
Key numbers
.................................. 2
Keys
........................................... 66
L
Language selection................... 51, 56
Lashing eyes
.............................. 103
Leather trim
............................... 310
Level control system
..................... 220
Light switch
.................................. 14
Lighting
.......................... 14, 40, 136
Driving abroad
......................... 142
Loading
....................... 243, 322, 323
Locking doors
........................... 2, 76
Locking from the inside
................... 78
Locks
........................................ 311
Lubricants
........................... 298, 313
Luggage compartment
Bulb replacement
...................... 293
FlexOrganizer
.......................... 102
Lighting
................................. 142
Loading
.................... 106, 243, 324
Locking
.................................... 81
Safety net
........................... 99, 101
Luggage compartment cover
............ 98
Lumbar support
.............................. 4
M
Main beam............................ 15, 136
Bulb replacement
............... 276, 278
Control indicator
......................... 41
Maintenance
.......................... 26, 296
Air conditioning system
............... 177
Antifreeze protection
.................. 300
Brake fluid
............................... 302
Brakes
.................................... 226
Catalytic converter
.................... 211
Engine oil
......................... 298, 299
Fuel consumption
...................... 203
Tyre pressure
........................... 232
Tyres
............................... 233, 234
Windscreen wipers
..................... 303
Manual transmission, see Transmission
20
Mirrors
................................... 6, 134
Misted windows
.................... 163, 174
Mobile telephone
........................... 65
Motorway lighting
................... 33, 139
Muffler, see Exhaust system
............ 210
N
Neutral, transmission ...................... 20
Number plate lighting
................... 291
Number plate lights
Bulb replacement
...................... 291
Number plates
............................ 307
O
Octane numbers.................... 204, 314
Oil change
.................................. 299
Oil consumption
........................... 298
Oil filter change
............................ 299
Oil level
...................................... 298
Oil pressure
.................................. 37
Oils
........................................... 298
Open&Start system
......... 22, 31, 36, 70
Operating temperature
.................. 201
Outside temperature gauge
............. 47
Overrun
.............................. 201, 203
P
Paintwork damage........................ 310
Panoramic windscreen
.............. 34, 146
Parking
................................. 24, 218
Parking distance sensor
.................. 218
Parking lights
......................... 14, 140
Parking lights
Bulb replacement
................ 277, 280
Parking the vehicle
......................... 24
Parts
.................................... 26, 135
Pedals
....................................... 201
Performance
............................... 319
Petrol
.......................... 204, 314, 315
Pinking
...................................... 204
Pollen filter
.................................. 177
Power assisted steering, see electro-hy-
draulic power assisted steering
....... 200
Power steering, see electro-hydraulic pow-
er assisted steering
...................... 200
Preheating
.............................. 22, 42
353Index
Preheating switch .......................... 22
Puddle light
................................ 142
Pushing, towing
........................... 247
Q
Quickheat..................... 162, 169, 173
R
Radio ......................................... 64
Radio equipment (CB)
..................... 65
Radio reception
............................. 64
Radio remote control
Central locking system
... 2, 31, 68, 71
Rain sensor
........................... 17, 303
Reading lights
............................. 141
Rear light cluster
.......................... 136
Bulb replacement
................ 282, 288
Rear window wash system
... 18, 305, 309
Refuelling
.................................. 205
Fuel filler cap
........................... 206
Remote control
Central locking system
... 2, 31, 68, 71
Steering wheel
....................... 30, 64
Replacement keys
.......................... 66
Reversing lights
Bulb replacement
................ 282, 288
Rollover protection system
............. 152
Roof lining
............................ 34, 146
Roof load
........ 106, 200, 203, 322, 323
Roof rack
...................... 203, 238, 324
Roof racks
.................... 203, 238, 324
Run-flat tyres
.............................. 235
Running-in
................................. 200
Brakes
................................... 226
S
Safeguard
against unauthorised use
....... 2, 14, 25
Safety
....................................... 111
Safety accessories
........... 130, 135, 252
Safety net
............................. 99, 101
Safety systems
............................ 111
Saving energy
............................. 202
Seat adjustment
.............................. 3
Seat belts
............................ 115, 310
Seat height adjustment
..................... 4
Seat occupancy recognition
............ 124
Seat position
................................. 87
Seats
........................................ 3, 4
heated
................................... 160
Selector lever
................. 179, 187, 193
Selector lever lock
........ 20, 21, 187, 193
Self-diagnosis
................. 113, 123, 229
Self-help
.................................... 247
Automatic transmission
............... 191
Electric sun roof
........................ 147
Electric windows
........................ 145
Information display
...................... 48
Radio remote control
............... 69, 75
Service Booklet
.............................. 26
Service interval display
.................. 296
Service work
........................... 26, 296
Side airbags
............................... 120
Signal system
........................... 15, 16
Spare fuses
................................. 265
Spare keys
.................................... 66
Spare wheel
................... 254, 255, 257
Speed
................................ 202, 203
Fuel consumption
............... 202, 203
Speedometer
................................ 43
Sport mode
.................................. 39
Sport programme
.................... 32, 214
Starter switch
................................ 14
Starting the engine
...... 14, 67, 179, 247
Self-help
.................................. 247
Steam-jet cleaners
.......... 242, 310, 311
Steering column lock
.................. 14, 24
Steering wheel adjustment
................. 7
Steering wheel remote control
...... 30, 64
Stowage compartments
................. 110
Sun roof
..................................... 146
Sun visors
....................... 34, 142, 146
Sunblind
..................................... 147
System settings
........................ 50, 55
T
Tables ....................................... 110
Tachometer
................................. 43
Tail lights
................................... 136
Bulb replacement
....................... 282
Tail lights
Bulb replacement
....................... 288
Tailgate
...................................... 81
Tank
Fuel gauge
................................ 43
Technical data
............................. 312
Telephone, see Mobile telephone
....... 65
Temperature regulation
.......... 161, 173
Tempomat, see cruise control
.......... 216
Temporary spare wheel
........... 237, 255
The first 600 miles/1000 km
............. 200
Tightening torque
.................. 260, 333
354 Index
Tilt angle
seats
......................................... 4
Time
...................................... 48, 51
Tools
........................................ 256
Towing
..................................... 249
Towing equipment
....................... 239
Towing eye
.......................... 249, 251
Trailer Stability Assist (TSA)
............ 244
Transmission display
... 45, 178, 186, 193
Transmission, automatic
20, 21, 186, 192
automatic mode
................. 187, 193
Driving programme
............. 188, 195
Fault
............................... 190, 198
Interruption of power supply
.. 191, 199
Kickdown
.......................... 189, 196
Selector lever
......... 20, 187, 193, 194
Selector lever lock
....................... 20
Winter programme
.............. 189, 196
Transmission, Easytronic
................ 178
Driving programmes
.................. 181
fault
...................................... 184
Interruption of power supply
........ 185
Kickdown
................................ 182
Selector lever
...................... 20, 180
Winter programme
.................... 182
Transmission, manual
..................... 20
Tread depth
............................... 234
Trip computer
..................... 30, 52, 58
Trip odometer
............................... 44
Triple information display
................ 46
TSA (Trailer Stability Assist)
............ 244
Turn signal lights
........................... 15
Turn signals
Bulb replacement
......... 281, 282, 288
Twin Audio
.............................. 31, 64
TwinTop
.................................... 148
Closing the roof
........................ 149
Opening the roof
....................... 149
Rollover protection
..................... 152
Warning buzzers
....................... 150
Wind deflector
.......................... 154
Tyre chains
.......................... 236, 333
Tyre condition
............................. 233
Tyre pressure
............ 32, 222, 232, 333
Tyre pressure monitoring system
...... 222
Tyre repair kit
.............................. 261
U
Units of measure....................... 51, 57
Unleaded fuel
................ 204, 207, 314
Used oil
..................................... 299
V
Valve cap key ...................... 232, 333
Vauxhall alarm system
.................... 83
Vauxhall Service
..................... 26, 294
Vehicle care
................................ 308
Vehicle decommissioning
............... 307
Vehicle identification number
.......... 313
Vehicle keys, see Keys
..................... 66
Vehicle recommissioning
................ 307
Vehicle tools
............................... 256
Ventilation
............. 157, 162, 169, 175
W
Warning buzzers ........................... 23
Warning messages
............... 49, 54, 55
Warning triangle
................... 135, 252
Wash fluid reservoir, windscreen
wash system
.............................. 305
Weights
.............................. 322, 323
Wheels
....................................... 230
Wheels, tyres
............................... 230
Wind deflector
............................. 154
Windows
Demisting and defrosting
..... 163, 166,
170, 174
Windscreen wash system
................. 18
Antifreeze protection
.................. 305
Capacities
................................ 343
Wash fluid reservoir
.................... 305
Windscreen wipers
................... 17, 303
Winter mode
Starting-off aid
......................... 182
Winter operation
Battery
.................................... 201
Coolant, antifreeze
..................... 300
Fuel consumption
...................... 203
Fuel for diesel engines
................. 205
Heating
..................... 157, 166, 170
Locks
...................................... 311
Tyre chains
....................... 236, 333
Window demisting and defrosting
.. 163
Windscreen wash system,
antifreeze protection
.................. 305
Winter programme
.......... 182, 189, 196
Winter tyres
.......................... 236, 333
355Index
X
Xenon headlight system
Driving abroad
......................... 142
Xenon headlight system
................ 278
Bulb replacement
...................... 278
338


Need help? Post your question in this forum.

Forumrules


Report abuse

Libble takes abuse of its services very seriously. We're committed to dealing with such abuse according to the laws in your country of residence. When you submit a report, we'll investigate it and take the appropriate action. We'll get back to you only if we require additional details or have more information to share.

Product:

For example, Anti-Semitic content, racist content, or material that could result in a violent physical act.

For example, a credit card number, a personal identification number, or an unlisted home address. Note that email addresses and full names are not considered private information.

Forumrules

To achieve meaningful questions, we apply the following rules:

Register

Register getting emails for Vauxhall Astra 2006 at:


You will receive an email to register for one or both of the options.


Get your user manual by e-mail

Enter your email address to receive the manual of Vauxhall Astra 2006 in the language / languages: English as an attachment in your email.

The manual is 7,1 mb in size.

 

You will receive the manual in your email within minutes. If you have not received an email, then probably have entered the wrong email address or your mailbox is too full. In addition, it may be that your ISP may have a maximum size for emails to receive.

Others manual(s) of Vauxhall Astra 2006

Vauxhall Astra 2006 User Manual - English - 355 pages


The manual is sent by email. Check your email

If you have not received an email with the manual within fifteen minutes, it may be that you have a entered a wrong email address or that your ISP has set a maximum size to receive email that is smaller than the size of the manual.

The email address you have provided is not correct.

Please check the email address and correct it.

Your question is posted on this page

Would you like to receive an email when new answers and questions are posted? Please enter your email address.



Info